This is only a preview of the March 2016 issue of Silicon Chip. You can view 36 of the 96 pages in the full issue, including the advertisments. For full access, purchase the issue for $10.00 or subscribe for access to the latest issues. Items relevant to "Ultrasonic Garage Parking Assistant":
Items relevant to "1-Wire Digital Temperature Sensor For The Raspberry Pi":
Items relevant to "Delta Throttle Timer For Cars":
Items relevant to "Solar MPPT Charger & Lighting Controller, Pt.2":
Items relevant to "Battery-Pack Cell Balancer For Optimum Charging":
Purchase a printed copy of this issue for $10.00. |
KIT OF THE
MONTH
12/24VDC 20A
Motor Speed Controller Kit
$
4395
SILICON CHIP MAGAZINE JUNE 2011 KC-5502
Control the speed of 12 or 24VDC motors from zero to full power, up to
20A. Features optional soft start, adjustable pulse frequency to reduce
motor noise, and low battery protection. The speed is set using the onboard
trimpot, or by using an external potentiometer (available separately).
FREE 10K POTENTIOMETER LINEAR SINGLE
GANG (24MM) (RP-3510) AND FREE UB3
BLACK BOX (HB-6013) FOR NERD PERKS
CARD HOLDERS* RP-3510 Valid with purchase of
*
Kit supplied with soldermasked PCB with overlay and all onboard electronic components.
KC-5502
• PCB: 106 x 60mm
RP-3510 VALUED AT $2.95, HB-6013 VALUED AT $3.95
POWER TESTING TOOLS
POWER CONTROL KITS
1295
$
Digital Multimeter Kit
24
95
KG-9250
Learn everything there is to know about component recognition
and basic electronics with this comprehensive kit. From test leads
to solder, everything you need for the construction of this meter
is included together will a detailed manual. With test questions
and schematic supplied in the manual, the kit can be geared to an
individual or class learning environment, making it an excellent
choice for first year trade apprentices.
Kit supplied with DMM case, LCD, solder, battery, test leads, PCB,
comprehensive 18 page learning manual and electronic components.
• 67(W) x 123(H) x 25(D)mm
DOUBLE
POINTS
$
USB Port Voltage Checker Kit
33
SILICON CHIP MAGAZINE JULY 2013 KC-5522
95
An easy way to test a USB port to see if it is dead, faulty or incorrectly wired to help prevent damaging a valuable USB device
you plan to connect. Voltage is indicated using three LEDs.
Kit supplied with double sided, soldermasked and
screen-printed PCB with SMDs pre-soldered, clear heatshrink,
USB connectors and components for USB 2.0 & USB 3.0.
• PCB: 44 x 17mm
DOUBLE
POINTS
$
1295
$
DOUBLE
POINTS
$
LED Battery
Voltage Indicator Kit
12VDC Relay Card Kit
KA-1778
It provides power and low voltage indication using a bi-colour
LED. Current consumption is 3mA at 6V and 8mA at 10V and the
circuit is suitable for equipment powered from about 6-30VDC.
Kit supplied with PCB, bi-colour LED and all specified electronic
components.
• 25mm x 25mm
1995
$
KG-9142
This kit will close a relay's contacts with as little as 5mA to trigger the
circuit. Literately any kit you see on these pages that uses an LED as
a trip-condition indicator, can be used with this nifty project. Use the
relay to sound buzzers, switch on lights, operate solenoids, trigger
alarms, etc.
Kit supplied with Kwik Kit PCB, relay plus electronic components.
• 3A max current
$
2495
1.3V to 22VDC 1A
Voltage Regulator Kit
Battery Saver Kit
This handy voltage regulator can provide up to 1,000mA at any
voltage from 1.3 to 22VDC. Ideal for experimental projects or as a
mini bench power supply.
Kit supplied with PCB and all electronic components.
• Heatsink may be regulated depending on output current.
• 38 x 35mm
It loads and cuts off the power when the battery becomes flat to
prevent the battery over-discharging and becoming damaged. Suitable
for use with cordless power tools, emergency lights, small to medium
UPS (up to about 300VA) and a wide variety of other devices.
• Suits most SLA, Li-ion, Li-Po and LiFePO4 batteries between 6
to 24V
• Cut-off voltage adjustable from 5.25 to 25.5V
• 38 x 18.5mm
SILICON CHIP MAGAZINE MAY 2007 KC-5446
FOR RECHARGEABLE LITHIUM AND SLA BATTERIES
SILICON CHIP MAGAZINE SEPT 2013 KC-5523
BARGAIN PACKS - HURRY! STOCKS ARE LIMITED!
5995
USB Power Monitor Kit
SILICON CHIP MAGAZINE DEC 2012 KC-5516
At the touch of a button the 4-digit LCD panel can display
current, voltage or power. It is auto-ranging and will read
as low as a few microamps and up to over an amp. It also
features display flip-mode, mode memory and digital
calibration.
Kit supplied with double sided, soldermasked and
screen-printed PCB with SMDs pre-soldered, LCD
screen, and components.
• PCB: 65 x 36mm
4
$ 95
PCB Mount Screw
Terminal Bargain
Pack XB-9004
Includes at least 10 x 2-way
screw terminals with 5.08mm
(0.2") pitch, and a few 2 or 3-way
at 2.54mm (0.1") pitch.
To order phone 1800 022 888 or visit our new website www.jaycar.com.au
1495
$
Terminal and
Connector Bargain
Pack XB-9005
Contains an assortment of over
60 different in-line, PCB mount
connectors and PCB mount
terminals.
1695
$
Switch Bargain
Pack XB-9007
A true lucky dip of over 50 high
quality switches, including rocker,
tactile, toggle, DIL, pushbutton
and micro switches. No two bags
are the same. Excellent value for
money.
$
2495
MKT Capacitor
Bargain Pack
XB-9008
A vast array of over 90 high
quality WIMA brand X2 type and
other capacitors.
Catalogue Sale 28 February - 23 March, 2016
Contents
Vol.29, No.3; March 2016
SILICON
CHIP
www.siliconchip.com.au
Features
14 A Look At Quantum Computers
Quantum computers are based on a different type of architecture to conventional computers and can solve problems using the strange properties of quantum
mechanics, such as superposition and entanglement – by Dr David Maddison
24 Macroscopic Entanglement At Room Temperature
News of an exciting new milestone in quantum computing
80 Save Money By Replacing Batteries In Emergency Lights
When Nicad batteries in emergency exit lights fail, the entire fitting is usually
replaced. But don’t be a tosser; replace the Nicad battery pack instead and
save $$$ – by Ross Tester
Ultrasonic
Garage Parking
Assistant –
Page 26.
Pro jects To Build
26 Ultrasonic Garage Parking Assistant
Is your garage a tight squeeze? This unit displays the distance from the wall of
your garage to your car’s bumper bar in large digits on a bright colour-coded
background: green for go, yellow for slow and red for stop – by Geoff Graham
34 1-Wire Digital Temperature Sensor For The Raspberry Pi
If you just want to measure temperature, then using a Sense HAT with the
RPi is overkill. A much cheaper and more accurate option is to use a DS18B20
1-Wire Digital Thermometer Sensor – by Greg Swain & Nicholas Vinen
38 Delta Throttle Timer For Cars
This device activates a timer and a relay if you accelerate or decelerate hard.
Use it for intercooler water spray and/or intercooler fan control, automatic turbo
boost increase with hard driving, automatically switching power or economy
transmission modes or for some other application – by John Clarke
1-Wire Digital Temperature
Sensor For The Raspberry
Pi – Page 34.
60 Solar MPPT Charger & Lighting Controller, Pt.2
Our new Solar MPPT Charger/Lighting Controller uses solar panels to charge a
12/24V battery and then works with LDR/PIR sensors to run 12V DC lighting or
an inverter. Pt.2 this month, shows you how to build it – by John Clarke
72 Battery-Pack Cell Balancer For Optimum Charging
Many chargers can handle lithium-ion, lithium-polymer or LiFePO4 batteries but
do not balance the charge between cells. This can lead to incomplete charging
and premature failure. Here’s how to solve the problem – by Nicholas Vinen
Special Columns
Delta Throttle Timer For
Cars – Page 38.
54 Serviceman’s Log
Sorting out my quake-damaged workshop – by Dave Thompson
67 Circuit Notebook
(1) Hot-Wire Cutter With Heat Controller; (2) Adjustable Current Sink For Valve
Biasing; (3) Soldering Iron Timer; (4) Improved AM Tuner Has Low Distortion
82 Vintage Radio
HMV 1939 model 209 5-valve radio – by Graham Parslow
Departments
2 Publisher’s Letter
4 Mailbag
siliconchip.com.au
53 Product Showcase
88 SC Online Shop
90
95
96
96
Ask Silicon Chip
Market Centre
Advertising Index
Notes & Errata
Battery-Pack Cell Balancer For
Optimum Charging – Page 72.
March 2016 1
SILICON
CHIP
www.siliconchip.com.au
Publisher & Editor-in-Chief
Leo Simpson, B.Bus., FAICD
Production Manager
Greg Swain, B.Sc. (Hons.)
Technical Editor
John Clarke, B.E.(Elec.)
Technical Staff
Ross Tester
Jim Rowe, B.A., B.Sc
Nicholas Vinen
Photography
Ross Tester
Reader Services
Ann Morris
Advertising Enquiries
Glyn Smith
Phone (02) 9939 3295
Mobile 0431 792 293
glyn<at>siliconchip.com.au
Regular Contributors
Brendan Akhurst
David Maddison B.App.Sc. (Hons 1),
PhD, Grad.Dip.Entr.Innov.
Kevin Poulter
Dave Thompson
SILICON CHIP is published 12 times
a year by Silicon Chip Publications
Pty Ltd. ACN 003 205 490. ABN 49
003 205 490. All material is copyright ©. No part of this publication
may be reproduced without the written
consent of the publisher.
Printing: Offset Alpine, Lidcombe,
NSW.
Distribution: Network Distribution
Company.
Subscription rates: $105.00 per year
in Australia. For overseas rates, see
our website or the subscriptions page
in this issue.
Editorial office:
Unit 1, 234 Harbord Rd,
Brookvale, NSW 2100.
Postal address: PO Box 139,
Collaroy Beach, NSW 2097.
Phone (02) 9939 3295.
E-mail: silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
ISSN 1030-2662
Recommended & maximum price only.
2 Silicon Chip
Publisher’s Letter
Future electronic developments
in cars
Every month it seems there is some new development
being introduced in cars to improve safety, efficiency
or driveability. For example, many new cars now have
adaptive cruise control, lane departure warning, rear
cross-traffic alert, 360° camera view, automatic engine
stop and restart and so on. Upmarket cars have head-up
displays on their windscreen, some have auto reverse
parking and many SUVs have rear cameras.
But it also seems that at least some of the electronic developments are trivial,
such as touch-screens to control the phone, music and air-conditioning, while
often eliminating the CD player. And do you really need a car with multiple
12V and USB outlets, to go with the multiple cup holders?
Overall, it seems as though at least some of the new features are just being
added as marketing features, or they really only provide a fraction of what could
easily be incorporated with the same hardware. For example, if a car has a rear
camera, why isn’t there an integral recording feature to an SD card? That way,
you would have a video recording of any rear-end collision. In fact, the car’s
OBD system could add in the info for speed, brake and throttle settings.
It also seems rather silly to see brand-new cars fitted with after-market dash
cameras. Why aren’t such cameras already built-in? Some cars do have a forward-facing camera but no recording feature; that’s just silly. Or if a car has
in-built GPS satnav, why doesn’t it give a readout of speed? Yes, in many cars
there would be a discrepancy between the speedo which is often optimistic
(under ADR specs) but the at same time the odometer is accurate. Why not the
speedo too?
And if some cars have lane departure warning, why don’t they have “lane
keeping assist” as well? This is an easy manufacturing upgrade for all cars with
electric steering. In fact, quite a few upmarket cars can be easily made to drive
autonomously – check out the YouTube videos of this with a stream of Hyundai Genesis saloons.
But there are other potential developments which seem to have well and truly
stalled. For example, what about electric braking? Is the conventional powerassisted hydraulic system, tied to the ABS and traction control systems still the
best way to go? It seems as though electric braking, with servo-controlled pistons on the disc brakes could potentially be superior. In fact, why not extend
some of the present dynamic energy recovery used in some cars for auto-start
and restart, to do virtually all the braking?
More radically, do we even need the rear window on cars? Recent styling trends
to smaller rear window glass have compromised rear vision anyway and if the
rear window glass was totally eliminated, it would reduce solar heating of the
car and the annoyances of cars with bright lights following too closely. In fact,
rear vision cameras could eliminate internal and external rear vision mirrors.
And whatever happened to the move to 42V systems? That makes even more
sense today with the greatly increased load on car electrical systems and the
weight reduction that is now possible with lithium batteries. A lithium battery
and a 42V (or close) system seems like a natural fit.
While all of this is going on, electric car sales are more or less going nowhere. This is only partly due to the current low price of fuel (which could easily change) but also relates to the lack of advantage of electric cars. Sure, you
don’t have to visit the petrol station and the cost of fuel (electricity) is quite
low but most of the few available electric cars have limited range and are quite
expensive compared to their internal combustion engine-powered equivalents.
Leo Simpson
siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
March 2016 3
MAILBAG
Letters and emails should contain complete name, address and daytime phone number. Letters to
the Editor are submitted on the condition that Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd may edit and has
the right to reproduce in electronic form and communicate these letters. This also applies to submissions to “Ask SILICON CHIP”, “Circuit Notebook” and “Serviceman”.
Beating the drum for
Australian-made products
It was great to read your story in the
January 2016 issue on Versatile Technology, regarding their manufacturing
facility in Australia and them doing so
well. Good on them.
It seems that there could be many
other interesting stories about Australian companies and their on-going success in producing all sorts of products.
It certainly belies the general belief
among a lot of people that Australia
“doesn’t make anything any more”.
Here at Altronics, we too have been
manufacturing products in Australia
at our Perth headquarters for many
years. We have a department dedicated to manufacturing our range of
“Redback” public address amplifiers
and associated equipment, thousands
of which are made each year.
These are installed in the premises of corporate customers such as
Bunnings, Masters Hardware, Coles,
Kmart, Dan Murphy’s, schools, hospitals, clubs and all manner of other
places and we also sell them overseas.
We know we could source similar
products from SE Asia but generally
these items fall way short of what is
expected here in Australia in terms
of quality, reliability and features. We
are so confident in our product quality
that we offer an industry-high 10-year
Solid state amplifiers
superior to valves
I am a long-time reader of your
magazine (my collection also includes Electronics Australia and the
last few editions of RTV&H) and this
is the first time I have been tempted
to drop you a line. I guess you can appreciate my interest in the Currawong
Valve Amplifier (SILICON CHIP, November & December 2014, January
2015) and the new valve preamplifier
in the January 2016 issue.
Having picked up the latest copy,
I fast-forwarded to the article, probably more for sentimental reasons
4 Silicon Chip
Binary fluid steam power
plants not mentioned
warranty on our locally made Redback
products.
We employ some very clever people, who design the products from
conception, including electronic and
mechanical design, through to the assembly process. Naturally, not everything is done in-house, as we outsource metal-work and PCB assembly
to local Perth specialists.
Further to our own manufacturing
department, Altronic’s parent company Altronic Distributors, supplies
hundreds of companies, large and
small Australia-wide, with its range of
components, connectors, transformers
and enclosures. All of these companies
are manufacturing a variety of niche
products and employing thousands of
tax-paying people. Now that must be
good for the country and the economy!
Brian Sorensen,
General Manager,
Altronic Distributors Pty Ltd,
Perth, WA.
than anything else, but I was stopped
in my tracks at all the (red) negative values for the operating voltages around the 12AX7s. I built up a
number of circuits using these valves
in the 1960s and was beginning to
wonder if you knew something that
I didn’t, until I checked all the component polarities which conformed
to expectations.
It’s interesting to revisit the old
technology and look at some fresh
concepts for power supplies but I
do not regret the passing of the thermionic valve with all its inefficiencies. Despite all the complexity, the
I have a few comments to make regarding Dr David Maddison’s series
of articles, the most recent appearing in the December 2015 issue and
concerning Super-Critical and UltraSuper-Critical Steam Power Plants.
I was somewhat astonished that he
made no mention of binary workingfluid power-plants as exemplified by
the Kalina Cycle and for which there
are several operational examples
around the world. So much so that I
actually wondered if Pt.2 was missing! These web links will fill you in:
www.physics.hmc.edu/~saeta/
courses/p80/oldwiki/files/16042.pdf
https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/
Kalina_cycle
As an aside, attempts to improve the
basic efficiency of steam boilers are not
restricted to utility power-plants, as
a most novel and by all accounts, effective system was trialled around the
mid 20th century (no doubt spurred on
by the rebels opposing the ‘dieselisation’ zealots fast encroaching on sacred
territory!) to improve (ie, reduce) the
fuel consumption of coal-fired steam
modern solid-state device is inherently more reliable and sounds pretty
good to my ears.
Keep up the good work. You guys
have been my unofficial textbook
over the years. I think my next project will be that nice BIG CLOCK you
have just finished describing.
Owen Goodrick,
Tauranga, NZ.
Comment: although not obvious at
first glance, the “minus” signs in
front of the voltages on the valve
preamp circuit are in fact “approximate” symbols. We’ll try to make
these easier to distinguish in future.
siliconchip.com.au
Professional PCB Fabrication Services
from China’s leading manufacturer
More professional | More reliable | Quick turnaround | Less cost
PCB fabrication up to 32 layers
Min. tracing/spacing to 3mil/3mil
Min. microvias to 0.1mm
Special PCBs-Aluminum, flex and HDI
Prototype to mass production
Small quantity full turnkey PCB assembly
www.pcbcart.com
sales<at>pcbcart.com
siliconchip.com.au
March 2016 5
Mailbag: continued
Helping to put you in Control
SparkFun Inventor’s Kit for Photon
Control your devices through
the cloud. The kit provides you
with the Photon RedBoard and
everything you need to hook up
and experiment with multiple
electronic circuits!
SKU: SFC-026
Price: $165.00 ea + GST
Wind Direction Sensor
The sensor scales the wind direction to a
0 to 5 VDC output. It can be
easily connected to a PLC/
SCADA system to provide
monitoring and control of
systems according to wind
direction. 12 to 30 VDC
powered.
SKU: FSS-012
Price: $170.00 ea + GST
Compact Ultrasonic Rangefinder
5 m range, compact, IP67 ultrasonic
rangefinder with 1 mm
resolution. Analog voltage, pulse
width and RS-232 serial outputs.
SKU: MXS-103
Price: $149.95 ea + GST
Digit-TL
Battery powered temperature
logger that can store up to 260k readings.
Up to 3 year battery life. 7 log intervals,
2 programmable alarm thresholds.
Download to .csv files
over USB to Windows
based computer. IP68
enclosure included.
SKU: LAJ-060
Price: $72 ea + GST
Back To Back Digital I/O
Two wireless I/O cards in
a pair. 2 x digital inputs
trigger two relays over the
wireless link. Additional
output to indicate comms
link status. 24 VDC
powered
SKU: KTA-307
Price: $299.00 ea + GST
Wireless MiniPixel Controller.
Based around the PICAXE18M2
microcontroller, this programmable
controller features include
wireless control, 3 analog/
digital inputs, 2 relays, a 4
position DIP switch and 2
potentiometers.
SKU: PIX-0042
Price: $99.50 ea + GST
High Accuracy Digital Compass
HCM508B digital magnetic compass.
Course accuracy better than
0.5 degrees at 0.1 degree
resolution. Housed in a rugged
IP67 aluminium enclosure.
SKU: SRS-220
Price: $949.00 ea + GST
For OEM/Wholesale prices
Contact Ocean Controls
Ph: (03) 9782 5882
oceancontrols.com.au
Prices are subjected to change without notice.
6 Silicon Chip
IR remote control
over Ethernet
I have TV sets in some bedrooms
and two living areas. Some of the
TVs have internet access and streaming while others have internet access and streaming by use of settop tuner/recorder units. As each
TV set or tuner/recorder unit provides different services, depending
on the brand, I wish to get a greater
choice but without having to purchase a number of set-top boxes for
each TV set.
Incidentally, the internet services offered for each brand change so
rapidly that I believe that it is better
to keep a good TV set with a good
display and simply buy new streaming units of various kinds which are
much cheaper and can be replaced
often and stay up to date.
The solution I wish to employ
involves mixing my off-air antenna signal with signals from various
set-top boxes and an Apple TV and
whatever else comes along to connect to services like Stan, Presto,
Foxtel, etc. With the appropriate
mixes and using different channel
frequencies out of each device and
with the appropriate amplifiers (and
digital modulators), I can transmit
over my coax distribution to all of
my TV sets. This will mean I will
only need one of each set-top unit
for the house which could be shared
by all of the TV sets. Aftermarket
remotes could be purchased fairly
cheaply to be placed with each TV.
The next issue is how to control
the set-top boxes remotely. There are
many wireless devices available but
they are expensive and unreliable in
big houses with lots of steel. Each
TV set has Ethernet/internet available. This would be necessary if one
hoped to stream to each TV set anylocomotives. Have a look at this link
on the Holcroft-Anderson Recompression Locomotive:
www.douglas-self.com/MUSEUM/
LOCOLOCO/holcroft/holcroft.htm
and this link to Wikipedia on advanced steam technology:
https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Ad-
way. What I seek are infrared sensors
to receive the IR signal at each TV
set and then transmit it over Ethernet and at the location where all the
set-top boxes are, with an IR transmitter relaying the signals.
There are a number of devices
which offer to do this over Cat5;
some even imply that they can be
compatible with the normal Ethernet network and even go through a
low number of switches.
However, what they do is not
clear. I am looking for a device which
will truly relay IR signals over standard Ethernet. In many places, I am
unable to lay Cat5 or Cat6 cable, particularly in the lower storey with a
slab and a second floor above it, so
that the internet is delivered to most
of the TV sets by wireless, hence the
need for true Ethernet.
This would be sufficient for my
purposes, however a bonus would
be if the units could also transmit
HDMI including sound, or composite and sound signals as well. Again,
there are many devices which handle Cat5 but not real Ethernet.
It occurs to me that there could
be many others who may wish to
achieve similar things and would
like a unit as I have suggested to
build. I believe this could probably
be done economically using Arduino components. Ethernet modules
are already available, as are infrared
sensors and transmitters.
Stan Condy,
via email.
Comment: what you propose sounds
like a good strategy but it may not
be easy to implement, both as far as
mixing the signals from the various
boxes with the off-air signal is concerned and then also having the remote signals passed back to the central location of all the boxes.
vanced_steam_technology#Holcroft_
and_Anderson
Referring to his previous article in
the November 2015 issue, concerning organic electronics, on page 18 he
makes reference to PVC. This material
was first discovered in 1838, “re-discovered” in 1872, then formally idensiliconchip.com.au
tified and patented in 1913. It is interesting that one of its first early uses
was to for “protective” outer-suits, as
worn by conscripted foreign workers
employed in Japan’s chemical weapons arsenal in the 1930s.
Andre Rousseau,
Papakura, NZ.
David Maddison comments: I have
spent some time looking at this and
believe the Kalina cycle is good for
utilising low-grade heat such as in
geothermal production or waste heat
recovery. This is where the power stations based on this cycle are used but
they are very low power, such as 4MW.
Because of its lower working temperature, it cannot reach the high temperatures of steam used in primary
electricity production. This is why it is
not used in large-scale power plants,
many of which have been designed
since the development of the Kalina
cycle in 1984.
Over-wind solution for
transformer over-voltage
Regarding the enquiry by D. L., in
the Ask SILICON CHIP pages of the January 2016 issue, on excessive voltage for
SC480 amplifier, I thought I would offer a solution I have used several times
to “adjust” toroid voltages. It simply
involves adding turns by hand over the
wrapped windings, usually equating
to around 0.4V per turn.
Then you simply add or subtract the
“wound-on” voltage by series-wiring
to the secondary, either in phase or out
of phase, to add or subtract the voltage. In the case of D. L, two windings
will allow one for each half of centre
tap, and in this case only about five or
six turns each would do it. Just make
sure the windings that are added are
GPS in-dash
satnav limitations
I write in response to the recent
Mailbag discussion relating to why
in-dash satnavs are more costly, updated much less frequently and are
often less capable than standalone
units.
First, standalone units have a short
development to production timeline;
as little as six months. The most they
have to worry about is getting the
data sources’ licensing signed off as
quickly as possible. Even so, frequent
and plentiful updates are warranted
just on sheer numbers.
A vehicle is a very different beast.
Sections of the vehicle design could
see 10 years before production. Then,
not only is the electronics not “just”
for satnav, but for pretty much all of
at least the same gauge as the original
secondary.
Alasdair McCarter,
Glen Huon, Tas.
Question on
hybrid solar system
I am a regular reader of your magazine and your article about the Hybrid
Solar System, in the October 2015 issue, was excellent. Good on Geoff
Woodman for designing a great system and giving you the opportunity
to feature it in SILICON CHIP magazine.
What I would like to know is how the
system synchronises to the grid when
power is restored after a blackout?
Gerard Gibbons,
Buff Point, NSW.
Geoff Woodman replies: the contactor solenoid is powered from the grid,
and must be energised for the system
the processor-mandated functions
the car is capable of.
As the electronics is updated to
deal with new features the vehicle
may have, the end user has to trust
the satnav functionality is backward
compatible with new data. Did the
vehicle manufacturer cater for this?
“Good luck with that”, as the saying goes.
And the editor is correct, in stating on page 8 of the February 2016 issue, that in-dash units are prevented
from showing speed. One could say
this is because you’re doubling functionality but the cynic in me says it
would only show-up the sometimes
glaringly incorrect speedo needle indication.
John Tzerkeris,
Croydon Park, NSW.
to be connected to the grid. If there
is a grid outage, the contactor drops
out, isolating the island grid, and reconnection is only possible once the
grid is restored.
More on how a
loudspeaker operates
With regard to the discussion in the
Ask SILICON CHIP pages of the February
2016 issue, about how a loudspeaker
operates, at very low frequencies the
speaker cone displacement will in fact
follow the instantaneous voltage as described. But at somewhat higher frequencies, the velocity of the cone follows the voltage. That is to say, when
a sinewave drive voltage reaches its
peak, the cone is going through the
mechanical zero crossing at maximum
velocity, just like a pendulum at the
lowest point of its swing.
Adafruit FEATHER - the new standard for portable projects
• Arduino-compatible with USB interface
• All boards measure 51 x 23mm
• On-board LiPo battery interface
• 8-bit and 32-bit microcontroller options
• Secure WiFi, Bluetooth LE, ESP8266 …
• All boards and accessories in stock
Local stock! • $5 delivery • Visit tronixlabs.com.au/sc
PO Box 5435 Clayton 3168 - 0488 TRONIX - support<at>tronixlabs.com
siliconchip.com.au
March 2016 7
Mailbag: continued
Two-foot driving
negates the QuickBrake
I read the article on your new
QuickBrake project in the January
2016 issue and am wondering if the
idea is based on a false assumption.
If I understand it correctly, it relies on the delay between lifting your
right foot off the accelerator and applying the brake with the same foot.
This assumes that everyone uses this
same driving technique and I am
referring to driving a vehicle with
automatic transmission. Some drivers, and I am one of them, use two
feet when driving; the left to operate the brake and the right for the
accelerator.
In this case, is it not possible that
the brake is applied before the accelerator is released? We are talking
about milliseconds here after all.
Would QuickBrake still operate in
these circumstances or with the same
improvement in delay time?
Syd Read,
Hastings, Vic.
Comment: some people do drive
like that and in some cases they
sometimes actually drive with their
foot lightly on the brakes while they
still have their right foot on the ac-
The cone displacement would be
lagging the voltage by 90°. One might
expect that this peak velocity produces peak pressure in open air, a derivative of the velocity, so the voltage
ends up producing a corresponding
air pressure. I’m sure there is more to
it than that.
It reminds me of a “Let’s Buy An Argument” column in Radio TV & Hobbies way back, regarding what shape of
groove would be needed on a phonograph record for a magnetic cartridge
to produce a square wave. The answer
was a triangular wave. So too, a sinewave record groove would produce
a sinewave but phase-shifted by 90°.
Graham Pratt,
Hampton Park, Vic.
Comment: you have raised an interesting point. In fact, the motion of
the loudspeaker cone will certainly
be modified by the complex load pre8 Silicon Chip
celerator. This is a generally a bad
technique because it can lead to increased fuel use and brake pad wear,
and it gives a misleading indication
to a following driver. It could also
mean that the QuickBrake would be
largely negated; it would not work
because the brakes are already applied! Not that any extra harm would
be done.
On the other hand, if your left foot
is not actually on the brake, it is possible that your reaction time in lifting your right foot off the accelerator and then applying the brake with
your left foot may still be quite long.
Without doing some controlled tests,
it is not possible to say what improvement the QuickBrake might give in
this situation.
However, we suspect that the time
to actually apply the brake (and the
brake lights) with your left foot may
still be quite a bit longer than the
action of the QuickBrake. It might
even be longer than if you drive in
“single-footed” mode. Think about
it: in order to approach the actuation time of the QuickBrake, your left
foot would need to apply the brakes
before you have fully lifted your foot
off the accelerator.
sented by the speaker to the amplifier and that includes the effects of the
crossover network and the enclosure
itself. And the previous discussion
also ignores the effects of cone breakup, wave propagation in the cone and
interference effects between the various drivers in enclosure.
As far as the recorded waveform necessary to obtain a square signal from
a magnetic cartridge is concerned, the
answer is somewhat more complex
than a “triangular wave”. It is true that
the RIAA equalisation circuitry necessary for magnetic cartridges can be regarded as a differentiator. And it is true
that if you feed a triangular waveform
signal into a differentiator, the output
will be a square wave.
In reality though, the RIAA equalisation characteristic (with the IEC modification) has four time constants of
7950µs (20Hz), 3180µs (50Hz), 318µs
(500Hz) and 75µs (2122Hz). This
means that the shape of the groove
waveform will not only be more complex than a simple triangular waveform but will also have quite a different shape at lower frequencies.
These days, a simulation could easily produce the actual waveforms.
QuickBrake revisions
& refinements
The QuickBrake project featured
in January 2016 issue is a great idea
but its potential to reduce rear-end
collisions is significantly reduced by
the conditions under which it won’t
trigger.
Here are some ideas for QuickBrake
V3. The primary purpose of brake
lights is to reduce the chances of a
rear-end collision. Having the brake
lights illuminate when the driver steps
on the brake pedal is an incomplete
implementation of this purpose. The
QuickBrake improves on this simplistic idea by detecting other reasons for
the car slowing.
What if we step away from the actions of the driver and decide that
the brake lights should flash or come
on when the following vehicle has a
following distance of less than three
seconds? Then even if our car isn’t
slowing at all, if another vehicle approaches too closely from behind, the
other driver will receive a clear warning to slow down.
This would require a reasonably
sophisticated sensor to reliably detect the distance to the following car
(up to 92 metres for a 3-second gap at
110km/h). In particular, cars travelling in other lanes would have to be
ignored. It may also not be legal or
desirable to use the brake lights this
way, since they might tend to flash a
lot and lose their impact.
In this case, I suggest that the QuickBrake could provide signalling additional to the existing brake lights.
Something like a large scrolling LED
sign mounted in the rear window that
can display messages like, “Thank you
for keeping your distance” and “Gas
cylinders on board. Please increase
your following distance to at least
three seconds” (the latter message is
a little tongue-in-cheek, but it might
make an aggressive driver back off out
of self-interest).
siliconchip.com.au
ICOM2007
PROFESSIONAL
SYSTEM
SOLUTIONS
IC-F1000 / F2000 SERIES
Introducing the IC-F1000/F2000 series VHF and UHF analogue transceivers!
The IC-F1000/F2000 series is a compact portable radio series with convenient
features such as built-in motion sensor, inversion voice scrambler, channel
announcement and IP67 waterproof and dust-tight protection.
To find out more about Icom’s Land Mobile products email sales<at>icom.net.au
WWW.ICOM.NET.AU
siliconchip.com.au
March 2016 9
Mailbag: continued
a considerably more complex design
involving a LIDAR or radar sensor to
compute the distance to the following
vehicle, a GPS module or other means
of measuring speed and so on. Whether such a system would work on curves
is problematic as the rear-facing sensor is unlikely to be steerable.
Standing power measurements for
air-conditioning seem very high
I refer to a letter in the Mailbox
pages of the February 2016 edition,
page 10, from Rodney Champness,
regarding split system air-con units
in standby mode. The measurements
quoted seem unbelievable for a modern-day appliance; hundreds of dollars per year in consumption whilst
not operating!
I take it that the air-conditioner
unit was just ready to run on pressing the “Start” button on the remote
hand-set, and the air-conditioner’s
modern innovation of a variable
speed and capacity compressor, was
not already up and running, quietly,
in the background?
I connected my “Watts Clever”
meter in circuit with my recentlyinstalled Fujitsu split air-con system, of the same 7100 watts cooling
capacity mentioned in the contributor’s letter, with the system previously switched off using the remote
hand-set “Stop” button. The readIf the QuickBrake detects that the
following vehicle is less than three
seconds away, a warning could also
be displayed to us to enable evasive
action to be taken, including pulling
over to allow the tailgater to pass, or
at least increasing our own following
distance.
If we have gone to the trouble of
designing this thing to detect the car
behind, it should then be a straightforward matter to apply it to the car
Unsteady hands make
SMDs difficult to solder
ing was typically around 7-9W. Last
summer, when I completed the installation, that reading was 8W on
a 35°C day!
By the way, I’ve found the Jaycar
“Watts Clever” inexpensive digital
power meter to be acceptably accurate, when compared to nameplate
values on various appliances and
taking into consideration that my
mains voltage is a bit on the high
side, ie, around 252VAC at low demand times, or with all those PV
panels around.
Robert Sebire,
Emerald, Vic.
in front, to give the driver a warning
if our following distance is too small.
In this case, the minimum following
distance could be the greater of three
seconds and six seconds, minus the
following distance of the car behind
us, to minimise our risk of becoming
the meat in a metal sandwich.
Andrew Partridge,
Ermington, NSW.
Comment: we like your concept for
QuickBrake V3 but that would require
I wonder if you can offer any assistance for older people where their
hands have an unfortunate tendency
to shake when performing fine tasks,
although they may be quite steady under most conditions? Whilst this lack
of steadiness sometimes shows itself
during some of my finer electronics
construction, I have accumulated an
assortment of clamps, vices, brackets
and the like with which to accomplish
assembly.
In my working lifetime I have gone
from computers using relays and
Boolean logic to microprocessors so I
recognise the inevitable march of progress and generally applaud it. However, in contemplating the move from
through-hole to surface-mount techniques, I am concerned about soldering even the simple passive devices,
let alone multi-pin ICs. I should not
like to abandon my electronics hobby
so I need to find some way to move to
the next generation of the technology.
I have read the articles published
in your magazine regarding surfacemount soldering techniques, stereo
microscopes and the like but I could
find little reference to component
holding techniques and other aids for
people with unsteady hands.
Therefore my question is: are there
tel: 08 8240 2244
Standard and modified
diecast aluminium, metal
and plastic enclosures
www.hammondmfg.com
10 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
such aids to assembly which can assist people with the
transition to surface-mount technology and can you suggest where I might find them?
Barrie Davis,
Hope Valley, SA.
Comment: this is a widespread problem and not confined
to older people. If other readers have worked out solutions,
we would love to know about them.
The Easiest Way to Design Custom
Front Panels & Enclosures
More on
balanced cables
In the Ask SILICON CHIP pages of the February 2016 issue there is a letter from P. J. about an earth hum problem
with his laptop and a venue’s PA system/amplifier. This
is a problem I have encountered many times in church
set-ups with laptops, PCs and VCRs & DVD players, etc.
Basically, anything not designed for the pro audio desk
with a 230VAC supply may cause earth noises and hum.
With respect to P. J., I think he may be trying to over-think
the issues. While a good DI box will almost always solve
the problem, most laptops and many hall type PA systems
do not have balanced inputs or outputs. Going to optical
isolation is way too complicated.
My recommendation to P. J. would be to search for “Audio Isolator” on eBay and he will find a range of cheap
isolating units complete with plugs and cables for his
laptop. This one is less than $10: www.ebay.com.au/itm/
Car-Accessory-3-5mm-AUX-Audio-Ground-Loop-Isolator-Noise-Filter-Killer-Pop-/231540622385
While I have not bought this one, we have several similar ones in our church set-up and they all work well!
I would also carry a range of plugs and adapters for
balanced and unbalanced and a DI box but just the eBay
isolator above and a 3.5-6.35mm adapter will solve most
problems on over 90% of the systems I have seen.
Russell Martyn,
Adelaide, SA.
You design it
to your specifications using
our FREE CAD software,
Front Panel Designer
●
●
●
●
We machine it
and ship to you a
professionally finished product,
no minimum quantity required
Cost effective prototypes and production
runs with no setup charges
Powder-coated and anodized finishes in
various colors
Select from aluminum, acrylic or provide
your own material
Standard lead time in 5 days or express
manufacturing in 3 or 1 days
FrontPanelExpress.com
suggested by SILICON CHIP, the tube’s amplification would
drop to nearly zero, because a current sink or source has
a very high impedance to AC and any changes in plate
current for any grid drive voltage would be eliminated.
So if that was used, to get any amplification, the current
sink would have to be bypassed, just like a cathode resiswith 1an electrolytic capacitor.
Silicon Chip ad 120mmx87mmtor,
APR15.indd
Biasing a class-A or
What is needed is a “voltage source” which has a low
any valve amplifier
internal resistance to AC. But it is actually illogical to
I’m sure you will have received a number of remarks
place it in the cathode circuit anyway because it is then
about J. C. from point Cook Vic, who asked a question
in series with the tube’s load and subtracting from the
in the January 2016 issue about biasing a class-A tube
available HT voltage. J. C.’s intuition was correct as he
audio amplifier. He wanted to do cathode bias with an
was worrying about the cathode circuit being in series
electronic control, not a variable resistor. A current sink
with the output transformer.
was suggested by SILICON CHIP but this is not a good idea.
The tube bias is set by the grid-to-cathode potential.
Let’s look at some issues. One advantage of using a resisSo it is much better to add the required voltage source
tor for cathode bias is that it results in negative feedback,
in series with the tube’s grid to ground return resistor
both AC and DC. From the DC perspective, this tends to
in the ground end, as a negative voltage. This is called
stabilise the average cathode current for different tube
“fixed bias”. The advantages are many. The tube’s cathspecimens to a more similar value.
ode can be grounded (making better use of the available
However, to maintain the stage gain, it is usually necHT voltage), it eliminates any heat dissipation from the
essary to bypass the resistor with an electrolytic capacicathode resistor and the bias supply need not be able to
tor, typically 22µF to 47µF, to eliminate the AC composupply significant current as the tube’s grid current is
nent of the negative feedback, or degeneration, caused by
usually negligible.
the cathode resistor. On the down-side, the DC voltage
In vintage battery radios and amplifiers, for example,
or “bias voltage” developed across the resistor subtracts
bias batteries were used to supply negative grid biases as
from the available HT voltage which reduces the maxievery HT volt came at a premium due to the cost of batmum power output.
teries. The bias batteries lasted for their shelf life.
If a current sink was placed in the tube’s cathode, as
There are many other ways to get this negative voltsiliconchip.com.au
March 2016 11
4/9/1
Mailbag: continued
Solar systems need
more panels
I found Steve’s Lansell’s letter in
the Mailbag pages of the January 2016
issue to be spot-on. I have worked
through similar issues myself. My
initial solar system consisted of a
5kW inverter “matched” with 5kW of
solar panels and this was increased
two years ago to 7.5kW. Monitoring
of my ROI (return on investment)
showed an improvement of 33% for
the 50% solar panel increase.
I can monitor my installation at:
http://pvoutput.org/intraday.
jsp?id=30164&sid=27624
When solar power exceeds inverter power, the MPPTs (maximum
power point trackers) in the inverter
raise the working voltage of the array until it reaches the roll-off point,
the efficiency of the array is reduced,
and the array produces less power.
Inverter temperature on hot sunny
days has been reduced by the addition of 24V fans controlled by a 45°C
Jaycar thermostat.
A Raspberry Pi has been used with
a program called SBFSpot for the
last two years to access my inverter, and upload the data to the above
website. A “Clever Watts” EW4008,
connected to another Raspberry Pi,
was hooked up three months ago to
capture my household consumption and upload it as well. The accuracy of the EW4008 was poor and
it was replaced with a $40 Eastron
SDM220-modbus electricity meter
to give very accurate data.
age. One is to place a resistor (R) in
the ground return of the amplifier’s
HT supply, where the average HT current is I, so that the IR voltage drop
is available as a negative bias. It can
be filtered and a control added. Or it
could be made available from one of
the power transformer’s windings with
additional rectifiers.
Another simple way, if 12V DC is
present, is to wire up any convenient IC as an oscillator, like a 555, running above the audio spectrum, say
at 30kHz, and put a diode-capacitor
voltage multiplier on that using 1µF
12 Silicon Chip
A web server on the Pi allows me
access to live data on the SDM220
from any internet connected device.
A screen dump is below:
The PVOutput website is designed
primarily for grid-connected systems but it is still very useful for
off-grid sites. My daughter, son-inlaw, and their children live off-grid
and rely on solar, wind and diesel
for their power. I have set up a Raspbery Pi at their location, equipped
with an ADC shield from ABElectronics in England. Their system is
basically 12V, with 12V-to-230VAC
inverters. The ADC on the RPi gets
its “current” inputs from three 150A
Allegro ACS758s.
PVOutput allows extended data
points to be used for a small donation. This allows for the generation
capacitors and 1N4148 diodes. Or
just buy a pre-made DC:DC converter
module (they would need additional
output filtering as they are often good
noise sources).
In any event, fixed bias is the superior way to go but unlike resistorcathode bias it does sometimes require
individual adjustments for individual
tubes and needs to be tweaked for tube
ageing. But in many cases, adjustments
are not needed at all once it is set for
a specific tube type.
Perhaps I should also mention that
some tube amplifier designers have a
to be split into solar and wind. At
present, diesel charging is combined
with the wind.
PVOutput has rules that ensure
“generation” power figures are not
higher than the system size. There
is no option in PVOutput to add the
wind component to the system size,
so the solar size had to be doubled
to ensure that the total generation
figures would not be rejected.
Again, a web server on this remote
RPi is very useful. Below is a screen
dump from my phone:
This remote RPi also sends my
son-in-law (and me) an email every
morning with a summary of the last
six days of data. This is very useful
to get an idea on how the batteries
are holding up, without having to log
onto PVOutput.
I have glossed over the many,
many hours spent writing Python
scripts to do all the things mentioned
above. My Python programming ability is basic at best and my scripts are
messy but they work.
Sid Lonsdale,
Cairns, Qld.
fondness for using a cathode resistor
un-bypassed (no capacitor across the
cathode resistor in class-A tube output
stages); the degeneration and negative
feedback lowers the distortion and of
course, the gain. Also some push-pull
stages use cathode signal coupling so
they cannot have a bypass.
There is one application with tubes
though where it is folly not to use a
cathode-bypass electrolytic capacitor. That is for a tube in the front end
of an amplifier (high gain), typically
with a magnetic cartridge phono input, for example, like an EF86, 5879
siliconchip.com.au
or EF37A where the heater is run from
the usual 6.3VAC.
In this case, small amounts of heater
cathode leakage in the tube can cause
significant audible hum and the cathode bypass capacitor is always needed
for that reason. A lot of modern tube
amplifier makers run the heaters from
DC, so it’s not a worry in that case.
Hugo Holden,
Maroochydore, Qld.
Light curtain
clarification
I have received my copy of the December 2015 issue which features my
circuit for a Light Curtain to prevent
garage door damage, on pages 88 &
89. Unfortunately, the description of
the Light Curtain is incorrect and this
mistake will make it hard for readers
to understand its operation.
The mistake involves the operation of the IR receivers. At no time do
siliconchip.com.au
their outputs go low and stay low. The
output is a 1kHz square-wave when
there is no obstacle in the way of the
infrared beam and it goes high and
stays high if the beam is broken. The
detectors feed Q1 and it is its output
that goes low and stays low when the
beam is broken.
Alan Chamberlain,
Charlestown, NSW.
Practical solution to
blown headlights
On page 94 of the January 2016 issue, there is a request for an overvoltage protector to prevent car head
lights from blowing frequently. This
reminds me of a nephew’s car with
a similar problem, which was due to
poor connection between the H4 globe
and the socket, causing over-heating
of the filament.
The problem was solved by tightening up the spring connectors or replac-
ing the socket on the wiring loom and
resoldering wires.
John Murphy,
Glen Waverley, Vic.
Comment on
Speech Timer project
Like your author, I too have seen
some “interesting” timers used in contests, with some of the mains-powered
ones verging on the illegal!
However, if I was the chief judge in a
contest where the SILICON CHIP Speech
Timer was being used, I would insist
that the display not be visible to the
audience, as it would be too easy for
a member to communicate (whether
knowingly or not) the elapsed time
to the contestant. The actual speech
time is confidential to just a few officials and Toastmasters International
can be quite strict at times.
Dave Horsfall,
SC
North Gosford, NSW.
March 2016 13
QUANTUM
COMPUTERS
“No, you’re not going to
be able to understand it...
You see, my physics students
don’t understand it either.
That is because I don’t
understand it. Nobody does...
The theory of quantum
electrodynamics describes
Nature as absurd from the
point of view of common
sense. And it agrees fully
with experiment. So I hope
you can accept Nature
as She is – absurd.”
(Nobel laureat Richard Feynman, 1985)
Quantum computers are based on a different type of architecture to
conventional computers and can solve problems using the strange
properties of quantum mechanics such as superposition and
entanglement.
By Dr David Maddison
I
n recent times computers have become enormously
powerful and can be used to solve extremely complicated problems such as in fluid dynamics. But the architecture of conventional computers is unsuited for certain classes of problems.
Solving those problems would take impractically long
periods of time or be altogether impossible.
Examples of problems that quantum computers could
or should be good at solving include simulation of quantum mechanical systems. For example, it may be possible
to accurately simulate interactions that occur in a particle
accelerator such as the large Hadron Collider. Chemical re14 Silicon Chip
actions could also be simulated including extremely complex ones like photosynthesis.
New drugs could also be developed more quickly because
large numbers of configurations of drug molecules could
be evaluated quickly and the ones most likely to work selected for further testing.
They could be used for breaking of certain types of encryption codes (with Shor’s algorithm, for example) or
searching very large unsorted databases (with Grover’s algorithm). A classic example given is searching a phone book
for a certain phone number when the name is not known.
If a book had one million numbers it could be searched in
siliconchip.com.au
one thousand steps with a quantum computer instead of
on average one half million steps as with a conventional
computer and a naive search method!
Weather forecasting and climate models are other possible uses. There are huge numbers of ways that different
parts of a weather or climate system can interact. A quantum computer could analyse all possibilities at once and
find the optimal answer.
Travel routes and schedules could be quickly optimised.
For example, for the classic “travelling salesman problem”
the order of which cities to visit in order to minimise the
distance travelled and not to visit any city twice could be
quickly evaluated. A commercial quantum computer, the
D-Wave Vesuvius solved such a problem in less than half
a second compared with a conventional computer which
took 30 minutes.
Other possible uses include machine learning, pattern
recognition, image classification and analysis, optimisation problems, quantum communication for guaranteed
privacy and quantum teleportation where information is
transferred from one quantum system to another with no
wires, radio or light transmission.
Note that quantum computers are unlikely to replace the
computers we use now but will coexist with them and be
used only for the types of problem they are best at solving.
Quantum mechanics
Before discussing how a quantum computer works it is
first necessary to discuss some basic principles of quantum mechanics. Quantum mechanics is a branch of physics
that describes the behaviour of the very small objects such
as atoms, sub-atomic particles and photons and is distinct
from traditional classical mechanics that describes the behaviour of larger scale objects.
In classical mechanics, objects exist in a specific and
definite place and time, something we are all used to. But
in quantum mechanics, particles exist in a “cloud of probability” so that the location of a particle is described by a
probability distribution.
In addition, in quantum mechanics, particles are restricted to certain particular values of properties such as
how much energy they have or a property known as spin
The probability distribution
of an electron in a particular
orbital of an atom. The darker
the “cloud”, the higher the
probability of finding the
electron. It does not have an
orbit analogous to a
planet orbiting the sun
as in the traditional
simplistic view that
many people are
familiar with
although electrons
will have the
highest probability of being
at certain energy
levels. For a further
explanation of energy levels
in atoms see SILICON CHIP,
November 2015, page 17.
(Image credit: RJ Hall)
siliconchip.com.au
How safe is encryption against attack by
a Quantum Computer?
It has been claimed that quantum computers will be able to break
certain types of cryptography by their ability to factor large numbers which are the basis of certain types of encryption schemes.
Schemes claimed to be at risk include those based on symmetric key algorithms (block cyphers) and asymmetric public key
algorithms (RSA, DSA, ECC).
Acknowledging the risk, the US National Security Agency has
already announced it will be moving toward using encryption
schemes which are resistant to attack by quantum computers.
It should be noted that for the foreseeable future, there are
no conceivable realistic quantum computers that are able to
come close to factoring the numbers required to break the above
schemes (when the key length is long enough) so they should be
safe for a long time.
For example, using Grover’s algorithm to factor a large number
would enable the calculation to be done in the square root of the
time taken by a classical computer (say 10 days instead of 100
days) but the security of the encryption could be maintained if the
key length were doubled which is relatively easy to do.
where a particle must be either “up” or “down”, much like
the north or south on a compass.
The values of the properties of particles are regulated like
the clicks on a dial and are said to be quantised. Another
main property of quantum mechanics is that elementary
particles sometimes act like waves and at other times like
particles, so-called “wave-particle” duality.
There is also the uncertainty principle which states that
for a given particle we cannot measure with precision its
properties of both position and its momentum. The more
accurately one value is known, the less accurately the other
is known. In fact, accurately knowing these two properties
together is a meaningless concept in nature.
Any attempt at measurement of one property will alter
the other property of the particle so it is impossible to ever
know both values. Incidentally, this uncertainty also applies to macroscopic objects but is so small as to be of no
consequence, eg, the uncertainty of position of a thrown
cricket ball would be around 10-30mm.
Superposition is the condition whereby a particle can be
in a combination of two or more quantum states simultaneously. For example, rather than having a spin of “up” or
“down”, an electron can be (3/5) up or (4/5) down. In this
case, the RMS sum of the coefficients must remain as one.
If up and down corresponded to the binary numbers zero
and one we would say (simplistically) that it partially had
the values of zero and one at the same time. Any attempt to
read or measure the value of the particle, however, causes
its quantum state to collapse or de-cohere into one of the
values it possesses such as a “one” and superposition is
lost. This phenomenon is known as quantum decoherence.
While superposition is a characteristic of one-particle
systems, a property that pairs or groups of particles can
have is entanglement. In this case the quantum state of
the pair or group is described collectively as it is shared
and it is not possible to describe the state of an individual
particle independently.
Consider a pair of entangled particles which are known
to have a total spin of zero. These entangled particles are
March 2016 15
SOME SIGNIFICANT DEVELOPMENTS IN THE HISTORY OF QUANTUM COMPUTING
There are far too many developments relevant to quantum computers to list them all here, so only a selection is given.
1975
RP Poplavskii showed the impossibility of simulating quantum systems on classic computers due to superposition.
1976
Roman Stanisław Ingarden published work on quantum information theory.
1980
Yuri Manin proposed the idea of a quantum computer in his work “The computable and the non-computable” (in Russian).
1981
Richard Feynman said in a talk that it seemed impossible to simulate quantum systems on classical computers and proposed a basic theoretical model
for a quantum computer. For those interested they can read a transcript of this talk at www.cs.berkeley.edu/~christos/classics/Feynman.pdf
1982
Paul Benioff proposed a comprehensive theoretical model for a quantum computer.
1985
David Deutsch described a theoretical model of universal quantum computer that can be used to model other quantum computers and the algorithms
they use.
1991
Artur Ekert invents secure communication based on quantum entanglement.
1993
Dan Simon invents a problem that would be exponentially faster for a quantum computer to solve than a classical one.
1994
Peter Shor, incorporating Dan Simon’s ideas from above, discovers a method to factor large integers quickly. The factoring of large integers is the basis
of many modern cryptography systems such as credit card transactions and this algorithm could theoretically break many such systems. This lead to a
tremendous interest in quantum computation.
1995
Peter Shor and Andrew Steane propose a method for quantum error correction. Also Christopher Monroe and David Wineland experimentally produce
the first quantum logic gate based on a trapped atom.
1996
Lov Grover invents a quantum algorithm to search databases that is much faster than would be achievable on classic computers. David P. DiVincenzo
published a list of the physical requirements for a quantum computer.
1998
First demonstration of a quantum algorithm run on a two qubit quantum computer. First three qubit quantum computer invented. Grover’s algorithm
(1996) run on quantum computer.
2000
First five qubit and then seven qubit quantum computer and also partial execution of Shor’s algorithm (1995).
2001
Full execution of Shor’s algorithm (1995) to factor the number 15.
2002
Quantum Computation Roadmap developed to facilitate the future development of quantum computation. The document is constantly updated.
See http://qist.lanl.gov/qcomp_map.shtml
2003
The US Defense Advanced Research Projects Agency (DARPA) implements a quantum network using optical fibres to transmit information securely
using entangled photons. Any attempt to improperly intercept the data will result in a loss of entanglement of the photons and an inability to read the
data. Also the University of Queensland demonstrate quantum NOT gates.
2005
First quantum byte created, known as a qubyte.
2006
First 12 qubit quantum computer.
2007
Commercial company D-Wave Systems announce working 28 qubit quantum computer.
2008
Qubits based on graphene quantum dots. D-Wave Systems announce working 128 qubit quantum computer chip.
2009
Qubits with lifetimes of hundreds of milliseconds. Google and D-Wave Systems collaborate in the area of using quantum computation for image searches.
2010
Single electron qubit demonstrated.
2011
D-Wave produces first commercial quantum computer. Error correction in quantum processor developed. Decoherence minimised using high magnetic
fields. Record low error rates are achieved for a quantum computer. An error rate of one in 10,000 logic operations was considered a benchmark target
but a rate of one in 50,000 was achieved. A group at the University of New South Wales and the University of Tokyo achieve a breakthough in quantum
teleportation, successfully transmitting quantum information without error or affecting the superpositions of qubits.
2012
D-Wave produced quantum computer with 84 qubits. Single atom transistor developed. 1QB Information Technologies founded, the world’s first company
to write quantum computer software. See www.1qbit.com/ Decoherence was kept suppressed for 2 seconds. A group at the University of New South
Wales develop the first qubit based on a single atom of silicon which would enable quantum computers to be built in silicon like conventional computers
with similar fabrication technology.
2013
Three billion qubits were held in a state of superposition for 39 minutes, exceeding the previous record of 2 seconds (2012).
2014
Leaked documents show that the US National Security Agency is interested in quantum computing for cryptography purposes. Quantum teleportation
demonstrated over 3 metres. This is necessary for a quantum-based Internet to make it secure and fast. The largest number ever factored on a quantum
computer was achieved, 56,153 exceeding the previous record of 143. University of New South Wales researchers embedded qubits in silicon to protect
them and give them longer decoherence times.
2015
D-Wave Systems announce a 1,000 qubit system. University of New South Wales researchers build the world’s first quantum logic gate in silicon.
16 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
The Titan supercomputer at the Oak Ridge National Laboratory, Tennessee, USA is the most powerful classical computer
in the Western world and the most powerful supercomputer that is freely accessible. It uses 18,688 AMD Opteron 6274
16-core CPUs and the same number of Nvidia Tesla K20X GPUs or graphics processing units. It has a benchmark of 17.59
petaFLOPs (where peta is 1015 or 1,000,000,000,000,000 and a FLOP is one floating point operation per second). The
computer runs the Cray Linux Environment and it consumes 8.2MW. There is a more powerful Tianhe-2 supercomputer
in China; however it uses US-made CPUs, is not freely accessible and has been criticised for its difficulty of use. Quantum
computers will not replace computers such as these but will supplement them.
in a state of superposition. If a measurement is made (thus
destroying superposition) on one particle and it is found
to have an up spin, for example, the other particle will
automatically acquire a down spin as the total spin of the
pair must be zero (an up spin plus a down spin).
The particle that is not measured changes its quantum
state as if to “know” a measurement has been made on
its partner. This happens no matter by what distance the
particles are separated and would happen even if the particles were at opposite ends of the universe.
Furthermore, the change is instantaneous, not propagated at the speed of light as might be expected. The information travels at an infinite speed, although it cannot be
used for faster-than-light communication. Einstein called
this phenomenon “spooky action at a distance” and felt
it meant that the description of reality by quantum mechanics was incomplete.
Bits and Qubits
The basic unit of information in a conventional computer is the bit which can have a value of either zero or
one. It is typically physically implemented by the use of
a transistor which is in either an “off” or an “on” state
representing either zero or one or a capacitor which is
either charged or discharged. For 2015 the commercial
CPU with the largest number of transistors, 5.5 billion,
was Intel’s 18-core Xeon Haswell-EP.
A qubit is the quantum equivalent of a bit which when
read (measured) will result in an answer equivalent to 0
Bloch sphere diagram
representing a qubit.
x, y and z represent
the axes of the
sphere, the north
and south poles
represent the
basis states and
the represents
the superposition
of |0> and |1>.
and represent
angles. Image credit:
Glosser.ca [CC BY-SA 3.0]
siliconchip.com.au
or 1. Due to the principle of quantum superposition as explained above, the qubit can have a combination of these
values at the same time whereas a conventional bit must
be either zero or one but not both at any given time.
A qubit can be physically represented by the states of
various quantum particles such as the spin of electrons
(which are either up or down) or other quantum-dominated systems (see below).
A qubit is regarded as the superposition of two basis states
which are denoted mathematically as |0> and |1> (spoken
as ket 0 or ket 1) and are equivalent to 0 or 1 in classical
computing. While an ordinary bit in classical computing
can be represented in a diagram by either a simple 0 or 1
a qubit is a bit more complicated and is represented by a
Bloch Sphere as shown.
On the Bloch spere, the “north” and “south” poles represent the basis states of |0> and |1> which physically might
Simulating a Quantum Computer
without yet having one!
There are a lot of problems to solve with quantum computers
but algorithms and computer code still need to be developed to
solve these problems.
Microsoft have developed a software simulation tool called
LIQUi|> or Language-Integrated Quantum Operations (the symbols at the end a notation used in quantum computing) that
transforms a higher level computer language such as F# that is
coded to represent a quantum operation into one specific to low
level operations in quantum computers.
It allows researchers to write and develop quantum code on
conventional computers in the absence of access to full scale
quantum computers that Microsoft judges to be 10-20 years
away, notwithstanding the developments described here. If you
are interested in looking at this it can be downloaded free from
https://github.com/msr-quarc/liquid
That version allows for the simulation of up to 23 qubits.
Among specific algorithms that can be simulated and which are
included as examples are: simple quantum teleportation, Shor’s
factoring algorithm, quantum chemistry, computing the ground
state energy of a molecule, quantum error correction, quantum
associative memory and quantum linear algebra.
March 2016 17
represent spin up or spin down states. The superposition
of these states – the qubit - is represented by some point
anywhere on the sphere.
When the state of a qubit is measured there is a loss of
superposition and thus the system can no longer be in
two states simultaneously due to quantum decoherence.
The result is |0> or |1>, equivalent to 0 or 1 in classical
computing.
When multiple qubits exists in a system they can possess
the property of entanglement, mentioned above. This means
that, for example, a pair of entangled qubits will maintain
a relationship with each other so if one is measured (thus
causing quantum decoherence) and found to have a spin
up state, the other will automatically have a down spin.
Entanglement is one method by which multiple qubits
can be made to “work together” and thus solve more complex problems.
Information representation in bits and qubits
Consider the information that can be represented in a
2-bit system. Two bits can be represented as either 00, 10,
01 or 11. Two bits can therefore represent only one of four
different values and to use all four values in some given
computation the computer would have to execute at least
four cycles so that each value could be loaded and then
used in a calculation.
On the other hand, a 2-qubit quantum computer can
contain and utilise for a calculation all those four values
(above) simultaneously so only one computer cycle is necessary to operate on all four items of data.
In other words, two bits contain information about only
one value and two qubits contain information about four
values. In fact, quantum computers scale the information
that can be contained in the qubits exponentially according to 2n where n is the number of qubits.
A 4-qubit computer could, for example, simultaneously
hold sixteen values (24), ie, 0000, 0001, 0010, 0011, 0100,
0101, 0110, 0111, 1000, 1001, 1010, 1011, 1100, 1101, 1110
and 1111. In contrast, a conventional 4-bit computer could
store only one of those sixteen values and would have to
repeat an operation 16 times to do the same computation
SQUID as used for the
qubit in the D-Wave
quantum computer. The
horizontal arrows
represent the possible
directions of current
and the vertical arrows
represent the two
possible spin states, up
or down corresponding
to zero or one.
as the quantum computer could do just once.
A multiprocessor classical computer increases its power
directly in proportion to the number of processors it possesses. The ability for data representation to scale exponentially in a quantum computer compared to a classical
computer and subsequent processing of that data is a key
to its theoretical power, providing that can be implemented in a practical manner. In other words a quantum computer is not simply the same as a classical parallel processing computer.
What can be used as a qubit?
Almost any system that displays quantum mechanical
phenomena can be used as the basis of a qubit as long it is
capable of possessing two different quantum mechanical
states, such as spin up or spin down.
Any real quantum computer might have a combination
of different two state systems just as a classical computer
uses the state of a transistor in a CPU, capacitors in RAM,
the pit or absence thereof in optical media such as a DVD
or the state of a magnetic domain on a hard disk.
Systems proposed include but are not limited to:
electrons (spin up or down), light (amplitude or phase
“squeezed”), Josephson junction and SQUIDs (direction
of current), photon (vertically or horizontally polarised),
atomic nucleus (spin up or down), optical lattice (spin up or
down), quantum dot (spin up or down), graphene quantum
dot (spin up or down), trapped ion (state of ions), nuclear
magnetic resonance of liquid molecules (nuclear spin state)
and diamonds (nuclear spin of atomic vacancies). Note:
What would program code for a Quantum Computer look like?
Anyone who has learned to program has probably started
with a simple program such as the classic one that prints “Hello
world”. What would a very simple program on a quantum computer look like?
No one yet knows how quantum computers and their programming languages will evolve but it might look like the following.
Consider a quantum computer language with just four instructions N (create qubit), E (entangle qubit), M (measure qubit) and
X (execute operation). This program creates an ancilla, a special
bit used for quantum error correction, entangles it with the input
qubit, measures the input qubit and conditionally performs an operation on the ancilla.
After the operation, qubit 2 contains the state of qubit 1 after
a Hadamard transformation has been performed. A Hadarmard
transformation is a one qubit rotation whereby two qubit states
are mapped onto two superposition states with the same computational state as the original qubits (more generally it is a class of
Fourier transforms).
Note that this is very low level programming, equivalent to as18 Silicon Chip
sembly language in a conventional computer and coding would not
normally be done at such a low level – much higher level programming languages would be used.
N2
# create a new quantum bit and identify it as ‘2’
E 1 2 # entangle qubits ‘1’ and ‘2’, qubit 1 already exists
and is considered input
M 1 0 # measure qubit ‘1’ with an angle of zero
(angle can be anything in [0,2pi]
# qubit ‘1’ is destroyed and the result is either
True or False
# operations beyond this point can be dependent
on the signal of ‘1’
X 2 1 # if the signal of qubit ‘1’ is True, execute the
Pauli-X operation on qubit ‘2’
Reference: http://cstheory.stackexchange.com/questions/9381/
what-would-a-very-simple-quantum-program-look-like
siliconchip.com.au
This graph shows “Rose’s Law” demonstrating the steady increase in the number of qubits in the D-Wave quantum
computer which is analogous to Moore’s Law with the number of transistors in a classical computer,
SQUID is a superconducting quantum interference device.
Note that a qubit does not have to be physically small,
although that is desirable so many qubits can be placed
on one chip.
Basic elements of a quantum computer
A practical quantum computer must have certain basic
requirements (DiVincenzo’s criteria) some of which also
differ from a conventional computer as explained below.
1) It must be scalable to enable a reasonable number of qubits just as a conventional computer must have a reasonable number of bits for efficient operation.
2) The qubits must be able to be set to a common initial
state such as all zeros, just as are the bits in a conventional computer.
3) The state of the computer must be controllable using
universal gates such as quantum logic gates. They are
analogous to the logic gates in conventional digital computer circuits (but unlike in a conventional computer
they are reversible).
4) To enable logic operations to be performed by the logic
gates the decoherence times of the qubits must be long
enough for the gate operation to complete. Decoherence
can be suppressed by error correction techniques and
fault tolerant computation. The logic state of a conventional digital circuit will remain indefinitely but qubits
are inherently unstable and will eventually revert to an
alternative state. A stability time of somewhere between
nanoseconds and seconds is required.
5) There has to be a means to read the quantum state of the
processor. In quantum mechanics, the very act of taking
a reading or measurement will alter the state of the system. Conventional digital circuits can be read without
altering the state of the system.
siliconchip.com.au
Quantum decoherence
As mentioned above, quantum decoherence can happen
due to making a measurement or reading but it can also
happen for unwanted reasons and this represents one of
the greatest challenges of quantum computing.
A quantum system can decohere due to thermal vibrations in the atomic lattice (if a crystal-based system is used)
or other subatomic or macro scale phenomena. One partial solution is to cool the quantum processor to extremely
low temperatures in order to reduce thermal vibrations.
INTO MODEL RAILWAYS
IN A BIG WAY?
With lots of points, multiple tracks, reversing loops, multiple
locos/trains, – in other words, your model trains are more a
passion than just a hobby? Then you might be interested in
these specialised model train projects from March 2013
Automatic Points Controller
(Supplied with two infrared sensor boards)
(PCB 09103131/2)........................$13.50
Frog Relay Board (09103133)............$4.50
Capacitor Discharge for Twin-Coil Points
Motors (PCB 09203131)..................$9.00
See article previews at www.siliconchip.com.au
ORDER NOW AT
www.siliconchip.com.au/shop
March 2016 19
(Above): closeup of the D-Wave 1000 qubit quantum
processor.
(Right): D-Wave processor package mounted on dilution
refrigerator to keep it at a temperature close to absolute
zero.
Temperatures as low as 20mK or
twenty thousandths of a degree above
absolute zero are required. This corresponds to -273.15° Celsius and is much
colder than anywhere in the universe,
which doesn’t get much colder than
about 3° above absolute zero.
Cooling won’t necessarily remove
all instances of decoherence and it is
necessary to use quantum error correction to detect and reduce errors
however this comes at the cost of the
requirement for many more qubits in
the system.
Conventional computers, it should
be noted, also use extensive error correction to ensure they operate correctly
and in very early digital computers it
was necessary to run a program several times to ensure the same result
was obtained each time and if it was,
confidence could be had in the result!
Operation of a Quantum
Computer
To operate a quantum computer the
qubits are first set to an initial state representing the problem and then those
qubits are manipulated using quantum logic gates which are operated in
a sequence according to a quantum
algorithm.
Quantum logic gates are like logic
gates in classical computers (although
their operation is reversible). A quantum algorithm consists of the step-bystep instructions for solving the problem but is specifically designed to utilise features of the quantum computer
such as superposition and entangle20 Silicon Chip
ment. Algorithms from classical computers can also be implemented on a
quantum computer.
Two widely known quantum algorithms are Shor’s algorithm for factoring and Grover’s algorithm for searching unstructured databases.
Once a quantum computer has finished running an algorithm, a measurement of the qubits is made which
collapses the qubits into their basis
states, representing a zero or one to
yield the result.
Some quantum algorithms give the
correct answer only with a certain
probability and may give a different
result each time the algorithm is run!
This is the case with some algorithms
run on the D-Wave computer discussed next. When these algorithms
are run multiple times the most common result is likely to be the correct
one.
The commercial D-Wave
Quantum Computer
The only company making quantum
computers on a commercial basis is DWave Systems (www.dwavesys.com),
a Canadian company founded in 1999.
D-Wave’s computers run a very specialised type of process called quantum annealing which is used for solving problems involving optimisation
where a huge number of options are
reduced to the best choice.
One way to think of these problems
is to think of a metaphor involving a
vast landscape with many hills and
valleys. The object is to find the low-
est valley (the best choice) and the way
to do it is either to
1) survey the whole landscape by
walking up and down the hills looking for the lowest valley as a conventional computer would do or
2) use the quantum computer to effectively tunnel through the hills to
quickly find the lowest point.
The basis of the qubit in the D-Wave
computers is a SQUID or Superconducting QUantum Interference Device.
The device is made of a ring of superconducting niobium and a junction.
Current within the ring can flow in
one direction or the other, resulting in
magnetic spin states which are either
up or down although before measurement the device is in a superposition
of both states, effectively meaning
that the current flows in both directions at once.
The D-Wave computer quantum
processor must be kept at a temperature close to absolute zero to minimise
quantum decoherence and also to ensure that the SQUID devices can operate in their superconducting state. The
large size of the computer is primarily
due to the cooling equipment.
In the quantum annealing process,
the algorithm used to run calculations
tries to predict what states the qubits
will be in when the temperature of the
SQUIDs is increased, thus finding the
solution or set of solutions for the lowest point in the valley in the landscape
metaphor described above.
As mentioned previously, this computer does not necessarily give the
siliconchip.com.au
same answer to a problem if run a second time however the more answers it
repeatedly gives which are the same,
the greater the confidence one has in
the result.
D-Wave sees this as an advantage as
it assists in determining the confidence
the computer has in the result of complex computer-based decisions in machine learning applications.
The D-Wave computer is in use by
Google, NASA, Lockheed Martin and
others.
Google hopes to use the computer for image and news classification,
spoken word recognition, machine
learning and understanding natural
language and is doing research into
other possible uses.
The D-Wave computer has been criticised because it is not a “universal
quantum computer” meaning that it
cannot run any type of calculation but
is limited to just “combinatorial optimisation problems” and it thus cannot run Shor’s algorithm, for example.
Another criticism relates to whether
it truly is a quantum computer andwhether it uses entangled states.
The reality is that no one fully understands how it works in all aspects,
not even the designers, although it is
now generally agreed that it is indeed
a real quantum computer.
Other issues relate to questions of
how to benchmark the speed of such
a computer and compare it to classical computers.
Making single atom qubits, atomic wires
Australia is a world leader in aspects
of quantum computing.
The Centre of Quantum Computation and Communication Technology
(www.cqc2t.org/) is a collaboration
between The University of NSW, The
University of Melbourne, Australian
National University, Griffith University, The University of Queensland
and The University of Sydney.
It is undertaking work involving a
diverse area of quantum communication and quantum computing. One
(1) To make an image of an atomic structure
the probe of a scanning tunnelling microscope
(STM) is moved along the surface of a silicon
crystal and an image of the surface is obtained
by measuring a current flowing between the
crystal and the tip which varies according to
the position on the crystal surface. An STM
can also be used to manipulate single atoms
on the crystal surface. It is important to map
the crystal surface so the exact location of the
qubit is known.
22 Silicon Chip
(4) Phosphine gas, consisting of phosphorus
(red) and hydrogen, is introduced and the
molecule of gas settles in the place where
the two hydrogen atoms were removed.
(5) The phosphorus atom of the gas molecule
now lies on the surface of the silicon crystal.
Conclusions
The dream of quantum computing
has been around for a while and now
there is one type of specialised quantum computer in commercial production with major research in other areas
of quantum computing, with Australia
being a key player.
Quantum computers will not replace classical computers but will
supplement them by solving specialised types of problems for which they
are suited.
It is also important to distinguish
hyperbole from reality.
Most likely quantum computers will
be introduced slowly, at first solving a
limited number of problems and then,
perhaps, the market will expand as
they solve problems with widespread
demand, such as understanding and
interpreting spoken language, recognising objects or even artificial intelligence.
SC
particular project is the Precision Qubit Program.
This program involves making qubits using single atoms and aims to
“position, control and read out the
electron spin on a single (phosphorus)
atom in silicon which acts as a quantum bit or qubit”. Single electron transistors and microwave strip lines are
used to both read and manipulate the
electron spin on a single phosphorus
atom embedded in a crystal of silicon.
The ability to create a single atom
(2) A layer of hydrogen atoms (light colour)
is laid down on the silicon surface to create
the desired types of surface chemical bonds.
A pulse of current is then applied to the STM
probe which removes one hydrogen atom.
(3) A second pulse of current is then applied to the STM tip to remove a second hydrogen atom.
(6) The hydrogen atoms are removed.
(7) More silicon atoms are added to the surface, embedding the phosphorus atom deep
in the atomic structure where it is not affected
by undesired interference from the crystal surface. (Diagrams captured from https://youtu.
be/0dXNmbiGPS4)
siliconchip.com.au
and the single atom transistor
qubit and support structures such as
nano-wires to access the qubit is a remarkable achievement and only possible due to the recent development
of techniques to reproducibly manipulate single atoms and also to know
exactly where those single atoms are
located within the crystal lattice.
The illustrations in the numbered
images in the box show how a single atom of phosphorus is embedded
into a specific location within a silicon crystal.
Actual STM image of a phosphorus
atom (centre) located on the surface
of a silicon crystal at step 6. The
scale bar represents one nanometre,
one millionth of a millimetre.
The ability to accurately place a single
atom at a precise location plus the ability to
make an atomic scale wire allow the fabrication of a single atom transistor. Such a transistor can be used as a qubit or as a component of a classical computer.
While making such a device is a fantastic
start, practical computers need large numbers of devices on the one chip. Also, according to Moore’s Law for classical computing
which says that the number of transistors
on a chip doubles every 12 to 18 months,
the size will need to reach the atomic scale
by 2020 if that rate of advancement is to be
maintained. Obviously beyond the point of
a single atom transistor, no further size reduction is possible.
STM image of single atom transistor.
The single phosphorous atom is at the
centre and the atomic scale wires are
shown in pink.
siliconchip.com.au
Dr Matthew House with
Honours student
Kirsti Date studying
deterministic placement
of single donors in
silicon at the Atomic
Fabrication Facility
at the University
of New South
Wales.
An atomic scale
wire just one atom
tall and four atoms
wide. This is the type
of wire that may be
used to connect to
single atom qubits.
It was made by
using an STM to
create a channel in
the silicon and then
exposing the area
to phosphine gas
to make a line of
phosphorus
atoms and then
depositing silicon
atoms on top of the
phosphorus atoms
(similar to with the
numbered images). The phosphorus
atoms, which were placed at a spacing
of less than one nanometer, doped the
region around their vicinity causing
it to become conductive and act as a
wire.
A similar conductivity and current
carrying capability as copper was
achieved. This particular work also
proved that Ohm’s law operates at
the atomic scale which was not an
expected result as quantum effects
were though to dominate at this size
scale. On the other hand, a concern
that has been raised
from the knowledge
that Ohm’s law still
works at this scale
is that nonquantum affects
may dominate
making a qubit
difficult to
implement.
Another important outcome of
this work relates
to conventional
silicon chip fabrication.
Companies
such as Intel have
become increasingly worried that
the feature size on microprocessors
is becoming so small that quantum
effects will soon start to dominate
and no further miniaturisation can
occur.
Already transistor gate sizes are at
22nm which is about 100 times the
spacing of silicon atoms. This work
suggests that miniaturisation can
continue for some time and down to
much smaller feature sizes.
Image Courtesy of the Centre
for Quantum Computation &
Communication Technology.
March 2016 23
Macroscopic quantum
entanglement achieved
at room temperature
As we went to press, this
article by Colin Jeffery
appeared in the February
2 issue of “Gizmag”
(www.gizmag.com) and
follows several other
articles on Quantum
Computing, including
one on the role UNSW
scientists are playing in
this exciting field.
I
n quantum physics, the creation of a state
of entanglement in particles any larger
and more complex than photons usually
requires temperatures close to absolute zero
and the application of enormously powerful
magnetic fields.
Scientists working at the University of Chicago (UChicago) and the Argonne National
Laboratory claim to have created this entangled state at room temperature on a semiconductor chip, using atomic nuclei and the
application of relatively weak magnetic fields.
When two particles, such as photons, are
entangled – that is, when they interact physically and are then forcibly separated – the spin
direction imparted to each is directly opposite
to the other.
However, when one of the entangled particles has its spin direction measured, the other
particle will immediately display the reverse
spin direction, no matter how great a distance
they are apart.
This is the “spooky action at a distance”
phenomenon (as Albert Einstein put it) that
has already seen the rise of applications once
considered science fiction, such as ultra-safe
cryptography and a new realm of quantum
computing.
Ordinarily, quantum entanglement is a rarely observed occurrence in the natural world,
as particles coupled in this way first need to
24 Silicon Chip
The researchers believe that the advance could lead to entanglement-enhanced
magnetic resonance imaging probes (Credit: Awschalom Group/University of Chicago)
be in a highly-ordered state before they can be
entangled. In essence, this is because thermodynamic entropy dictates that a general chaos
of particles is the standard state of things at
the atomic level and makes such alignments
exceedingly rare.
Going up a scale to the macro level and
the sheer number of particles involved makes
entanglement an exceptionally difficult state
to achieve.
In standard sub-atomic quantum entanglement experiments using photons, for example, very high energy photons are generated using a laser and then directed through
a nonlinear crystal.
The majority of the photons will pass
straight through unimpeded, however some
will undergo a process known as spontaneous
parametric down-conversion (SPDC) where,
simply stated, a single high-energy photon will
split into two lower-energy photons.
As a result of this SPDC, the two photons
will have been created entangled, with opposing spin polarisations, because they both were
spawned from a single particle.
At a macroscopic level, however, things
aren’t quite as simple, and particles such as
atoms in solids and liquids are particularly difficult to wrangle into a quantum state.
This is because the difficulties of overcoming quantum decoherence (where interfering
wave functions from surrounding atoms cause
the collapse of quantum states) in entangling
particles normally means that ultra-low temperatures (around -270°C) and strong magnetic fields (about 1,000 times greater than that of
an average refrigerator magnet) are required.
This is to keep atomic movement close to
zero and contain the entangled particles, both
of which reduce the likelihood of decoherence.
Given that a practical application of entanglement of macroscopic particles is to allow
quantum electronic devices to operate in real
world situations and at ambient temperatures,
the researchers sought a different approach
to this problem.
Using an infrared laser, they coaxed into
order (known in scientific circles as “preferentially aligned”) the magnetic states of many
thousands of electrons and nuclei and then
proceeded to entangle them by bombarding
them with short electromagnetic pulses, just
like those used in standard magnetic resonance imaging (MRI).
As a result, many entangled pairs of electrons and nuclei were created in an area equal
to the size and volume of a red blood cell on a
Silicon Carbide (SiC) semiconductor.
See the full article at www.gizmag.com/
quantum-entanglement-nuclei-universitychicago-argonne/40884/
SC
siliconchip.com.au
“Rigol Offer Australia’s Best
Value Test Instruments”
Oscilloscopes
RIGOL DS-1000E Series
NEW RIGOL DS-1000Z Series
RIGOL DS-2000A Series
450MHz & 100MHz, 2 Ch
41GS/s Real Time Sampling
4USB Device, USB Host & PictBridge
450MHz, 70MHz & 100MHz, 4 Ch
41GS/s Real Time Sampling
412Mpts Standard Memory Depth
470MHz, 100MHz & 200MHz, 2 Ch
42GS/s Real Time Sampling
414Mpts Standard Memory Depth
FROM $
469
FROM $
ex GST
579
FROM $
ex GST
1,247
ex GST
Function/Arbitrary Function Generators
RIGOL DG-1022
NEW RIGOL DG-1000Z Series
RIGOL DG-4000 Series
420MHz Maximum Output Frequency
42 Output Channels
4USB Device & USB Host
430MHz & 60MHz
42 Output Channels
4160 In-Built Waveforms
460MHz, 100MHz & 160MHz
42 Output Channels
4Large 7 inch Display
ONLY $
539
FROM $
ex GST
Spectrum Analysers
971
FROM $
ex GST
Power Supply
RIGOL DP-832
RIGOL DM-3058E
49kHz to 1.5GHz, 3.2GHz & 7.5GHz
4RBW settable down to 10 Hz
4Optional Tracking Generator
4Triple Output 30V/3A & 5V/3A
4Large 3.5 inch TFT Display
4USB Device, USB Host, LAN & RS232
45 1/2 Digit
49 Functions
4USB & RS232
1,869
ONLY $
ex GST
649
ex GST
Multimeter
RIGOL DSA-800 Series
FROM $
1,313
ONLY $
ex GST
673
ex GST
Buy on-line at www.emona.com.au/rigol
Sydney
Tel 02 9519 3933
Fax 02 9550 1378
Melbourne
Tel 03 9889 0427
Fax 03 9889 0715
email testinst<at>emona.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
Brisbane
Tel 07 3392 7170
Fax 07 3848 9046
Adelaide
Tel 08 8363 5733
Fax 08 83635799
Perth
Tel 08 9361 4200
Fax 08 9361 4300
EMONA
web www.emona.com.au
March 2016 25
By Geoff Graham
Ultrasonic Garage
Parking Assistant
This Garage Parking Assistant will display the distance from the
back wall of your garage or carport to your car’s bumper bar, in
large digits and with a colour coded background: green for go,
yellow for slow down and red for stop. It makes positioning the
car a breeze as you will always know just how many centimetres
you are from the wall or an ideal stopping point.
T
HIS PROJECT is based on the Micromite LCD BackPack described
in last month’s SILICON CHIP. The BackPack is a low-cost, touch-sensitive LCD
panel coupled with an even lower cost
microcontroller programmed in BA-
SIC. Turning this into our Digital Garage Parking Assistant only requires
the addition of an ultrasonic distance
sensor and a suitable BASIC program.
As you drive the car into the garage
the display will light up, with the dis-
TRIGGER
ULTRASONIC
DISTANCE
SENSOR
MICROMITE
MK2
TOUCH-SCREEN
LCD PANEL
ECHO
Fig 1: this block diagram shows the main components in the Garage Parking
Assistant. The Micromite is in control: using the trigger line, it signals
the ultrasonic distance sensor to transmit an ultrasonic sound pulse then
measures the round trip time on the echo line. The result is converted to
centimetres and displayed on the touch-screen LCD panel.
26 Silicon Chip
tance in centimetres displayed on a
green background. As you come closer,
the background changes to yellow and
then finally to red. During this time, the
display will tell you the exact distance
to the wall or an ideal stopping point
in large 25mm-high digits. Finally, after the vehicle has been stationary for
a little while, the display blanks, ready
for the next time you park the car.
By making some small changes to
the software program, you could use
the same design for other applications
where you need to know the distance to
an object. For example, with a simple
modification, the unit could display
the water level in a rainwater tank.
Based on the dimensions of the tank,
it could also calculate and display the
content in litres, with the background
colours serving as a warning when the
siliconchip.com.au
REG1 MCP1700-3302E
+5V
CON1
POWER
AND
CONSOLE
CHASSIS-MOUNT
DC SOCKET
(WIRED TO
USB PLUG)
RED
GND
10 µF
+3.3V
OUT
IN
10 µF
100nF
100nF
5V
ILI9341
BASED
LCD DISPLAY
Tx
13
Rx
BLACK
GND
CON2
MICROMITE
I/O
DATA OUT
11
DATA IN
12
RESET
1
3
3
4
4
5
5
9
9
10
10
14
14
16
16
17
17
18
18
21
21
22
22
24
24
GND
25
25
ECHO
26
26
TRIG
+3.3V
5V
+5V
4-PIN
MICROPHONE
PLUG &
SOCKET
GND
HC-SR04
ULTRASONIC
DISTANCE
SENSOR
28
15
T_IRQ
T_DO
T_DIN
7
T_CS
T_CLK
SDO (MISO)
MICROMITE
MK2
LED
IC1
PIC32MX170F
–256B
SCK
SDI (MOSI)
2
D/C
23
RESET
6
CS
VR1
14 25
20
8
19
27
3
PINS
ON IC1
47 µF
TANT
BACK
LIGHT
+5V
GND
VCC
CON3
ICSP
1
+3.3V
4
1 – MCLR
2 –Vcc
5
3 – GND
RESET
5 – PGC
4 – PGD
S1
6 – NC
10k
CON4
+3.3V
+5V
MC P1700
SC
20 1 6
GARAGE PARKING ASSISTANT
IN
OUT
GND
Fig.2: the circuit is based on a Micromite LCD Backpack, a touch-screen LCD and an ultrasonic distance sensor. IC1
does most of the work, while REG1 is a 3.3V voltage regulator. The ultrasonic distance sensor is triggered by pin 21 of
the Micromite and the subsequent echo signal is then fed to pin 22. A 5V USB charger powers the circuit.
water has dropped to a low level.
The program running on the Digital
Garage Parking Assistant is written in
BASIC. This is an easy-to-learn programming language and the program is
stored in plain text. And because the
Micromite has its own program editor, you can connect it to a laptop and
easily change the program to suit your
preferences, even when it is attached
to the garage wall.
You might, for example, prefer the
distance to be displayed in old-fashioned inches. That would require the
modification of just one line in the program and could be done in minutes.
How it works
Fig.1 shows the block diagram of
the Garage Parking Assistant, while
Fig.2 shows the full circuit (including
siliconchip.com.au
the LCD BackPack). The key components are an ultrasonic distance sensor, Micromite microcontroller IC1
and the LCD panel. The Micromite is
completely in control; it uses the ul-
trasonic transducer to measure the distance and then displays the result on
the LCD panel.
The distance sensor emits an ultrasonic pulse and then listens for the reThe ultrasonic
sensor unit is
mounted on the
garage wall at
bumper height,
while the display
unit is mounted
above it at eyelevel, where it
can be easily
seen, and shows
the distance to
the vehicle in
centimetres.
March 2016 27
The background colours on the LCD provide a simple visual warning to the driver – green to continue, yellow to slow
down and red to stop. In addition, the LCD shows the distance readout in centimetres. You can change the thresholds
used for the three colours via the touch-screen and the various options menus.
turn echo, under the control of the Micromite. The microcontroller starts the
measurement cycle by triggering the
ultrasonic signal with a short positive
pulse on the trigger line of the sensor.
The sensor then raises the echo line
to a logic high level to acknowledge
that it has sent the ultrasonic pulse
and then drops it low again when the
echo is received.
The time that the echo pin is held
high by the sensor represents the round
trip time for the ultrasonic pulse to
leave the sensor, reach the distant object and bounce back to the sensor.
The microcontroller must accurately
measure this time and then calculate
the distance to the target.
In a normal microcontroller, this operation can be complex but on the Micromite it’s easy. The BASIC program
just needs to use the DISTANCE() func-
tion which will automatically generate the trigger pulse and calculate the
distance to the target. The result is returned as a floating point number representing the distance in centimetres
to one decimal place.
For example, if you had an ultrasonic transducer connected to pins 21
(trigger) and 22 (echo), the following
command would display the distance
(in centimetres) to the target:
PRINT DISTANCE(21, 22)
The output from running the above
command would be a number. For example, 26.1 would mean that the distance is 26.1 centimetres.
The sensor will work with a target
that ranges from 30mm to 3m. The precision will vary depending on several
factors, such as the reflectivity of the
object and the air temperature, but is
generally accurate to within 10mm.
This range and accuracy is more than
adequate for our Garage Parking Assistant.
The ultrasonic sensor goes by the
part number HC-SR04 and can be
found on eBay or purchased from the
SILICON CHIP Online Shop. Compatible
sensors are the SRF05, SRF06, Parallax
PING and the DYP-ME007 (which is
waterproof and therefore good for locations that are exposed to the weather).
All of these work exactly the same as
the HC-SR04.
The Micromite
The ultrasonic distance sensor used
in the Garage Parking Assistant.
The righthand transducer is used
to transmit the sound pulse and the
lefthand transducer receives the
reflected signal. The sensor will work
with targets ranging from 30mm
to 3m and is generally accurate to
within a centimetre.
28 Silicon Chip
The Micromite has been described
many times before in SILICON CHIP and
has evolved into a powerful but inexpensive controller. The IC used here
is a 28-pin dual-in-line (DIL) package
which can be plugged into an IC socket
and is programmed using a version of
BASIC called MMBasic.
BASIC stands for “Beginner’s Allpurpose Symbolic Instruction Code”.
Originally designed as an interactive teaching language by Dartmouth
College in the USA in 1963, it subsequently became widely used on early
personal computers. Because of its
simplicity, BASIC is often used for
teaching the fundamental concepts of
programming.
The program for the Garage Parking
Assistant is written in BASIC and because of this, it can be easily modified
to suit your preferences. For example,
if you do not like the colours you can
change them to suit yourself.
The Micromite is coupled with a lowcost touch-screen LCD panel which can
display 320 by 240 pixels in any one
of 65,535 colours. We chose the larger
2.8-inch version for our prototype because the displayed digits are easier to
see from the driver’s seat; they are just
over 25.4mm (1-inch) high. If you already have the 2.4-inch LCD, this could
be used instead. Its mounting arrangement (on the lid of the case) will be
slightly different, however.
The Garage Parking Assistant uses
the touch input to set its various options. All you need do is tap the screen
and the main options menu appears.
Touch support is another area where
the BASIC language makes programming easy. The TOUCH() function will
return the X and Y coordinates of the
touched location in pixels. Using this
and a selection of drawing commands,
it is possible to create touch sensitive
buttons and other screen objects that
make sense to the casual user.
Options
The photo at top-right on the facing
page shows the main options menu that
appears when the screen is touched. In
particular, it shows the timeout, offset and thresholds for the background
colours.
The timeout is simply the length of
time after the car has stopped moving
before the display is blanked. By contrast, the offset is the distance from
the sensor at which the displayed dissiliconchip.com.au
tance will be shown as zero. It is useful if the sensor is mounted on a wall
but the car must stop before the wall
is reached, perhaps because of some
other obstruction.
For example, if the offset is set at
10cm, the display will read zero when
the distance between the car’s bumper
bar and the sensor has been reduced
to 10cm.
Either of these two settings can be
changed by touching the CHANGE button. In this case, a virtual on-screen
keypad will be displayed which allows the required number to be keyed
in. An example of this is shown in the
photo below left. The keypad includes
the ability to delete the previously entered digit (the DEL key) or cancel the
entry and return to the menu (the CAN
key). Pressing the ENT key will store
the keyed-in number and return to the
previous menu.
The third entry on the main options
screen shows the thresholds for the
colour changes. Pressing the change
button for this entry will open up a
new menu as shown in the photo below right. By default the threshold for
green is 200cm, for yellow it is 50cm
and for red it is 10cm.
Initially, as the vehicle approaches,
the LCD will be blank but when the
vehicle’s distance reaches the green
threshold, the display will light and
show the distance with a green background. Similarly, when the yellow
threshold is reached, the background
will change to yellow and so on.
These colour changes provide a
simple visual warning for the driver
– yellow means slow down and red
means stop immediately. You can easily change these thresholds by touch-
Touching the screen on the Garage Parking Assistant displays the options
settings. This photo shows the main menu, which displays the current settings
for the timeout, the offset and the thresholds. Touching the CHANGE button for
a particular parameter brings up a virtual keypad (see photo below) so that the
setting can be changed.
ing the CHANGE button and keying in
the new number.
The FINISHED button will save the
options and return to the previous
screen. All options are saved in nonvolatile memory, so they will be retained even if the power is removed.
Building the LCD Backpack
The first step in the construction is
to build the Micromite LCD BackPack
and test it to make sure that it’s working correctly. This was described in
last month’s issue of SILICON CHIP so
we won’t go into too much detail here.
Besides, with the silk screening on
the PCB, it’s obvious where the parts
go and it should take less than half an
hour to build.
This is a typical virtual keypad which allows the user to
enter a new number. It includes the ability to delete the
previously entered digit (the DEL key) or cancel the entry
and return to the menu (the CAN key). Pressing ENT will
store the number and return to the previous menu.
siliconchip.com.au
Loading the firmware and the BASIC
program is essentially a 3-step process.
First, the blank PIC32 microcontroller must be programmed with the Micromite firmware which includes the
BASIC interpreter (MMBasic). That
done, the interpreter needs to be configured to suit the LCD panel. And finally, the BASIC program that drives
the ultrasonic sensor and the display
needs to be loaded.
You have a few choices when it
comes to this process:
Option 1: the first option is to download
the file “ParkingAssistFull.hex” from
the SILICON CHIP website and program
the PIC32 yourself. This file has the Micromite firmware, the settings for the
LCD panel and the BASIC program all
The thresholds for bringing up different background colours can be changed using this menu. The Finished button
saves the options and return to the previous screen. All
options are saved in non-volatile memory so they will be
retained even if the power is removed.
March 2016 29
STARTUP
LCD
TOUCHED?
YES
GET THE
OPTIONS
FINISHED
NO
BLANK
DISPLAY
GET THE
DISTANCE
FORWARD
MOVEMENT?
NO
YES
Program operation
NO
YES
> GREEN
THRESHOLD?
TIMEOUT
OCCURED?
YES
NO
> YELLOW
THRESHOLD?
YES
BCOLOUR = GREEN
NO
> RED
THRESHOLD?
YES
BCOLOUR = YELLOW
NO
BCOLOUR = RED
DISPLAY THE
DISTANCE
combined into one “package”. It must
be programmed into the PIC32 microcontroller using a programmer such as
the PICkit 3.
Using this firmware is quite convenient because this single operation
combines all three steps and sets up
the chip so that it’s ready to do the job.
Option 2: the second (and easiest) option is to purchase the PIC32 microcontroller pre-programmed with the combined firmware file from the SILICON
CHIP Online Shop. Then, all you need
to do is plug the chip into its socket
and you are ready to go.
Option 3: the third option is to go
through all three steps individually.
Step 1 is to download the file “Micro
mite_V5.1.hex” from the SILICON CHIP
website and program it into the PIC32
microcontroller using a PICkit 3. Step
2 is to connect a USB-to-serial converter to the Micromite’s console and
configure the chip to work with the
30 Silicon Chip
cover that the touch calibration is inaccurate, this can be corrected by connecting a USB-to-serial converter to
the console, halting the program with
CTRL-C and re-running the calibration. The calibration procedure was
also described in detail last month.
Note that if you already have a working Micromite LCD BackPack, then it
will only be necessary to load Parking
Assist.bas into the PIC32 micro. Alternatively, you can choose to reprogram
the chip with the combined software
(ie, ParkingAssistFull.hex).
Fig.3: the software
flowchart diagram. The
BASIC program runs
in a continuous loop.
After checking for a
touch on the screen the
program then measures
the distance to the car.
Following this, a series
of decisions are made to
determine if the display
should be blanked or to
select the background
colour.
LCD and touch. And finally, step 3
involves loading the BASIC program
“ParkingAssist.bas” (again available from the SILICON CHIP website).
This can be loaded using either the
XMODEM protocol or using the AUTOSAVE command.
The above process was described in
detail in last month’s article on the Micromite LCD Backpack and isn’t hard
to do. When you have run through all
three steps, the result will be exactly the same as if you had loaded the
combined firmware containing the interpreter, the settings and the BASIC
program (or if you purchased a preprogrammed chip).
The only issue that you need to be
aware of is that the touch calibration
in the combined firmware was done
with a reasonably standard LCD panel
but yours might require re-calibration
if it is significantly different from the
“standard” that we used. If you dis-
If you wish to modify the BASIC
program, you need to have some idea
of how it works. Fig.3 provides a highlevel flow diagram of its operation.
As shown, the program runs in a continuous loop. First, it checks if the LCD
is being touched and if it is, branches
to a subroutine which will display the
menus and the options.
The program then retrieves the distance from the ultrasonic sensor which
is averaged over five successive readings to reduce noise. It then checks
for forward movement and if there is
none it checks for a timeout. This is
the time that the display remains on
after the vehicle has stopped moving.
If the vehicle is stationary, a counter
will increment every second and the
program will blank the display when
the counter reaches the timeout setting.
The program next checks the vehicle’s distance and compares it to the
green threshold. If it is greater than
this threshold, it blanks the display
and returns to the start of the loop for
another “go around”. If the distance
is less than the green threshold, the
program checks the other thresholds
to determine the colour to be used, ie,
green, yellow or red.
Finally, the program displays the
distance in centimetres with the specified coloured background. It then loops
around to get another distance reading
and repeat the process.
If you are going to modify the program there is one feature that you need
to be aware of. In the main program
loop, the watchdog timer is set to one
second. This timer is used to automatically restart the program if an error occurs.
In operation, the timer must be constantly reset to one second to prevent
a restart under normal operation. This
means that you must make sure that the
siliconchip.com.au
program can execute the loop in less
than one second to avoid an automatic
restart of the Micromite.
The watchdog timer is also used
when the program detects a touch on
the screen and branches to the menus
where the options are set. In this case,
the timeout is set to 10 minutes every time a button is touched. This was
included in the program so that the
Micromite will automatically restart
and return to normal operation after
10 minutes of inactivity within any
menu – handy if you have been called
away while fiddling with the settings
and forget to return.
M3 x 10mm
MACHINE SCREW
CLEAR ACRYLIC LID WITH CUT-OUT FOR LCD
(REPLACES ORIGINAL UB3 BOX LID)
TOUCH-SCREEN LCD
2 x M3
WASHERS
M3 x 6mm
MACHINE SCREW
M3 x 12mm
TAPPED SPACER
2.8" LCD PCB
MICROMITE
BACKPACK PCB
Fig.4: here’s
how to attach
the LCD &
Micromite
BackPack PCB
to the clear
acrylic lid.
The LCD goes
through a cutout in the lid
and sits flush
with its top
surface.
Building it
The first job in the assembly is to
build and calibrate the Micromite LCD
BackPack, as detailed in the February
2016 issue of SILICON CHIP. It’s then just
a matter of mounting the LCD BackPack
assembly and the ultrasonic sensor assembly in separate enclosures and connecting them together.
As shown in the photos, the Micromite LCD Backpack is mounted inside
a UB3 ABS box, while the ultrasonic
sensor goes in a smaller UB5 box. A
4-core cable joins the two units and
allows the sensor to be mounted at
bumper bar height, while the Micromite LCD BackPack can be mounted
above it at eye height.
In each case, the lid supplied with
the box is discarded and replaced with
a laser-cut clear acrylic panel (available
from the SILICON CHIP Online Shop; see
parts list). The panel for the BackPack
assembly comes with all the mounting
holes plus a precision cut-out for the
touch-screen LCD, while the panel (or
lid) for the UB5 box comes with corner
mounting holes plus neat circular cutouts for the two ultrasonic transducers.
Fig.4 shows how the LCD BackPack
assembly is mounted. First, the touchscreen LCD is attached to the acrylic
lid at each corner using an M3 x 10mm
machine screw, two stacked M3 washers and an M3 x 12mm tapped spacer.
This arrangement ensures that the LCD
sits flush with the clear acrylic lid.
Note that the LCD itself is offset to
the left on its PCB, so be sure to fit the
module the right way around, so that
the viewing area is centred horizontally on the acrylic panel. Once it’s in
place, the Micromite BackPack PCB is
then plugged into CON3 on the LCD
board and secured in place using M3
x 6mm machine screws.
siliconchip.com.au
This view shows the LCD/BackPack PCB assembly
just before it is lowered into the case.
The next step is to drill holes in the
lefthand side of the case to accept a
panel-mount DC power socket and a
4-pin microphone socket (used for the
sensor connection). These holes can be
centred vertically on the panel, with
each hole about 20mm in from its adjacent outside edge.
Drill small pilot holes to start with,
then carefully enlarge each hole to size
using a tapered reamer, so that the part
just fits.
That done, the DC socket can be
wired to a 4-pin female header as
shown in Fig.5, with the red wire going to the centre pin terminal. The DC
socket is then be secured to the case,
after which the microphone socket can
be fitted and wired to an 8-pin female
header – see Fig.6.
March 2016 31
5V
4
Tx
3
2
Rx
1
USB CONNECTOR
TYPE A MALE
GND
DC PLUG
DC INPUT
SOCKET
(ON END OF BOX)
4-PIN FEMALE
HEADER
CONNECTOR
MICROMITE
CON1POWER
AND CONSOLE
CONNECTOR
Fig.5: the Garage Parking Assistant is powered from a standard USB plugpack charger. To make a suitable power
cable, cut off one end of a USB cable (retaining the type A male connector on the other end) and solder the red wire to
the centre terminal pin of a DC plug and the black wire to the outside pin. The matching DC socket is mounted on the
side of the UB3 box and is connected to a 4-pin female header which then plugs into CON1 on the Micromite PCB.
21
22
GND
ECHO
3.3V
TRIG
5V
+5V
4-PIN FEMALE
HEADER CONNECTOR
ULTRASONIC
DISTANCE
SENSOR
GND
4-PIN MICROPHONE
PLUG
4-PIN MICROPHONE
SOCKET ON
END OF BOX
8-PIN FEMALE
HEADER CONNECTOR
MICROMITE
CON2 I/O
CONNECTOR
Fig.6: a cable with a 4-pin female header at one end and a 4-pin microphone plug at the other end connects the ultrasonic sensor to the display unit via a matching 4-pin socket. The microphone socket in turn is wired to an 8-pin female
header which then connects to CON2 on the Micromite PCB. Note that the female headers shown in Figs.5 & 6 are not
polarised, so make sure that they are orientated correctly when plugging them in.
The main unit can now be completed
by plugging the headers into CON1 &
CON2 on the BackPack PCB, then lowering the PCB assembly into the case
and securing it at the corners using the
supplied self-tapping screws.
Be careful when plugging in the two
headers, as the connectors are not polarised. Basically, it’s just a matter of
making sure that ground (GND) from
the DC socket (black wire) goes to GND
on CON1 and that GND on the microphone socket goes to GND on CON2.
Note also that CON2 on the BackPack PCB has 18 pins; the 8-pin female
header must be plugged in at the end
that has the GND pin.
Fitting the sensor PCB
The ultrasonic sensor unit comes
pre-assembled. It’s just a matter of
pushing the two sensors through their
The sensor unit is connected to
the Micromite LCD Backpack via
a 4-core cable. Power is derived
from CON2 on the BackPack PCB.
32 Silicon Chip
front panel holes as far as they will go
to secure the unit in position. The sensors are a firm fit in the holes and that
will usually be enough to hold the assembly in place.
Alternatively, a couple of small dabs
of neutral-cure silicone can be used
on the inside to ensure that the sensor
unit can’t be pushed back into the case.
The next step is to drill a 9.5mm hole
through one side of the case (or through
the top) and fit a rubber grommet. A
4-way cable (used to connect the sensor to the Micromite BackPack PCB)
is then pushed through this grommet
and wired to a 4-way female header as
shown in Fig.6.
Either 6mm-diameter 4-core audio
cable (with the shield braid cut short)
or 4-wire telephone cable can be used
here. The audio cable is a tight fit into
the grommet, so it won’t be necessary
to secure it with a cable clamp. Conversely, some sort of clamping arrangement will probably be required if telephone cable is used.
The other end of this 4-way cable
is connected to a 4-pin microphone
plug. Make sure that the wires go to
the correct pins on this plug, so that
they mate with the correct wires on
the socket when the two are connected
together. If you are using audio cable,
the shield braid can either be cut short
or connected to the plug’s metal shell.
siliconchip.com.au
Firmware Updates
For firmware updates for the Micromite and the Garage Parking Assistant, please check the author’s website at geoffg.net/micromite.html
Note that the ultrasonic sensor assembly derives its power (5V) via this
cable from CON2 on the Micromite
BackPack PCB.
Power supply
5V USB plugpack chargers are cheap
and the Garage Parking Assistant works
perfectly with one of these. Be sure to
select one with a generous current rating (500mA or more), as the unit can
draw up to 250mA.
Fig.5 shows the details for the USB
supply cable for one of these supplies.
It’s just a matter of cutting off one end
of a USB cable (retaining the male type
A connector at the other end) and soldering the red and black wires to the
DC plug (red wire to the centre-pin
terminal).
The other two wires in the USB cable
(generally green and white) can be cut
short, as they are not needed.
Another option is to use a 5V DC
plugpack with a captive lead fitted
with a DC plug. If the plug is the incorrect size, cut it off and fit one that
does match the socket.
Loading BASIC
If you are going to load the BASIC
program yourself or edit it later, you
also need to make up a cable with a
USB-to-serial converter as described
last month. Then, after you have the
program running, you can remove
the converter and use the power cable instead.
This is because the program is designed to start running automatically
whenever power is applied and after
the program has been run once, you
don’t need to use the console again.
Mounting it in place
Having made the connections, the
next step is to mount the two units in
place. The LCD unit should be mounted on the garage wall at eye height,
while the sensor should be mounted
at bumper bar height.
Don’t forget that you can easily adjust the green, yellow and red threshold
values if necessary. Depending on how
close you want to park to the wall, the
siliconchip.com.au
Parts List
Micromite LCD BackPack Unit
1 PCB, code 07102122, 86 x
50mm (for 2.8-inch LCD)
1 ILI9341-based LCD, 320 x 240
pixels, 2.8-inch diagonal
1 UB3 ABS box, 130 x 67 x 43mm
(Altronics H0153 or H0203,
Jaycar HB6013 or HB6023)
1 pre-drilled clear acrylic lid to
suit UB3 box
1 4-pin tactile switch, throughhole hole
1 100Ω vertical-mount side adjust
trimpot (Altronics R2579,
element14 9608044 or similar)
1 28-pin DIL low-profile IC socket
1 4-pin 0.1-inch male header
(CON1)
1 18-pin 0.1-inch male header
(CON2)
1 14-pin 0.1-inch female header
socket (CON3)
1 6-pin 0.1-inch right-angle male
header (CON4)
1 4-pin 0.1-inch female header
1 8-pin 0.1-inch female header
1 2.1mm or 2.5mm panel-mount
DC socket (Altronics P0622 or
P0623)
1 4-pin panel-mount microphone
male socket (Altronics P0955
or Jaycar PP2010)
4 M3 x 12mm tapped spacers
4 M3 x 10mm machine screws
4 M3 x 6mm machine screws
8 M3 flat washers
Semiconductors
1 PIC32MX170F256B-50I/SP
microcontroller programmed
with ParkingAssistFull.hex
(IC1) – see text. Note: a PIC32
MX170F256B-I/SP can also
be used but will be limited to
40MHz)
1 Microchip MCP1700-3302E/TO
voltage regulator (REG1)
Capacitors
1 47µF 16V tantalum or SMD
ceramic (3216/1206)
default values should be fine in most
cases. However, some people might
want to increase the red threshold to
(say) 15cm or even 20cm.
As stated earlier, all you have to
do is touch the screen to bring up the
main options menu and then touch the
2 10µF 16V tantalum or SMD
ceramic (3216/1206)
2 100nF monolithic ceramic
Resistors (0.25W 5%)
1 10kΩ
Sensor Unit
1 ultrasonic distance sensor, HCSR04, SRF05, SRF06, Parallax
PING or DYP-ME007
1 UB5 ABS box, 82 x 54 x 30mm
(Altronics H0155 or H0205 ,
Jaycar HB6005)
1 pre-drilled clear acrylic lid to suit
UB5 box
1 9.5mm rubber grommet to suit
6mm-dia. cable (Jaycar HP0702)
Cable Parts
1 USB cable with a male type A
connector (length to suit)
1 2.1mm or 2.5mm DC plug to suit
DC socket (Altronics P0634A
or P0635A, Jaycar PP0510 or
PP0511)
1 4-pin female line microphone
connector (Altronics P0950 or
Jaycar PS2012)
1 4-pin 0.1-inch female header
1 length 4-core audio cable
1 200mm length of rainbow cable
Where To Buy Parts
A complete kit for the Micromite
LCD BackPack is available from the
SILICON CHIP Online Shop. The clear
lid with cut-out, to suit a UB3 Jiffy
box, is available separately. We are
also offering the ultrasonic distance
sensor with a custom-cut UB5 jiffy
box lid. See the Online Shop ad on
page 88 for more details.
The Micromite BackPack PCB and
programmed microcontroller can also
be purchased separately.
Note that the kit does not include
the boxes, mounting hardware, plugpack power supply, rubber grommet
off-board headers and connectors or
cable parts.
CHANGE button for the colour thresh-
olds to bring up the relevant options
menu. You then hit the CHANGE button
for the threshold you want to change,
enter in the new number on the virtual
keypad, touch ENT and then FINISHED,
SC
and that’s it!
March 2016 33
1-Wire Digital
Temperature Sensor For
The Raspberry Pi
By Greg Swain
& Nicholas Vinen
If you just want to measure temperature,
then using a Sense HAT with the Raspberry
Pi (RPi) is overkill. A much cheaper, easier
and more accurate option is to use a Dallas
DS18B20 1-Wire Digital Thermometer
Sensor.
T
HE DALLAS DS18B20 temperature sensor looks just like a TO-92
transistor but is actually much more
complicated. Its internal chip not only
includes a temperature sensor but also
has a 12-bit on-board digital-to-analog
converter, a 1-wire serial interface and
all the necessary control logic. It’s accurate to within ±0.5°C over the range
of -10°C to +85°C and has a full operating temperature range from -55°C
to +125°C.
In addition, each DS18B20 has a
unique 64-bit serial code, which allows multiple DS18B20s to function
on the same 1-Wire bus. If you want to
use multiple sensors, it’s just a matter
of connecting them in parallel.
A waterproofed and pre-wired version of the sensor is available and this
can be purchased from the SILICON CHIP
Online Shop for just $5 plus postage.
The sensor itself is housed in a small
metal tube and is hooked up to a 1metre long cable.
Apart from cost, the big advantage
of the DS18B20 is that it’s far more
accurate than the Sense HAT. It’s not
only inherently accurate but can be
well-separated from the RPi so that
it is unaffected by heat generated by
the RPi’s ARM CPU. As a result, it
doesn’t require time for the readings
to stabilise after switch on and we
don’t need to compensate for heatsoak from the RPi.
Connecting it to the RPi
Interfacing the DS18B20 sensor to
the RPi’s GPIO port couldn’t be easier.
As shown in Fig.1, there are just three
wires to connect: the red wire goes to
the +3.3V pin, the black wire goes to
GND and the yellow data wire goes to
GPIO4. In addition, a 4.7kΩ pull-up resistor must be connected between the
data line and the +3.3V supply.
The easiest way to connect the wires
is to terminate them in 1-way header
sockets which are then plugged into
RPi’s GPIO port. Alternatively, you
can cut two sections from a pin header
socket (eg, Altronics P5380), plug them
into the GPIO port and solder the sensor’s leads to the pins. A small clamp
attached to the case lid can be used to
secure the cable in place.
The 4.7kΩ resistor can be connected
by soldering its leads directly to the
GPIO pads underneath the PCB.
Getting it going
You will need to install Raspbian
on the RPi and set it up as described
in the January and February 2016 is-
RASPBERRY PI
GPIO
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
34 Silicon Chip
GPIO4
Fig.1: here’s how to connect the DS18B20 sensor leads to the Raspberry Pi’s GPIO
port. The red wire goes to +3.3V, the black wire to GND and the yellow data wire
goes to the GPIO4 pin. In addition, a 4.7kΩ pull-up resistor is connected between
GPIO4 and the +3.3V pin.
+3.3V
GND
4.7k PULLUP
RESISTOR SOLDERED
TO +3.3V & GPIO4
PINS UNDERNEATH
RASPBERRY PI PCB
siliconchip.com.au
The Raspberry
Pi connects to
your router via
WiFi and streams
the temperature
readings to a web
server so they can
be accessed over
the internet.
sues of SILICON CHIP. If you don’t have
a Sense HAT module, you can leave
out Steps 8-10 of the January article as
they are not relevant.
Once you’ve done that and connected the DS18B20 temperature sensor,
power up the RPi. You now need to
tell it how to detect the sensor. To do
that, enter the following command in
a terminal window:
sudo nano /boot/config.txt
then move the cursor to the bottom
of the file and add the following line:
dtoverlay=w1-gpio
Hit Ctrl-o and Ctrl-x to save the file
and exit Nano, then reboot (sudo reboot)
the RPi so that the changes take effect.
(Note: on older versions of Raspbian,
it may be necessary to add the lines
w1-gpio and W1_therm to the end of
/etc/modules).
Once the RPi is up and running
again, enter the following commands
into a terminal window:
cd /sys/bus/w1/devices
ls
Your DS18B20 temperature sensor’s
unique ID address will now be listed
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.2: once the DS18B20 has been connected to the RPi, a number of commands
are run in a terminal window to determine its ID address (see text).
in the terminal window followed by
w1_bus_master1 – see Fig.2. If you multiple sensor’s connected in parallel,
then multiple IDs will be listed (one
for each sensor).
In our case, the sensor’s ID is 28011581aefaff and we can now open the
sensor’s file to view the temperature
reading as follows:
cd 28-011581aefaff
cat w1_slave
This will return two lines of data,
as shown in Fig.2. The first line is a
cyclic redundancy check (CRC) and
if it ends in “YES”, then the reading
was successful. The second line displays the temperature reading, in this
case t=23812. This is the temperature
in °C x 1000, so we simply divide by
The 4.7kΩ pull-up resistor can be
directly soldered to the GPIO pins.
1000 to get the temperature: ie, 23812
÷ 1000 = 23.812°C.
Python program
We don’t want to have to go through
this rigmarole every time we want to
March 2016 35
import time
import os
import re
Fig.3: readtemp.py
sensor_names = {"011581aefaff": "indoor"} #Substitute your sensor's ID
def list_onewire_sensors():
path = '/sys/bus/w1/devices'
return [f for f in os.listdir(path) if not os.path.isfile(os.path.join(path, f)) and f.sta
def read_onewire_sensor(name):
path = '/sys/bus/w1/devices'
file = open(os.path.join(path,name,'w1_slave'), 'r')
line1 = file.readline()
line2 = file.readline()
file.close()
if line1.endswith(' YES\n'):
info = re.search('(\\d+)\n?$', line2)
if info and int(info.group(1)) > 0:
return int(info.group(1)) / 1000.0
return '?';
def getmsg(entities):
tm = time.strftime("%d/%m/%Y %H:%M:%S", time.localtime())
msg = "[%s]" % tm
deg = "°" if entities else u"\u00B0"
onewire_sensors = list_onewire_sensors()
for sensor in onewire_sensors:
temp = read_onewire_sensor(sensor);
msg += ' '+( sensor_names[sensor[3:]] if sensor[3:] in sensor_names else sensor[3:])+'
return msg
while True:
print(getmsg(False))
time.sleep(5)
read the temperature, so the answer
is to automate the procedure using a
simple Python program. Better still,
we can then stream the readings to
Apache Web Server on the RPi, so
that we can access the readings over
the internet (or on the local network)
using a web browser.
Let’s get the Python program running first. Fig.3 shows the code – just
download the readtemp.py file from
the SILICON CHIP website to the RPi’s
/home/pi folder, then launch Python 3
from a terminal window using the following commands:
xhost + (if you're running it headless)
sudo idle3 &
Wait until Python 3 launches, then
open /home/pi/readtemp.py and click Run
Module. You should see the temperature
readings appear as shown in Fig.4, with
the reading updated every 5s.
OK, let’s take a closer look at the pro36 Silicon Chip
gram. The new code has two functions
to assist with reading the DS18B20
1-Wire sensor temperature, plus some
extra code to display the results.
The list_onewire_sensors function
scans the /sys/bus/w1/devices directory
for subdirectories starting with “28” and adds the sensor’s name, which
includes its unique serial number, to
an array. The returned array thus contains one entry for each DS18B20 sensor that has been detected.
The read_onewire_sensor function
receives the name of one of the sensors (from the list) and interrogates
that sensor. It reads two lines, both
of which contain the full sensor response. As stated, the first one has a
flag indicating whether the CRC is valid, while the second line contains the
decoded temperature value.
This function reads both lines and,
if the CRC is valid, returns the temperature reading in °C as a floating point
value. If an error occurs, it returns a
string containing a question mark.
We also have a list called sensor_
names which can be used to map the
cryptic unique ID for a given sensor
to a more useful name such as “indoor”, “outdoor”, etc. That way, you
can name the sensors and the temperature for each sensor is then displayed
after its name.
The test script also initialises a
string with the current date and time.
It then calls the first helper function to
get a list of sensors and then, for each
sensor, gets the name and temperature and adds it on to the end of that
string. Finally, that string is printed,
as shown in Fig.4.
If you want to change the update
time, just edit the last line of the script.
Web access
We’ve also adapted the index.py
script originally used last month so
siliconchip.com.au
artswith('28-')]
Fig.5 (above): the temperature readings as displayed
in a web browser. The rapid increase in temperature
was the result of briefly holding the temperature sensor
between two fingers.
': '+('?' if temp == '?' else ('%.3f' % temp)+deg+'C')
played. You can edit the sensor_names =
line to distinguish between them – just
add a comma after each preceding entry and add each additional sensor’s
ID address and name (with everything
enclosed by one set of parentheses).
Apart from adding code to support
the DS18B20 sensors, we’ve also improved the program to give more consistent time intervals between readings. Basically, the page load time has
now been taken out of the equation.
Setting up the web server
Fig.4: this is the output that appears when running readtemp.py in Python on the
RPi. The reading updates about every five seconds but this is easy to change.
that the Apache 2 Web Server could
serve readings from the Sense HAT.
We’ve left the code to display the readings from the Sense HAT in place but
wrapped it with an “exception handler” so that if the Sense HAT isn’t installed, its absence is ignored.
We then use the same code from
the readtemp.py script to append the
DS18B20 reading(s) to the end of each
siliconchip.com.au
line that’s displayed. If you can physically connect both the Sense HAT and
some DS18B20 temperature sensors,
all the readings at any particular instant will be shown on the same line.
If you only have a DS18B20 sensor
connected, its readings will be displayed as shown in Fig.5. And if you
have several DS18B20s connected in
parallel, all their readings will be dis-
Installing and getting the Apache
Web Server going is straightforward –
just follow the step-by-step procedure
described in the February 2016 article. As before, the index.py script (embedded in index.py.zip) can be downloaded from the SILICON CHIP website,
unzipped and copied to /var/www/html.
Don’t forget to set up password access and a dynamic DNS service (eg,
Duck DNS) if you want to access the
temperature readings over the internet.
It’s also a good idea to install Fail2Ban,
to temporarily ban anyone who makes
too many failed log-in attempts.
Once the set-up is complete, you
can browse to the RPi’s web server by
entering your local IP, WAN IP or dynamic DNS address into your browser
to display the temperature readings.
By default, the reading updates every
five seconds but you can easily change
this by altering the two interval=5 values in index.py; eg, interval=30 updates
the reading every 30 seconds.
Alternatively, you can add a switch
to the website address, as described on
SC
page 58 of the February issue.
March 2016 37
Delta Throttle
Timer
By JOHN CLARKE
This handy device will activate a timer and relay when you’re
accelerating or decelerating hard. It does this by responding to
how quickly you’re moving the accelerator pedal. In fact, it is a
general purpose version of the QuickBrake project presented in
the January 2016 issue.
I
And when you go back to gentle
f you read the article on the Quick- apex, get back hard on the power.
The Delta Throttle Timer (DTT) has driving, the spray will then turn off.
Brake project, you will know that
But there are other possible uses.
it turns on your brake lights be- all the time been watching the voltfore the brakes are actually applied, age coming from the throttle position The DTT is the ideal way of triggering engine and transmission modifiby sensing that you have lifted off the sensor.
When it recognises how fast you’re cations.
throttle very rapidly, just as you do beFor example, you could set it up so
fore a heavy application of the brakes. pushing down on the throttle, it actiThis gives following drivers an ear- vates a timer which in turn controls a that when you drive with fast throttle
ly warning (via an earlier brake light relay. If that relay is connected to (say) movements the turbo boost increases.
Or you can use the DTT to automatiturn-on) that you are about to decel- an intercooler water spray, you’ll be
cooling the core even before the car cally switch the transmission’s Power/
erate heavily.
Economy button to Power mode when
But this version of the circuit, the comes up on boost!
Set the timer for an interval of 30 you’re really pushing it along. And
Delta Throttle Timer, can respond to
heavy applications of the throttle too. seconds and that’s how long the spray again, when you revert to a more genSay you’re driving along and the will stay on for but you can repeatedly tle mode, the DTT will switch the auto
road passes through a section of wind- extend the time if you push down fast transmission back to Economy Mode.
Still with a turbo car, because the
ing country road. As you approach on the throttle again before the relay
DTT can be configured to also measthose bends, you decide to push it times out.
ure quick throttle lifts
along a lot harder –
(as in the QuickBrake),
and your foot goes
you can also use the dedown fast.
vice to control an elecYou wind out the
tric blow-off valve.
engine in second
• Has a 0-5V signal input range
In that application,
gear, flick the le• Powers a relay when a specific rate of voltage change occurs
the timer would be set
ver across to third
• Adjustable rate threshold
for a very short period –
and then flatten the
• Adjustable timer from 0.1s to more than 100 seconds
say one second – so that
throttle again. A cor• Selectable rising or falling voltage rate switching
whenever you quickner approaches and
ly lift the throttle (eg,
you lift off, turn in
• Power-up delay to prevent false triggering at ignition-on
for a gear-change), the
and then right at the
Main Features
38 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
100nF
1M
+12V
100F
16V
7
1k
47k
82k
IN
GND
OUT
REG1 LM2940CT-5.0
SCHMITT
TRIGGER
4
IC2b
1k
10F
TRIG
100nF
5
2
470F
1
+12V
+5V
+5V
K
C
E
A
K
1N4004
A
1N4148
B
150
TIME
6
5
+2.5V
100F 1k
TIMER
3
6
7
A
OUT
DISCH
8
IC3 THR
7555
4
A
K
D3
100F 1N4148
K
IC1: LMC6482AIN
D4
1N4148
DIFFERENTIATOR
VR1
1M
100k
SENSITIVITY
DELTA THROTTLE TIMER
CON1
6
5
1M
1
100nF
1k
Q2
BC327
VR2
1M
10F
BUFFER
IC1b
K
A
4.7k
LED
K
A
LED1
JP1
K
L/H
2
E
10k
B
C
BC327,
BC337
B
8
IC2a
E
C
1
GND
IN
OUT
100F
16V
GND
CON3:
X & C1 ARE N/C
Y & C2 ARE N/O
10F
LM2940CT-5.0
RLY 1
+12V
INVERTER
Q1
BC337
D2
1N4004 A
10k
H/L
1.8k
7
3
IC2: LM358
Fig.1: the Delta Throttle Timer circuit. IC1a monitors and buffers the signal from the throttle position or MAP sensor and feeds it to
a differentiator stage which passes fast-changing signal transitions only. The differentiator’s output is then buffered by IC1b and fed
to Schmitt trigger IC2b via JP1 or via inverter stage IC2a and JP1. Depending on the setting of JP1, a rapid transition from the throttle
position sensor (eg, during a fast throttle depression) can cause IC2b’s output to briefly go low to trigger 7555 timer IC3, which is then
enabled to activate Relay1.
2016
SC
GND
K
D1 1N4004
A
4
IC1a
8
BUFFER
100F
10k
2
3
10F
CON3
GND
Y
C2
C1
X
to connect and set up. Apart from the
device that you are controlling, only
three connections are needed to the
car’s wiring: ignition-switched +12V,
chassis (earth or GND) and the throttle
IGNITION
10k
12k
* REQUIRED ONLY FOR
THE MAP SENSOR
GND*
SIG
+5V*
CON2
+5V
blow-off valve will open. However, at
idle, the valve will stay shut, avoiding
those problems where intake air can
be drawn in through the open valve.
The DTT is easy to build and easy
position sensor. Alternatively, if your
car does not have a throttle position
sensor or if the TPS is difficult to access, you could use the MAP (manifold
absolute pressure) sensor instead, then
March 2016 39
Suggested uses
When configured to measure quick downwards throttle movements:
• Switching engine management and auto transmission control
modifications in and out
• Automatic switching of the Power/Economy auto transmission button
• Automatic turbo boost increase with hard driving
• Intercooler water spray and/or intercooler fan control
When configured to measure quick throttle lifts:
• Electronic blow-off valve control
• Early brake light illumination (as in the QuickBrake)
you need four connections: switched
+12V (from ignition), +5V, signal and
chassis.
Circuit description
Fig.1 shows the circuit and is almost
identical to that of the QuickBrake.
It uses two dual op amps (IC1 & IC2)
and a 7555 timer (IC3). The circuit is
designed to detect the rapid change of
voltage from the TPS or MAP sensor
and then switch on a relay. The relay
then stays on for a preset period of
time before it is switched off.
The dual op amps are an LMC6482
AIN (IC1) and an LM358 (IC2) and
these run from a +5V supply.
The signal voltage from the MAP
sensor or TPS is fed via a 1MΩ resistor with a 100nF low-pass filter capacitor to the non-inverting input of IC1a.
This operates as a unity gain buffer.
Its pin 1 output drives a differentiator
comprising a 100nF capacitor, 1MΩ
trimpot VR1 and a series-connected
100kΩ resistor.
The differentiator acts as a highpass filter, letting fast-changing signals
through but blocking slowly-changing
signals. This is exactly what we want
in order to sense the sudden change
as the driver lifts off or shoves the accelerator down.
The differentiator is connected to a
+2.5V reference which is derived from
the +5V rail with a voltage divider using 1kΩ divider resistors, bypassed
with a 100µF capacitor. With no signal
passing through the 100nF differentiator capacitor, the output voltage on the
VR1 side of the capacitor sits at +2.5V.
Depending on how the vehicle is
being driven, the MAP or TPS signal
will either be steady or decreasing or
increasing in voltage.
Exactly how much signal passes
through the 100nF differentiator capacitor is dependent on the rate of voltage change and the setting of trimpot
40 Silicon Chip
VR1. VR1 sets the time-constant of the
differentiator so high resistance settings for VR1 will mean that the circuit responds to more slowly changing
signals from the TPS or MAP sensor.
The differentiator output is buffered
using op amp IC1b and it provides the
high-to-low (H/L) output. IC2a is wired
as an inverting amplifier and it inverts
the output from IC1b. This provides
the low-to-high (L/H) output.
Jumper link JP1 then selects the
output of IC1b or IC2a. This allows
triggering on a falling (H/L) or rising
(L/H) input signal. The selected signal is applied to IC2b, a Schmitt trigger stage. IC2b has its inverting input
connected to a 2.27V reference derived using 12kΩ and 10kΩ resistors
connected across the 5V supply. The
non-inverting input is connected to
JP1 via a 10kΩ resistor. A 1MΩ hysteresis resistor connects between the
non-inverting input and IC2b’s output.
With no signal passing through the
differentiator, the voltage applied to
the non-inverting input via the 10kΩ
resistor to IC2b is 2.5V. Since the inverting input is at 2.27V, the output of
IC2b will be high, at around +4V. This
output goes low when the signal from
JP1 drops below the 2.27V threshold.
The associated 1MΩ feedback resistor
provides a degree of hysteresis so that
IC2b’s output does not oscillate at the
threshold voltage.
Relay timer
lC2b’s output drives the pin 2 trigger input of IC3, a 7555 timer, via a
1kΩ resistor. IC3 is triggered when
pin 2 drops below 1/3rd the 5V supply, at +1.67V.
When triggered, IC3’s output at pin
3 goes high, turning on transistor Q1
and relay RL1. Diode D2 is connected across the relay coil to quench the
spike voltages that are generated each
time transistor Q1 turns off. Q1 also
drives LED1 via a 1.8kΩ resistor to indicate whenever the relay is energised.
Before IC3 is triggered, its pin 3 output and its discharge pin (pin 7) are
both low. So pin 7 causes the negative side of the 100µF capacitor to be
pulled toward 0V via a 150Ω resistor.
Whenever IC2b’s output goes low it
also turns on transistor Q2, wired as an
emitter follower. The transistor keeps
the negative side of a 100µF capacitor tied at 0V. This keeps the 100µF
capacitor charged while ever IC2b’s
output is low.
When IC2b’s output goes high, Q2 is
off and the 100µF capacitor discharges
via trimpot VR2 and the series 1kΩ resistor, so that the negative side of the
capacitor rises toward the 5V supply.
When the negative side of the 1µF
capacitor rises to 2/3rds of the 5V supply (about +3.3V), the threshold voltage for pin 6 is reached.
At this point, pin 3 goes low
and transistor Q1 and the relay are
switched off. IC3’s timing period can
be set from around 100ms up to more
than 100 seconds, using VR2.
Power-up delay
The components connected to pin
4 of IC3 are used to provide a powerup delay. When the vehicle ignition
is switched on, the DTT circuit is prevented from operating the relay for a
short period. The delay components
comprise a 470µF capacitor, diode D4,
and 47kΩ and 82kΩ resistors. When
power is first applied to the circuit,
the 470µF capacitor is discharged and
so pin 4 is held low. This holds IC3
in reset so its pin 3 cannot go high to
drive Q2 and the relay.
IC3 becomes operational after about
a second when the 470µF capacitor charges via the 82kΩ resistor to
above operating threshold for pin 4.
The 47kΩ resistor is included to set
the maximum charge voltage at 1.8V.
That’s done so the 470µF capacitor
will discharge quickly via diode D4
and the 47kΩ resistor when power is
switched off.
Power for the circuit comes via the
+12V ignition supply. Diode D1 provides reverse polarity protection and
an LM2940CT-5.0 automotive regulator (REG1) provides the 5V supply for
all the circuitry, with the exception of
the relay and LED1.
Construction
The DTT is built on a PCB codsiliconchip.com.au
This design can use either a throttle position sensor or a MAP sensor (shown ringed above) – the choice is often made by the
easiest access. On this Honda VTEC engine, the MAP sensor is obviously more accessible so it would be the better choice.
ed 05102161 and measuring 105.5 x
60mm. It can be fitted into a UB3 plastic utility box that measures 130 x 68 x
44mm, with the PCB supported by the
integral side clips of the box. Alternatively, you can mount the PCB into a
different housing on short stand-offs
using the four corner mounting holes.
Fig.2 shows the component layout
for the PCB. The low-wattage resistors
can be installed first. The respective
resistor colour codes are shown in Table 1 but you should also use a digital
multimeter to check each resistor before it is installed. The diodes can go in
next and these need to be inserted with
the correct polarity with the striped
end (cathode, K) orientated as shown.
Take care when installing the IC sockets (optional) and the ICs. Make sure
that their orientation is correct and that
the correct IC is inserted in each place.
REG1 is installed with its leads bent
over at 90° so as to fit into the allocated holes in the PCB. The regulator is
then secured to the PCB using an M3 x
6mm screw and M3 nut before its leads
are soldered. The 3-way pin header for
JP1 is installed now with the shorter
pin length side inserted into the PCB,
leaving the longer pin length for the
jumper link.
siliconchip.com.au
The two long wire links can be installed now and then the capacitors
can go in. The electrolytic types must
be installed with the polarity shown,
with the plus side oriented toward the
sign as marked on the PCB. The ceramic and polyester capacitors (MKT)
can be installed with either orientation
on the PCB.
Install transistors Q1 and Q2 next.
Make sure that Q1 is a BC337 and Q2,
BC327. LED1 must be installed with its
anode side (longer lead length) orientated as shown. The LED is normally
just used to provide a relay-on indica-
tion that is useful when testing, so the
LED can be mounted close to the PCB.
VR1 and VR2 can go in next. Both
are 1MΩ multi-turn top-adjust types
and the screw adjustment needs to be
orientated as shown. This is so that
faster pedal movement for triggering
set by VR1 and longer time periods
set by VR2 are achieved with clockwise rotation.
The screw terminal blocks are installed with the open wire entry sides
facing outwards. The 5-way screw terminal block (CON3) consists of one
2-way and one 3-way block which are
It’s been done before
While the Delta Throttle Timer may be
a new concept to many readers, a similar approach is used in nearly all recent
model cars. The speed with which the
throttle is moved helps determine the
rate of transient ignition timing change
and the injection of fuel (the latter is the
accelerator pump, if you like).
In cars with sophisticated electronic
transmission control, gear down-changes are also determined by how fast the
throttle is moved as much as it is by how
far the throttle is moved.
In fact, in some cars the driver learns
to use this facility by:
• Moving the throttle slowly when a
down-change isn’t needed;
• Quickly moving the throttle a short distance when a one-gear down-change
is wanted;
• Quickly moving the throttle a longer
distance when two-gear down-changes are wanted.
With the DTT able to control anything
that can be electrically turned on and off,
the driver will be able to activate (either
consciously or unconsciously) a whole
range of devices.
March 2016 41
0.7mm WIRE LINKS
IC3
7555
X
47k
BC327
C2
D4
4148
C1
1k
1M
10k
10k
D3
RELAY1
1k
+
10F
+
Q1 BC337
QUICK BRAKE LIGHTS
X
N-C CONTACTS
C1
C2
N-O CONTACTS
Y
NC COM NO
100F
100nF
NC COM NO
82k
470F
CON2
CON3
TIME
+
1k
16120150
VR2 1M
4.7k
100k
+
2x 100F
4148
100F
12k
IC2
LM358
VR1 1M
10F
JP1
100nF SENSIT
10k
10k
100F
+
Q2
D2
4004
1.8k
A
GND
+
05102161
Rev.C
C 2016
STHGIL EKARB KCIUQ
150
100nF
IC1
LMC6482
H/L
+
1M
+
CON1
SIG GND
+5V FOR
MAP SENSOR
(IF REQUIRED)
L/H
1k
10F
LM2940
REG1
+5V
INPUT FROM
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR OR
MAP SENSOR
4004
+12V GND
CHASSIS
(0V)
D1
+
10F
+12V FROM
IGNITION
SWITCH
Y
GND
LED1
Fig.2: follow this parts layout diagram,
along with the photo at right to
assemble the Delta Throttle Timer.
All external wiring connections
are made via screw-terminal
blocks. The LED can be mounted
remotely (via a pair of hookup
wires) if you wish. The two links
(in place of the 4.7Ω 5W resistors
marked on the PCB) are too long to
be made from component lead offcuts;
hence the call for a length of 0.7mm
tinned copper wire in the parts list.
simply dovetailed together before installing them on the PCB.
Finally, complete the PCB assembly
by fitting the relay.
Initial testing
Apply power to the +12V and GND
terminals of CON1 and check for 5V at
CON1 between the +5V & GND terminals. If the voltage is within the range
of 4.85-5.15V, then this is OK. If the
voltage reads 0V, the 12V supply may
have been connected with reversed polarity or D1 may have been orientated
the wrong way.
Before doing any adjustments, trimpots VR1 and VR2 should be wound
anticlockwise until a faint click is
heard, indicating that the adjustment
is set fully anticlockwise. This sets
VR1 for maximum sensitivity to sensor
voltage change and VR2 for minimum
relay on-time. Then place a jumper
link on JP1 in the H/L position.
To simulate a throttle position sensor, connect a linear 10kΩ potentiometer to CON2, with the outside terminals
connected to GND and +5V and the
wiper to the SIG (signal) input. Adjust
the 10kΩ potentiometer clockwise and
then wind it quickly anticlockwise.
The relay should switch on and LED1
should light. You can now check the
Uh Oh, it won’t suit all cars!
As constructed, the DTT will work
with a throttle-position sensor that
has an output that varies within the
0-5V range. Just about all cars use
sensors that increase in voltage
with throttle opening.
However, the DTT can also be
used in cars where the sensor voltage decreases with an increasing
throttle opening (just move link LK1
to the H/L position to trigger with
decreasing sensor voltage).
What if you want to use an input
42 Silicon Chip
signal that rises as high as 12V? In
this case, you can attenuate the incoming signal to a range that can be
accepted by IC1a. To do this, connect a 470kresistor in parallel with
the 100nF capacitor that connects
between pin 3 of IC1a and ground
(ie, immediately to the left of IC1 on
the PCB).
Also, some older cars use a throttle
position switch, rather than a variable
sensor and in this case you cannot
use the DTT.
So before buying the kit, the
first step is to determine whether
you have a TPS or MAP sensor in
your car.
If you don’t know whether you
have a switch or variable sensor,
measure the output of the throttle
position sensor.
With one multimeter probe
earthed, a TPS will have a voltage
signal that varies somewhere within
the 0-5V range as you manually adjust the throttle.
siliconchip.com.au
Parts List
Throttle position sensors come in a wide variety of shapes
and styles – here’s just a small selection we found being offered for
sale. Unless yours is faulty (very rare) you should be able to tap across the one
already fitted to your vehicle. If you don’t know where to find the TPP, perhaps
this is not the right project for you!
effect of adjusting VR1 clockwise; this
will mean that the 10kΩ potentiometer
will need to be rotated more quickly
clockwise before the relay switches on.
VR2 can then be rotated clockwise to
set more on-time for the relay.
Installation
Most modern vehicles will have a
TPS (and possibly a MAP sensor as
well) and so this sensor can be used as
the signal source for the DTT. In this
case, only the signal input terminal
is used and isconnected to the signal
wire from the TPS which will normally be connected to the accelerator
pedal. In some cases though, it may
be located on the inlet manifold butterfly valve. The connections can be
found by checking the wiring against
a schematic diagram and connecting
to the wiper of the TPS potentiometer. Alternatively, you could probe the
TPS wires to find the one that varies
with throttle position. Note that some
TPS units will have two potentiometers plus a motor.
Use the potentiometer wiper output
that varies with throttle pedal position.
Once you have identified the correct
wire from the TPS, you can connect
a wire from it to the DTT PCB using
a Quick Splice connector (Jaycar Cat
HP-1206; packet of four). Just wrap it
around the existing TPS wire and the
new wire and simply squeeze it to
make a safe connection.
If you have an older vehicle, then it
will not have a TPS or engine management. In this case, a MAP sensor can
be used to monitor the inlet pressure.
Using a MAP sensor for manifold
pressure readings is suitable only for
petrol engines though, not diesels. The
5V supply provided on the DTT PCB
at CON2 can be used to supply the
MAP sensor. It is not critical which
MAP sensor is used. A secondhand
MAP sensor can be obtained from a
wreckers’ yard. Holden Commodore
MAP sensors are common. Alternatively, you can obtain a new one from
suppliers such as: www.cyberspace
autoparts.com.au/contents/en-uk/
d3721_Holden_Map_Sensors.html
The voltage output of a MAP sensor usually decreases with increasing
vacuum; typically 0.5V with a complete vacuum and up to about 4.5V at
atmospheric pressure. This is similar
to a TPS sensor which has an output of
about 0V at no throttle and 5V at maximum throttle. Note that the TPS output
will only vary with throttle position
when the ignition is on. And naturally
a MAP sensor will only vary its output
with changes in manifold pressure, ie,
when the engine is running.
You can now install it in your car.
Having made the connection to the
TPS or MAP sensor, the next step is
to measure the output of the sensor
and confirm that it varies over a 0-5V
range when the throttle is moved. If
so, install link LK1 in the “L/H” position so that the circuit triggers with
increasing sensor voltage (ie, for quick
throttle presses).
You can now connect ignitionswitched +12V, earth and the throttle
position signal to the DTT. Note that
to get the throttle signal, you simply
tap into the throttle position output
wire – you don’t need to cut it. This
Similarly, there’s a huge range of MAP sensors
available (that stands for
Manifold Absolute Pressure,
by the way). Perhaps the
easiest way to identify the
MAP sensor (apart from
any label which says so!)
is the fact that MAP sensors
will normally have three
wires: +V, 0V and signal.
siliconchip.com.au
1 double-sided PCB, code
05102161, 105.5 x 60mm
1 UB3 plastic utility box, 130 x
68 x 44mm
1 12V DC DPDT PCB-mount
relay (Jaycar SY-4052 [5A],
Altronics S4190D [8A],
S4270A [8A])
(RLY1)
1 set of Quick Splice connectors
(Jaycar HP-1206 or similar)
2 2-way PCB-mount screw
terminals, 5.08mm spacing
(CON1,CON3)
2 3-way PCB-mount screw
terminals, 5.08mm spacing
(CON2,CON3)
1 3-way pin header, 2.54mm pin
spacing (JP1)
1 2.54mm jumper shunt (JP1)
2 1M vertical multi-turn
trimpots (VR1,VR2)
4 tapped spacers, M3 x 6.3mm*
5 M3 x 6mm screws*
1 M3 nut
100mm length 0.7mm tinned
copper wire (LK1 & LK2)
Semiconductors
1 LMC6482AIN dual CMOS
op amp (IC1)
1 LM358 dual op amp (IC2)
1 7555 CMOS timer (IC3)
1 LM2940CT-5.0 3-terminal 5V
low-dropout regulator (REG1)
1 3mm or 5mm red LED (LED1)
1 BC337 NPN transistor (Q1)
1 BC327 PNP transistor (Q2)
2 1N4004 1A diodes (D1,D2)
2 1N4148 diodes (D3,D4)
Capacitors
1 470µF 16V PC electrolytic
5 100µF 16V PC electrolytic
4 10µF 16V PC electrolytic
3 100nF MKT polyester
Resistors (0.25W, 1%)
2 1M
1 100k
1 82k
1 47k
1 12k
4 10k
1 4.7k
1 1.8k
4 1k
1 150
*4 tapped spacers and 4 M3
screws are not required if PCB is
mounted in a UB3 box.
latter connection can be made either at
the ECU or at the throttle body itself.
Next, adjust both trimpots fully anti-clockwise – this increases the sensitivity of the DTT to throttle changes
March 2016 43
IGNITION
SWITCHED
+12V
100nF
0.7mm WIRE LINKS
IC3
7555
47k
BC327
1k
12k
1M
COM
NC COM NO
D4
4148
10k
10k
CON3
TIME
NO
NC COM NO
D3
RELAY1
1k
+
10F
100F
CON2
16120150
VR2 1M
2x 100F
82k
470F
1k
Q2
+
4.7k
100k
100nF
+
4148
10F
100F
IN
THROTTLE
POSITION
SENSOR
OUTPUT
IC2
LM358
H/L
100F
VR1 1M
1k
1M
+
CHASSIS
(0V)
L/H
CON1
JP1
100nF SENSIT
10k
10k
GND
REG1
+
+12V
05102161
Rev.C
C 2016
STHGIL EKARB KCIUQ
150
LM2940
IC1
LMC6482
D1
4004
+
+
10F
10F
+
and reduces the timer’s “on” time to a
minimum. (Note that both these pots
are multi-turn so they don’t have a
distinct end “stop”.)
If using a TPS, turn the ignition on
but don’t start the car. Wait five seconds (remember: the DTT has an ignition-on reset pause), then quickly
push down on the throttle and check
that the relay pulls in and that the LED
lights. The relay should then click out
(and the LED go off) fairly quickly, so
adjust the righthand trimpot clockwise
and again push down quickly on the
accelerator pedal. This time, the “on”
time should be longer.
If using a MAP sensor, the engine
needs to be running.
The next step is to adjust the lefthand trimpot clockwise until the DTT
responds only when the throttle is
being pushed down with “real life”
quick movements. That done, move
LK1 to the H/L position and confirm
that the DTT now responds only to
quick throttle lifts.
Finally, move LK1 back to the L/H
position if you want the circuit to trigger on a rising sensor voltage.
+
QUICK BRAKE LIGHTS
Q1 BC337
D2
4004
1.8k
A
LED1
Fig.3: a simplified diagram showing how to
connect the DTT to a turbo boost bleed solenoid.
Setting Up
Setting up the DTT is also easy. Normally, you’ll find that driving on the
road actually involves different speeds
of throttle movement than used during the static set-up, so the sensitivity control will need to be adjusted
accordingly. The length of time that
you set the timer to operate for will
depend very much on what you are
controlling.
The PCB is
designed to snap
into the guides in a UB3 Jiffy Box.
Otherwise you can use four spacer pillars and
screws, as shown in the photo on page 42.
TURBO
BOOST
BLEED
SOLENOID
CHASSIS
(0V)
The prototype was used to automatically activate the Power mode in
an auto transmission, an easy task to
accomplish.
All you have to do is wire the Normally Open (NO) and Common (C)
terminals of the relay in parallel with
the Power/Economy switch (this still
allows the switch to be manually used
as an over-ride). In this application, a
DTT timer “on” period of about 7.5
seconds was ideal – any longer and
sometimes the car would hang on too
long in third gear before finally changing up to fourth, while lesser time periods meant that sometimes the DTT
would click out of Power mode while
the driver was still pushing hard.
Incidentally, the driveability of the
car was transformed by the use of the
DTT in this way – after all, it’s a bit like
having a little man sitting on the centre
console, ready to push in the Power/
Economy button every time you slam
the throttle down fast!
The PCB fits straight into a 130 x 68
x 42mm zippy box, so when the system is working correctly, the board can
be inserted into the box and tucked
out of sight.
SC
Resistor Colour Codes
No.
2
1
1
1
1
4
1
1
4
1
44 Silicon Chip
Value
1MΩ
100kΩ
82kΩ
47kΩ
12kΩ
10kΩ
4.7kΩ
1.8kΩ
1kΩ
150Ω
4-Band Code (1%)
brown black green brown
brown black yellow brown
grey red orange brown
yellow violet orange brown
brown red orange brown
brown black orange brown
yellow violet red brown
brown grey red brown
brown black red brown
brown green brown brown
5-Band Code (1%)
brown black black yellow brown
brown black black orange brown
grey red black red brown
yellow violet black red brown
brown red black red brown
brown black black red brown
yellow violet black brown brown
brown grey black brown brown
brown black black brown brown
brown green black black brown
siliconchip.com.au
Power into Autumn
Bench Top Power Bundle
VALUED OVER $330
$
COMPACT SWITCHMODE LABORATORY POWER SUPPLY
MP-3800 $149
HIGH QUALITY BANANA PIGGYBACK TEST LEADS WT-5326 $29.95
TOUGH HEAVY DUTY IP67 TRUE RMS AUTORANGING DMM
QM-1574 $129
279
90W Automatic
Mini Car Laptop
Power Supply MP-3334
SAVE OVER $50
NON-CONTACT AC VOLTAGE DETECTOR
Charge your laptop as you drive. Compact in size
with the electronics housed within the cigarette
lighter plug itself. Supplied with 10 DC
connectors. Output voltage 14.5 - 20VDC.
$
NEW
5995
QP-2268 $24.95
9ea
$ 95
Single Core Conductors - 10m Rolls
15A rated current. Total diameter is 3.3mm. Max temperature 80°C.
RED WH-3054
BLACK WH-3055
GREEN WH-3056
PP-4045
NEW
$
$
209
120A 12/24VDC Programmable
Dual Battery Isolator MB-3688
ea
2495
NEW
NEW
3495
$
NEW
Outbound Mains
Travel Adaptors
WITH 4 USB SOCKETS
• Use Australian appliances overseas
• Provides 2.1A 4 USB charging ports to charge a
Designed to meet your vehicle’s specific application. Tablet or Smartphone.
The Microprocessor Controlled circuit provides
Does not convert voltage, suitable for 240V 50Hz mains.
accurate monitoring, finer tuning of voltage, delay
AUSTRALIA TO USA PP-4045
timer set points and more fail safe protection with
AUSTRALIA TO EUROPE PP-4047
diagnostic display.
• 90(L) x 90(W) x 85(H)mm
$
240V GPO Wall Plate
WITH 4 X USB PS-4071
This hardwired USB adaptor will fit into a standard
GPO wall plate base and give 4 USB power sockets
with a total of 3.1 amps.
AUSTRALIA TO UK & HK PP-4049
NEW
FROM
1995
POWER ACCESSORIES
NEW
DOUBLE
POINTS
PT-4470
Chassis Mount
Anderson® Type Adaptors
These products enable you to mount an Anderson®
type plug onto a chassis frame, bull bar, etc.
50A BLACK PT-4460 $19.95
50A RED PT-4470 $19.95
120A BLACK PT-4462 $24.95
175A BLACK PT-4464 $27.95
ALSO AVAILABLE:
DUSTPROOF RUBBER BOOT FOR 50A
PT-4474 $3.95
NEW
PANEL MOUNT CONNECTOR
PT-4472 $24.95
50A CONNECTOR COVER QUICKFIT
PT-4466 $25.95
$
3495
$
4995
2 Outlet Workstation Centre
4 Outlet Power Block WITH
Fits into a standard 60mm desk grommet.
Minimizes desktop clutter. Features 2 surge
protected power sockets and 1 USB port.
• Max Current: 10A
• Surge Protected to 175 joules
• USB Socket: 5V at 1A (below the picture but
smaller)
Unique securing loops ensure plugs do not
accidentally pull from sockets
• 240VAC at 10A max
• USB outlet 5VDC at 1A
• Dust cover for USB socket
WITH USB 1A SOCKET MS-4082
SECURING LOOPS AND USB MS-4083
$
Weatherproof Outdoor
Powerboard Enclosure HB-6179
Protects 240 volt power cables from outdoor
elements.
• IP44 weather resistant rating.
• Fits extra long powerboards up to 42cm long
• Wall mountable
Accessories not included
COME VISIT US AT THE MINI MAKER FAIRE
Catalogue Sale 28 February - 23 March, 2016
5495
19 MARCH, KIOSC <at> SWINBURNE UNIVERSITY OF
TECHNOLOGY, 369 STUD RD WANTIRNA, VICTORIA
WWW.MAKERSFAIRE.COM.AU
To order phone 1800 022 888 or visit www.jaycar.com.au
ALL ABOUT POWER
240 - 115V STEPDOWN
TRANSFORMERS
$
49
DC-AC POWER
MI-5106
95
$
50VA 240VAC to 115VAC
Stepdown Transformer MF-1091
Includes overheat protection. If the unit gets too hot,
the thermal fuse will open, then close after unit cools
down, restoring operation. Two pin US socket on unit
for 110V appliance and cord plug for 240V power.
• This is not dielectrically isolated
• 50V.A
FROM
59
95
$
FROM
249
12VDC to 230VAC
Electrically Isolated Inverters
12VDC to 230VAC
Pure Sine Wave Inverters
300W MI-5104 $79.95
400W MI-5106 $89
180W MI-5700 $249
360W MI-5702 $319
The cigarette lighter plug is fused with a 15A 3AG fuse, and the output They include advanced control logic which provides standard
is a standard 3 pin mains socket. Modified sine wave.
protection as well as a host of additional features to provide improved
performance and reliability under adverse conditions.
150W MI-5102 $59.95
FROM
$
AC-AC POWER
119
Isolated Stepdown
Transformers
MF-1080
Fully-enclosed with fold up metal carry handles,
approved 3-wire power cord & US style 2 pin 110
- 115V socket. Electrically isolated between
primary and secondary. Useable with precision
electric & electronic appliances. Compact,
excellent, safe and robust construction - steel case
120W 240V - 115V MF-1080 $119
250W 240V -115V MF-1082 $169
500W 240V -115V MF-1084 $289
1000W 240V - 115V MF-1086 $419
FROM
ea
1895
$
7
$ 95
Centre Tapped Transformers
9V, 1.35VA, 150MA MM-2017 $7.95
24V, 3.6VA, 150MA MM-2018 $8.95
12.6V CT, 1.9VA, 150MA MM-2006 $7.95
30V CT, 4.5VA, 150MA MM-2007 $8.95
$
Multi-Tapped Transformers
9V - 24V, 60VA, 5A MM-2014 $27.95
12V - 30V, 100VA, 6A MM-2015 $29.95
DESKTOP STYLE AC ADAPTORS
FROM
109
$
13.8V Laboratory
Power Supply
MP-3097
These power supplies are available in
three current capacities. They use proven
technology and are designed to give long
service life in workshop situations. The
range features short circuit protection on
the output and a fused input.
5A MP-3096 $109
10A MP-3097 $149
20A MP-3098 $219
FROM
2795
Multi-Tapped / Dual
Transformer
15 - 30V, 30VA, 1A MM-2008
6-14V, 30VA, 2A MM-2004
POWER SUPPLY
$
MI-5700
MP-3242
3995
12VDC 7.5A Switchmode
Power Supply MP-3575
A handy solution for powering 12V equipment such
as car coolers, camping fridges, etc, from a mains
AC power source. Supplied with a 1.5m output lead
with cigarette socket output, making connection
simple and easy.
• Input voltage: 240VAC
• 57(L) x 90(W) x 57(H)mm
$
FROM
7995
$
5995
60W Desktop Style AC Adaptor 120W 12VDC 10A Switchmode
Power Supply DESKTOP STYLE
Versatile switchmode power supplies in a range of
different configurations.
12VDC 5A MP-3242 $59.95
19VDC 3.42A MP-3246 $59.95
24VDC 2.7A MP-3248 $59.95
12VDC(5 PLUGS) 5A MP-3243 $64.95
MP-3241
High current switchmode desktop power supply.
Suitable for various power requirements, including
large surveillance systems to replace a number of
smaller plugpacks.
• Output cable terminated to fixed 2.1mm DC plug
DOUBLE POINTS FOR NERD PERKS CARD HOLDERS ON THESE SWITCHMODE AC ADAPTORS
DOUBLE
POINTS
DOUBLE
POINTS
MP-3144
DOUBLE
POINTS
MP-3496
DOUBLE
POINTS
MP-3310
1795
ea
$
FROM
1995
$
5W Ultra-Slim
Switchmode Power Adaptors
Switchmode Plugpacks
WITH USB OUTLET
Supplied with 7 plugs and a USB output socket.
Incorporates a high efficiency circuit, built in EMI
filter, short circuit protection, over current protection 3-12VDC 600MA MP-3310 $19.95
and thermal shutdown capability.
3-12VDC 1.0A MP-3312 $24.95
5VDC 1A MP-3144
3-12VDC 1.5A MP-3314 $29.95
6VDC 0.8A MP-3145
9VDC 0.5A MP-3146
12VDC 0.4A MP-3147
3-12VDC 2.25A MP-3316 $34.95
9-24VDC 1-1.5A MP-3318 $34.95
Page 2
MP-3480
$
2495
ea
15W Switchmode Slim High
Power Connectors
Regulated output voltage, small size and higher
power output make these AC adaptors suitable for
thousands of different applications.
5VDC 3.0A MP-3480
6VDC 2.2A MP-3482
9VDC 1.7A MP-3484
12VDC 1.5A MP-3486
Follow us at facebook.com/jaycarelectronics
$
2995
ea
25W Extra High
Power Adaptors
• 100-240VAC 50/60Hz
• Supplied with 7 plugs
9VDC 3.0A MP-3496
12VDC 2.5A MP-3490
15VDC 2.0A MP-3492
24VDC 1.25A MP-3494
Catalogue Sale 28 February - 23 March, 2016
ALL ABOUT POWER
DC-DC CONVERTERS
$
FROM
$
2495
DC to DC Converter Modules
Handy DC voltage converter modules that can stepup or step-down voltages so you can power your
devices where a different power source is present.
They feature protection against short-circuits,
overload and over-heating. They will auto-switch off
in the event of overheating.
1.5A STEP DOWN AA-0236 $24.95
2A STEP UP AA-0237 $29.95
1.1A STEP DOWN AA-0238 $24.95
3995
$
60W Regulated
Car Power Adaptor MP-3478
It powers MP3 players, games, CD players,
appliances or anything else that requires 5 - 12VDC
at up to 5A. Fuse protected and includes four plug
adaptors to suit most popular devices.
• Selectable voltage: 5, 6, 9 & 12VDC
POWER PANEL METERS
6495
FROM
8995
MS-6172
Digital DC Power Meters
An ideal addition to any low voltage DC system this
digital power meter features real time display of the
voltage, current draw, and power consumption.
0-20A WITH INTERNAL SHUNT
MS-6170 $89.95
0-200A TO SUIT 50MV EXTERNAL SHUNT
MS-6172 $89.95
ALSO AVAILABLE:
USB DATA ADAPTOR MS-6174 $99.95
MP-3063
24VDC TO 12VDC 5A Converter 24VDC to 12VDC Converters
WITH USB MP-3354
It converts 24VDC to 12VDC so that you can use
normal car accessories designed for 12V vehicles.
Input: 24V Cigarette lighter plug; Output: 12V
Cigarette lighter socket.
Maximum rated current: 5A.
These converters have switchmode technology for
light weight and compact design, and come in a
range of current ratings up to 40 amps.
10A MP-3061 $74.95
20A MP-3063 $119
40A MP-3066 $149
POWER PROTECTION
$
$
FROM
7495
$
$
4395
FROM
2495
$
Self-Powered
LED Panel Meters
Simple 2 wire connection for voltage readout.
Auto zero calibration and easy to read red
LED display. Give your next project a truly
professional look. Cutout size 42 x 23mm.
8-30V VOLTMETER QP-5586 $24.95
0-50A AMMETER QP-5588 $39.95
1795
DOUBLE
POINTS
Surge Protected Mains
Double Adaptor WITH 2 X USB
PORTS PP-4037
Provides 2 x mains sockets and 2 x USB
sockets. Features a green grounded LED and
red protected LED. Surge protected.USB socket
output: 5V at 1A Voltage: 230-240VAC. 91(W) x
72(W) x 55(D)mm.
Battery Discharge
Protector AA-0262
DOUBLE
POINTS
Protects your car battery from total discharge by
switching off appliances such as fridges and TV sets
before the battery voltage drops to an unrecoverable
level. When battery voltage is re-established by
recharging, it switches appliances on automatically.
• Operating voltage: 12VDC
• Max. switching current: 20A
• Interrupting voltage: 10.4 - 13.3VDC
• 87(L) x 60(W) x 32(H)mm
DOUBLE POINTS FOR NERD PERKS CARD HOLDERS ON THESE POWER ACCESSORIES
$
34
95
DOUBLE
POINTS
DOUBLE
POINTS
FROM
25¢/m
12VDC 8A Dimmer
/ Motor Speed Controller MP-3209
General Purpose Power Cables
The pulse width modulation (PWM) used in this controller allows
you to vary the output from 0 to 100% while maintaining a very high
efficiency. When used on motors this ensures full torque is available
at very low speed and the motor won't shudder at start-up. Operates
on any 12VDC system and capable of controlling devices rated at up
to 8 amps.
• 95(L) x 47(W) x 26(H)mm
FLEXIBLE LIGHT DUTY Suitable for general purpose wiring. 13x
0.12mm. PVC insulation. 0.6A rated current. WH-3016 $0.25/M
HEAVY DUTY Suitable for 250V wiring. 24 x 0.2mm.
PVC insulation. 7.5A rated current. WH-3040 $0.5/M
EXTRA HEAVY DUTY Suitable for 250V wiring. 32 x 0.2 mm. PVC
insulation. 10A rated current WH-3052 $0.70/M
DOUBLE POINTS ON
ALL POWER CABLES
1595
$
Stainless Steel
Wire Stripper, Cutter, Pliers
DOUBLE
POINTS
TH-1841
High quality precision stripper/cutter. Spring-loaded with locking
jaws, rubber handles for added comfort. Cuts wire up to 3.0mm.
Strips wire up to 2.6mm.
DOUBLE
POINTS
EARN A POINT FOR EVERY DOLLAR SPENT AT ANY
JAYCAR COMPANY STORE* & BE REWARDED WITH
A $25 JAYCOINS CASH CARD ONCE YOU REACH
500 POINTS! *Conditions apply. See website for T&Cs
FROM
1/m
$ 25
DOUBLE
POINTS
AC Mains Cables
TWO CORE MAINS FLEX 7.5A WB-1560 $1.25/M
THREE CORE MAINS FLEX 10A WB-1562 $2.50/M
To order phone 1800 022 888 or visit www.jaycar.com.au
SIGN-UP IN-STORE OR ONLINE TODAY BY VISITING:
www.jaycar.com.au/nerdperks
See terms & conditions on page 8.
Page 3
ALL ABOUT BATTERIES
NICKEL METAL HYDRIDE (NI-MH) RECHARGEABLE BATTERIES
LIFEP04 BATTERIES
9
$ 95
3.2V LIFEPO4
Rechargeable Batteries
Lithium iron phosphate (LiFePO4) is a more chemically
stable type of lithium rechargeable cell that is becoming
increasingly popular, due to increased safety and longer
cycle life over traditional Li-ion cells.
14500 600MAH SB-2305 $9.95
18650 1600MAH SB-2307 $17.95
26650 3000MAH SB-2317 $24.95
LI-ION BATTERIES
NIPPLE CONNECTION:
AA 2000MAH SB-1706 $4.25
AA 2000MAH 4 PACK SB-1737 $15.95
AAA 900MAH 4 PACK SB-1739 $10.95
SOLDER TABS CONNECTION:
AA 2000MAH SB-1708 $4.45
2000MAH AA 2 PACK SB-2930 $16.95
2000MAH AA 4 PACK SB-2931 $29.95
800MAH AAA 2 PACK SB-2932 $16.95
800MAH AAA 4 PACK SB-2933 $32.95
FROM
9
SB-1706
FROM
4
$ 25
For even more demanding applications the
Panasonic XX High Capacity range are perfect.
Can be recharged 500 times, and will retain 75%
of their capacity after a year in storage. They can
also be used in sub-zero temperatures (-20°C)
without issue.
SB-1734 $44.95
C 4500MAH NIPPLE 2 PACK
SB-1733 $22.95
$
Choose between nipple or solder tabs to make
into battery packs for replacement or new projects.
FROM
1695
$
Panasonic XX High Capacity
Eneloop Ni-MH 1.2V
D 9000MAH NIPPLE 2 PACK
Rechargeable Li-ion Batteries
NIPPLE CONNECTION:
14500 800MAH 3.7V SB-2300 $9.95
18650 2600MAH 3.7V SB-2308 $19.95
26650 3400MAH 3.7V SB-2315 $24.95
SOLDER CONNECTION:
14500 800MAH 3.7V SB-2301 $10.95
18650 2600MAH 3.7V SB-2313 $21.95
26650 3400MAH 3.7V SB-2319 $25.95
This range of Panasonic eneloop batteries have
numerous advantages over regular rechargeables. They
include low self-discharge, they are pre-charged so can
be used right out of the packet, and can be recharged up
to 1800 times. After 5 years of storage they will retain
70% of their capacity once fully charged. A far more
environmentally friendly option than churning through
dozens of alkalines.
1.2V Ni-MH
Rechargeable Batteries
$ 95
SB-2300
Panasonic Eneloop Ni-MH 1.2V 2000mAH
Nickel Metal Hydride (Ni-MH) batteries offer superior
features to Nickel Cadmium batteries.
• No memory effect
• Higher current capacity than Ni-Cd batteries
• High drain performance
FROM
SB-2317
1.2A Rechargeable Ni-MH Battery
FROM
2295
SB-1734
900MAH AAA 4 PACK SB-2938 $39.95
2500MAH AA 4 PACK SB-2936 $33.95
$
FROM
3395
SB-2938
COMPUTER BACKUP
BATT LITHIUM
1/2AA 3.6V
High capacity batteries used in computers to retain
date, time and configuration information. Also
useful for long shelf life or fitting into difficult or
sealed access areas. Up to 10 years storage life.
HALF AA 900MAH NIPPLE SB-1770 $11.95
HALF AA 900MAH AXIAL LEAD SB-1771 $13.95
AA 2000MAH NIPPLE SB-1774 $16.95
AA 2000MAH AXIAL LEAD SB-1775 $18.95
FROM
1195
$
BATTERY CHARGERS
Batteries not
included.
$
24
$
$
95
Universal Ni-Cd/Ni-MH Battery
Charger WITH CUT-OFF MB-3514
• Recharges: AAA, AA, C , D and 9V batteries
• Cut-off function
• Accepts various combinations of batteries
• 199(L) x 100(W) x 46(H)mm
2995
$
2 Hour Fast Charger for AA/
AAA Ni-MH Batteries MB-3549
Utilises Delta V voltage detection. Charges batteries
to optimal level. Charge state can be monitored
on the integrated electric blue LCD. Includes car
cigarette lighter and mains charger cords.
• 1150mA charging current for AA batteries
• 600mA charging current for AAA batteries
• 105(L) x 68W) x 30(H)mm
5995
$
1395
$
Battery, Bulb
and Fuse Tester QP-2252
DOUBLE
POINTS
Tests AAA, AA, C, D (1.5V) & 9V batteries and
indicates their power level. It checks bulbs and
fuses, giving a 'good' or 'replace' indication, and
will also test larger 1.5V button batteries like the
LR-44. Requires 9V batteries.
Page 4
Universal Programmable
Balanced Battery Charger
Smart Battery Charger
NI-CD & NI-MH MB-3551
Chargers up to 10 x AA or AAA cells and 2 x 9
volt batteries. Uses Delta V sensing to achieve
the maximum charge. A maximum charging timer
protects against overcharging & individual LEDs
show battery status.
• Mains power & 12V car adaptor supplied
• 220(W) x 40(H) x 115(D)mm
PH-9280
2395
PH-9260
FROM
All in One
Battery Tester QP-2253
DOUBLE
POINTS
Can test standard AA/AAA/C/D/9V batteries, button
cells and lithium batteries such as those used in
digital cameras.
MB-3632
Charges Li-Ion, Li-Po, NI-Cd, Ni-MH and lead
acid batteries. Li-Po batteries are balance-charged
so there's no risk of damage or explosion from
incorrect charging. Programmable charging
process. Charging of each individual cell can be
monitored on the LCD screen. Powered by mains
plugpack or a 12V battery (or any other DC source
from 10 - 18 volts). 132(L) x 82(W) x 28(H)mm.
BATTERY HOLDERS
SEE THE WHOLE RANGE IN-STORE!
BATTERY TESTERS
Batteries not included.
8995
95¢
AA Battery Holders
FROM
DOUBLE
POINTS
2XAA SIDE BY SIDE PH-9202 $0.95
2XAA SWITCHED BATTERY ENCLOSURE
PH-9280 $2.45
Follow us at twitter.com/jaycarAU
80¢
AAA Battery Holders
DOUBLE
POINTS
Moulded in Derlin with corrosive resistant nickel
plated springs and studs
1 X AAA PH-9260 $0.80
2X AAA PH-9226 $1.45
Catalogue Sale 28 February - 23 March, 2016
SOLAR SOLUTIONS
SOLAR PANELS
Powertech Monocrystalline Solar Panels
The panels are fitted with a waterproof junction box, UV stabilized output cables
and bypass diodes to withstand harsh environments.
12V 20W ZM-9094 $69.95
12V 40W ZM-9095 $129
12V 80W ZM-9097 $269
12V 120W ZM-9085 $329
12V 145W ZM-9087 $399
24V 200W ZM-9088 $559
$
12V Semi-Flexible Solar Panels
These monocrystalline solar panels can be easily mounted on the curved surfaces of
your boat deck or caravan to charge on-board batteries. The flexibility of the solar cells is
limited by the plastic base but will easily bend on the long axis to accommodate a yacht
deck or RV roof. It is slightly flexible on the short axis.
ZM-9152
40W ZM-9152 $199
ZM-9097
100W ZM-9154 $429
180W ZM-9156 $749
FROM
6995
ZM-9095
FROM
199
$
HIGH CURRENT CONNECTORS
SOLAR CONNECTORS AND CRIMPS
VALUED AT $94.90
9ea
$ 95
Anderson® 50A
Power Connectors
PT-4420
Used widely in both domestic and industry, you’ll
find this connector in many 4WD applications,
boating, automotive and other industries. Supplied
as a moulded 2 pole with contacts.
50A, 600V (AC or DC).
95
PT-4424
Anderson® 120A
& 175A Power Connectors
120A PT-4422 $19.95
175A PT-4424 $29.95
$
FROM
6495
$
MP-3129
Solar Charge Controllers
2995
This unit is capable of handling all of your solar
charging requirements and protects your battery.
It has an array of features including adjustable
charging voltage, automatic dusk-till-dawn on/off,
overload protection, etc.
12V 5A Battery
Charging Regulator
FOR SOLAR PANELS AA-0348
Ideal for charging 12V SLA batteries from solar
panels up to 60 watts. 5 amp fuse and fuseholder
recommended - not supplied.
• <3.9mA (LEDs on) own power consumption
• 72(W) x 50(D) x 43(H)mm
See our website for details.
12V 8A WATERPROOF MP-3720 $64.95
12V 20A MP-3129 $179
24V 20A MP-3724 $199
12V 30A MP-3722 $219
7ea
$ 50
12V/24V 30A MPPT Solar
Charge Controller MP-3735
Maximum Power Point Tracking technology uses
DC to DC conversion and electronic smarts to
extract the absolute maximum charging power
from your solar panels. Gives you an extra 10-40%
from your solar panels compared to a normal PWM
charge controller.
• 3-stage charging
• LCD display
SF-4150
FROM
7995
$
4ea
$ 95
Aluminium Solar Panel Angle
Mounting Bracket HS-8785
DOUBLE
POINTS
9
DOUBLE
POINTS
$ 95
SZ-2090
Power Distribution Posts
WITH BRIDGE PLATE
Heavy duty stainless steel posts mounted on a
moulded plastic base.
Mounting a single solar panel allows you to tilt the
SINGLE M10 SZ-2090 $9.95
panel to your desired angle.
TWIN M8 SZ-2092 $11.95
• Holes pre-drilled to line up with 80W panels
TWIN M6 POWER SZ-2094 $11.95
• Supplied with full stainless steel hardware
To order phone 1800 022 888 or visit www.jaycar.com.au
Waterproof Solar
Power PV Connectors
IP67 rated for maximum environmental
protection.
• 1000VDC rated voltage
• 30A at 70°C, 25A at 85°C rated current
4MM FEMALE INLINE PS-5100
4MM MALE INLINE PP-5102
6MM FEMALE PANEL MOUNT PS-5104
6MM MALE PANEL MOUNT PP-5106
Solar Panel
'Y' Leads
2 PLUG TO 1 SOCKET
DOUBLE
POINTS
10A SINGLE POLE SF-4150
16A SINGLE POLE SF-4151
20A SINGLE POLE SF-4152
32A SINGLE POLE SF-4153
PP-5106
259
DOUBLE POINTS FOR NERD PERKS CARD HOLDERS ON THESE SOLAR PANEL ACCESSORIES
DIN rail mounted circuit breakers
suitable for solar applications.
Electrical safety authority approved.
5990
SAVE $35
DOUBLE
POINTS
SZ-2016 VALUED AT $3.50
SF-2200 VALUED AT $0.40
BUNDLE
SOLAR PANEL CONNECTORS
- DOUBLE POINTS
SOLAR CHARGE REGULATORS / CONTROLLERS
Valid with purchase of AA-0348.
240VAC High Current
Circuit Breakers
$
QUICK CHANGE CRIMP TOOL DIES PV TO SUIT TH-2000 TH-2010 $29.95
ALSO AVAILABLE:
SOLAR SYSTEM CABLE FROM $4.20/M
*
$
NERD PERKS CLUB
TH-2000 $49.95
Used widely in both domestic and industry.
Supplied individually with a pair of contacts.
600V (AC or DC).
WITH 8 GAUGE CONTACTS PT-4425
WITH 10-12 GAUGE CONTACTS PT-4427
WITH 6 GAUGE CONTACTS PT-4420
FREE FUSE AND HOLDER FOR
NERD PERKS CARD HOLDERS*
SZ-2016 & SF-2200
FROM
19
$
BUNDLE INCLUDES:
1X WATERPROOF SOLAR POWER “PV”
CONNECTOR 4MM FEMALE PS-5100 $7.50
1X WATERPROOF SOLAR POWER “PV”
CONNECTOR 4MM MALE PP-5102 $7.50
QUICK CHANGE RATCHET CRIMP TOOL
See terms & conditions on page 8.
Used for connecting the output
of two solar panels in parallel or
connecting multiple panels
in an array. Waterproof and UV
resistant.
$
1995
ea
2 SOCKET TO 1 PLUG
PS-5110
2 PLUGS TO 1 SOCKET
PS-5112
DOUBLE
POINTS
PS-5110
Page 5
ARDUINO® COMPATIBLE & DIY ESSENTIALS
SEE STEP-BY-STEP INSTRUCTIONS ON
www.jaycar.com.au/diy-arduino-led-tester
ARDUINO PROJECT FOR NERD PERKS CARD HOLDERS
Build Your Own Arduino® LED Tester
Features include:
• Adjustable test current.
• Displays LED Forward Operating voltage.
• Calculates ideal resistor & gives cat. number for a design voltage and current.
• Only 3 discrete components to be soldered.
• Detachable shields - pull it apart & use for other projects.
NERD PERKS OFFER
ADVANCED BUNDLE
$
4995
SAVE OVER $12
PROJECT BUNDLE:
VALUED AT $62.55
Completed project.
BUNDLE INCLUDES:
DUINOTECH CLASSIC (UNO) XC-4410 $29.95
ARDUINO® COMPATIBLE PROTOTYPING BOARD SHIELD XC-4482 $15.95
ARDUINO® COMPATIBLE 2 X 16 LCD CONTROLLER MODULE XC-4454 $14.95
10OHM 1/2 WATT 1% METAL FILM RESISTORS - PK.8 RR-0538 $0.55
10OHM 1/2 WATT 1% METAL FILM RESISTORS - PK.8 RR-0524 $0.55
470UF 16V RB ELECTROLYTIC CAPACITOR RE-6194 $0.60
ACCESSORIES TO USE WITH DUINOTECH CLASSIC (UNO)
$
7
$ 95
$
1995
Arduino Compatible RF
Transceiver Module XC-4522
®
Arduino® Compatible DC - DC
Stepdown Module XC-4514
This moduleaccepts any voltage from 4.5 - 35VDC,
and outputs any lower voltage from 3-34V.Output
is adjusted via a multi-turn potentiometer. Use it
to run your 5VDuinotech projects from a 6v, 9v or
even 12v Supply.
4795
LeoStick XC-4266
A tiny board small enough to plug straight to
the USB port without requiring a cable. Features
ATmega32u4 MCU with 2.5K RAM and 32K Flash.
• Analogue & digital I/O
• User-controlled RGB LED
• 9(W) x 19(H) x 8(D)mm
This module adds a versatile 433MHz radio to
your Duinotech project allowing two-way wireless
communication between Duinotechs. Controlled via
ALSO AVAILABLE:
SPI. Prewritten libraries available.
• Includes antenna.
LEOSTICK PROTOTYPING SHIELD
XC-4268 $9.95
• 32(W) x 19(L) x 19(H)mm (Excluding antenna)
$
2995
DuinoTECH Classic (UNO)
XC-4410
ATMega328P Microcontroller. Powered from
7-12VDC or from your computers USB port.
5VDC Regulated via USB port or 5V pin.
• 75(W) x 53(L) x 13(H)mm
ARDUINO®
KITS
ARDUINO® COMPATIBLE
DOUBLE
POINTS
$
109
4
$ 20
Arduino Experimenters Kit
®
XC-4262
Learn about the exciting world of Arduino® with these
easy to build projects. From flashing LED to moving
things with a servo. Complete with instructions and
a supporting web page and software examples. No
soldering required.
$
Stackable Header Set
HM-3207
The perfect accessory to the ProtoShields
and vero type boards when connecting to
your Arduino® compatible project.
• 1 × 10-pin
• 2 × 8-pin
• 1 x 6-pin
• 1 x 2x3-pin (for ICSP)
Light Dependent
Resistor (LDR)
129
Deluxe Modules Package
XC-4288
Get more savings by purchasing this 37 modulesin-1 pack. Includes commonly used sensors and
modules for duinotech and Arduino®: joystick,
magnetic, temperature, IR, LED and more.
Page 6
DOUBLE
POINTS
DOUBLE
POINTS
Cadmium Sulphide (CdS) light
dependent resistor cells suitable
for all your light-sensitive
projects.
48K OHM TO 140K OHM
RD-3480
Resistor Pack
300-PIECES RR-0680
$
DOUBLE
POINTS
3ea
$ 25
3495
Light Duty Hook-up Wire Pack
8 COLOURS WH-3009
This assorted pack contains 5 of virtually each value Quality tinned hook-up wire on plastic spools. 8
from 10Ω to 1MΩ.
rolls included, each roll a different colour.
• 0.5W 1% mini size metal film
• 25m on each roll
See website for full contents.
4
$ 50
DOUBLE
POINTS
Economy Breadboard
Jumper Kit 5 COLOURS WH-3032
2.8K OHM TO 8.4K OHM
RD-3485
1695
$
Solid core hookup cable, which is the ideal size for
breadboards. All you need to do is cut it to whatever
lengths you require and strip the ends.
• Includes 2m of each colour
Colours may vary from time to time.
Follow us at facebook.com/jaycarelectronics
1350
$
DOUBLE
POINTS
Breadboard Jumper Kit
PB-8850
This kit consists of 70 pcs of single core sturdy
wire which has been stripped on each end and
bent at right angles. They are specifically made for
breadboards. Supplied in a plastic box for easy
storage. There are 5 pieces each of 14 different
lengths.
Catalogue Sale 28 February - 23 March, 2016
ARDUINO® COMPATIBLE MODULES AND SHIELDS
7
$ 95
5
$ 95
3
$ 95
Arduino Compatible Infrared
Receiver Module XC-4427
®
Receive data sent via infrared, this module can read
the signals sent by most IR remote controls.
• Operating Voltage: 5VDC
• 28(L) x 15(W) x 2(H)mm
7
Arduino® Compatible
Temperature Sensor Module
XC-4494
This module provides a simple way to measure
temperature. The module outputs an analog voltage
that varies directly with temperature. Connect it
straight to one of your DuinoTECH analog inputs.
• Operating voltage: 5VDC
• Max 100°C
• 21cm Breakout cable included
• 33(W) x 22(D) x 9(H)mm
Our range would not be complete without a
microphone sensor module. This unit is highly
sensitive with the added advantage of having
two outputs. An analogue output for real time
microphone voltage signal, and a digital output
for when the sound intensity reaches its threshold.
Great to turn your Arduino® into a voice recorder
or vox.
• 5VDC operational voltage
• Sensitivity potentiometer adjustment
• 43(L) x 16(W) x 13(H)mm
This module measures the reflectivity of a surface
with an infrared emitter/detector pair. The output
goes to high whenever the reflectivity exceeds the
threshold value, which can be adjusted with the
onboard potentiometer.
• Output electrical level signal: Active Low
• VCC/OUT/GND pin connector
• Power Supply: 2.5-12V
• Working current: 18-20mA at 5V
$
$ 95
Arduino® Compatible
Microphone Sound Sensor
Module XC-4438
Arduino® Compatible Line
Trace Sensor Module XC-4474
1995
$
Arduino® Compatible
Temperature Sensor Module
XC-4432
Measure both temperature and humidity with this
nifty module. Full digital operation so no analog to
digital calibration is required.
• Temperature Range: -40 ºC - 80 ºC +/- 0.5 ºC
• Humidity Range: 20 – 90% +/- 2%
• Sample Rate: 0.5Hz
• 52(W) x 20(L) x 13(H)mm
4495
1995
$
Arduino® Compatible
Temperature Sensor Module
XC-4538
This versatile 1-wire bus temperature sensor
module features 0.5°C accuracy and fast response,
and is easy to connect up for all projects. Perfect
for building your temperature-sensitive projects or
even add on to your home automation system or
dataloggers. Temperature Range: -55ºC - +125 ºC
• 20(W) x 15(L) x 5(H)mm
Limited stock. Not available online.
119
$
3.2” LCD Touchscreen
Arduino® Compatible 8 x 8
RGB LED Matrix Driver Module Display Kit FOR ARDUINO® XC-4280
XC-4498
A full colour RGB display driver designed to
drive a tri-colour 8x8 dot matrix. Driven by an
ATMega328p (The same chip as the Arduino®), this
module communicates with your project via I2C.
Alternatively, use an ICSP programmer (XC-4237)
to flash your own firmware and the device no longer
requires an external controller.
• Operating Voltage: 5VDC
• 66(L) x 60(W) x 12(H)mm
Add an interactive touchscreen display to your
existing Arduino® projects. Draw lines, shapes,
text, display images, play sound and log data to
microSD card. Includes LCD display, 4D Arduino®
Adaptor Shield, 5-way interface cable and USB
programming adaptor with pre-loaded software.
• Operating voltage: 4.5 - 5.5VDC
• Screen display area: 64.8 x 48.6mm
• Screen resolution: 240 x 320 pixels
• 65K True to life colours
Limited stock. Not available online.
Limited stock. Not available online.
9
$ 95
4
$ 95
Arduino® Compatible
Amplifier Module XC-4448
4
$ 95
Arduino® Compatible Logic
Level Converter Module XC-4486
It provides two bi-directional channels to safely
This remarkably small module provides a complete marry 3.3V with 5.0V. Drops straight into solderless breadboard or can be soldered into your own
2 x 3W stereo audio amplifier. Ideal for driving
small speakers and earphones. Requires no external PCBs.
components.
• Two bi-directional channels
• Operating Voltage: 2.5-5.5VDC
• 12-pin DIL package
• 23(W) x 16(D) x 2(H)mm
• 35(W) x 31(D) x 21(H)mm
Arduino® Compatible 3 Axis
Compass Magnetometer
Module XC-4496
This module allows you to take accurate compass
bearings, no matter how it is orientated. Easily
interfaced via I2C.
• Operating Voltage: 5VDC
• Resolution: 12bits
• Includes 5V - 3V level shifter.
• 20(L) x 16(H) x 5(H)mm
119
$
RGB LED Cube Kit 4x4x4
FOR ARDUINO® XC-4274
This stunning 3D-matrix of 64 RGB LEDs connects
directly to your Arduino®-compatible board so you
can produce mesmerising light shows controlled
by software.
• 4x4x4 matrix of individually addressable 8mm
RGB LEDs
• 106(W) x 130(H) x 106(D)mm (assembled)
PRE-ASSEMBLED MODULES
9
$ 95
Multi-Voltage
Regulator 1.5A AA-0372
This module is a low-powered DC converter for
many applications. Just plug its input into your
PC's internal power supply cable and get selectable
regulated voltage out from 3 to 15VDC*. Output
current capability is around 1.5 amps.
• 63(L) x 24(Dia.)mm
$
24 ea
95
AA-0223
Universal Amplifier Modules
1 CHANNEL
Ideal as a bench-test amplifier for audio sources,
or even as a mono headphone amplifier, this small
audio amplifier can be operated from 4.5 V up to 12
VDC. Use two for stereo.
3.5W AA-0223
12W AA-0225
To order phone 1800 022 888 or visit www.jaycar.com.au
$
2995
24-12V 3A Converter Module
M038 AA-0266
Many trucks and boats use 24V systems. These
converters will allow you to run a reasonably sized
12V car-stereo or other devices from a 24V supply.
Heatsink (not included) should be used for superior
performance. Features include: short-circuit
protection and thermal cut-out.
• 90 x 60 x 34 mm
See terms & conditions on page 8.
$
3795
12V 3A Timer Module
2 SECONDS TO 23 MINUTES AA-0364
A versatile and useful timer module that can be set
for periods of 2 seconds to 23 minutes. The start
and stop functions are controlled by simple switch
inputs and the relay output can control a device of
up to 25VDC at 3A.
• Operating voltage: 12-15VDC
• 87(L) x 60(W) x 30(H)mm
Page 7
CLEARANCE
Magnetic Reed Switch Module
SAVE UP TO 50%
Dual Mains Adaptor
XC-4476 WAS $7.95
A simple to use reed switch module, output will
turn whenever the reed switch is in proximity to a
magnetic field. Useful for door security.
Operating voltage 3-5VDC
• Digital output
• 16mA comparator output capacity
• 37(L) x 15(W) x 23(H)mm
WITH NIGHT LIGHT PP-4039 WAS $9.95
Leave a night light on without wasting a power point.
Light sensor for automatic on/off.
SPECIAL
4
$ 95
SAVE $5
Limited stock.
SPECIAL
4
$ 75
SAVE 40%
Limited stock.
Rechargeable Battery Lithium-ion
SB-2303 WAS $9.95
Universal Lithium-ION "14500" size battery, 3.7V 750mAh. Similar in
size to an AA battery. Suitable for LED torches and other applications.
Limited stock.
SPECIAL
7
$ 95
SAVE 20%
USB Voltage
and Current Tester
Master / Slave Powerboard
WITH AUTO OFF
MS-4080 $39.95
It features an auto power-down
feature where the 'auto' sockets
turn off after 60 minutes. If no
IR signal is detected within 55
minutes an LED will indicate that it
will shut-down in 5 minutes time.
SPECIAL
$
3495
SAVE $5
12VDC & 240VAC
Battery Charger
XC-5074 WAS $24.95
This device displays the voltage and current that
your USB powered device uses.
• Voltage Range: 3-6V
• Current Range: 0-3A
• 78(L) x 36(W) x 17(D)mm
SPECIAL
1995
$
SAVE 20%
Limited stock.
WITH LCD DISPLAY MB-3545 WAS $59.95
Ni-Cd & Ni-MHRecharge up to 4 x AA, AAA, C, D and
2 x 9V Ni-Cd or Ni-MH batteries together for a total of
6 batteries. Using Delta V voltage detection and cut-off,
batteries are never overcharge. With LCD display.
SPECIAL
$
4995
SAVE $10
Limited stock.
80W Portable
Fold-Up Solar Panel
17V AC 1.25 A Plugpack
WITH EARTH CONNECTION MP-3022 WAS $24.95
Similar to our standard alarm supply, except that this has
the earth pin wire connected. This is used for alarm panels
that have an inbuilt dialler, as Austel require earthing due
to it being connected to the telephone system.
• Terminated with bare ends
• Safety approval number: N13057
SPECIAL
1795
$
SAVE 28%
Limited stock. Not available online.
ZM-9130 WAS $399
Features 10m output lead with Anderson, alligator
or eye terminal connections, has the charge
controller included so you can connect directly to
your battery without fear of over-charging, and is
supplied with a durable nylon carry bag.
SPECIAL
$
349
SAVE $50
Limited stock.
TERMS AND CONDITIONS: REWARDS / NERD PERKS CARD HOLDERS FREE GIFT, % SAVING DEALS, DOUBLE POINTS & MEMBERS OFFERS requires ACTIVE Jaycar Rewards / Nerd Perks Card
membership at time of purchase, at company owned Jaycar stores only. Refer to website for Rewards/ Nerd Perks Card T&Cs. ON PAGE 1: Bench top power bundle. ON PAGE 5: Solar Connector
Bundle,
special
price forREWARDS
Nerd Perks
Card
Holders;
Free
fuse
andDOUBLE
holder (SF-2200)
with purchase
AA-0348
forJaycar
Nerd Perks
Card
Holders.
ON PAGE
project
bundle,
TERMS AND
CONDITIONS:
CARD
HOLDERS
FREE
GIFT,
% (SZ-2016)
SAVING DEALS,
POINTS & REWARDS
OFFERSofrequires
active
Rewards
Card
membership
at time6:ofArduino
purchase.
Refer to
websitespecial
for
price forCard
NerdT&Cs.
PerksDOUBLE
Card Holders.
ON REWARDS
PAGE 8: Clearance
priceisfor
SB-2303,
MP-3022,
MS-4080,
ZM-9130.
ACCRUED
Rewards
POINTS FOR
CARD HOLDERS
forXC-4476,
purchase of
specified XC-5074,
product listed
on page.PP-4039,
DOUBLE POINTS
OFFERMB-3545
on PAGE 2and
is for
YN-8204,DOUBLE
YN-8205,POINTS
YN-8206,
YN-8207,DURING
YN-8208,THE
YN-8294,
YN-8295,
YN-8296,
YN-8297,
WB-2020
WB-2030.
REWARDS
CARDAFTER
HOLDERS
on PAGE 2 are for YN-8410, YN-8077, YN-8078, YN-8326, YN-8328, YN-8348, YN-8352 or YN-8354.
PROMOTION
PERIOD
WILL BE
ALLOCATED
TOorTHE
NERD PERKS
CARD
THEBUY
END2 &
OFSAVE
THEDEALS
PROMOTION.
REWARDS CARD HOLDERS 15% OFF on PAGE 5 is for HB-5430, HB-5432, HB-5434, YN-8046, YN-8048, HB-5420, HB-5422, HB-5424, HB-5426, HB-5450, HB-5452, HB-5454 or MS-4094. See in-store for full details.
SAVINGS OFF ORIGINAL RRP (ORRP). DOUBLE POINTS accrued during the promotion period will be allocated to the Rewards Card after the end of promotion.
Australian Capital Territory
South Australia
Port Macquarie
Ph (02) 6581 4476
Mermaid Beach
Ph (07) 5526 6722
Belconnen
Ph (02) 6253 5700
Rydalmere
Ph (02) 8832 3120
Nth Rockhampton
Ph (07) 4922 0880
Adelaide
Ph (08) 8221 5191
Fyshwick
Ph (02) 6239 1801
Shellharbour
Ph (02) 4256 5106
Townsville
Ph (07) 4772 5022
Clovelly Park
Ph (08) 8276 6901
Tuggeranong
Ph (02) 6293 3270
Smithfield
Ph (02) 9604 7411
Strathpine
Ph (07) 3889 6910
Elizabeth
Ph (08) 8255 6999
Sydney City
Ph (02) 9267 1614
Underwood
Ph (07) 3841 4888
Gepps Cross
Ph (08) 8262 3200
Taren Point
Ph (02) 9531 7033
Woolloongabba
Ph (07) 3393 0777
Modbury
Ph (08) 8265 7611
Tuggerah
Ph (02) 4353 5016
Reynella
Ph (08) 8387 3847
Tweed Heads
Ph (07) 5524 6566
Wagga Wagga
Ph (02) 6931 9333
Cheltenham
Ph (03) 9585 5011
Warners Bay
Ph (02) 4954 8100
Coburg
Ph (03) 9384 1811
Warwick Farm
Ph (02) 9821 3100
Ferntree Gully
Ph (03) 9758 5500
Wollongong
Ph (02) 4225 0969
Frankston
Ph (03) 9781 4100
Geelong
Ph (03) 5221 5800
Hallam
Ph (03) 9796 4577
Kew East
Ph (03) 9859 6188
Melbourne City
Ph (03) 9663 2030
Mornington
Ph (03) 5976 1311
Ringwood
Ph (03) 9870 9053
Roxburgh Park
Ph (03) 8339 2042
Shepparton
Ph (03) 5822 4037
Hobart
Ph (03) 6272 9955
Springvale
Ph (03) 9547 1022
Launceston
Ph (03) 6334 2777
Sunshine
Ph (03) 9310 8066
Thomastown
Ph (03) 9465 3333
Werribee
Ph (03) 9741 8951
New South Wales
Albury
Ph (02) 6021 6788
Alexandria
Ph (02) 9699 4699
Bankstown
Ph (02) 9709 2822
Blacktown
Ph (02) 9672 8400
Bondi Junction
Ph (02) 9369 3899
Brookvale
Ph (02) 9905 4130
Campbelltown
Ph (02) 4625 0775
Castle Hill
Ph (02) 9634 4470
Coffs Harbour
Ph (02) 6651 5238
Aspley
Ph (07) 3863 0099
Croydon
Ph (02) 9799 0402
Browns Plains
Ph (07) 3800 0877
Dubbo
Ph (02) 6881 8778
Caboolture
Ph (07) 5432 3152
Erina
Ph (02) 4367 8190
Cairns
Ph (07) 4041 6747
Gore Hill
Ph (02) 9439 4799
Caloundra
Ph (07) 5491 1000
Hornsby
Ph (02) 9476 6221
Capalaba
Ph (07) 3245 2014
Maitland
Ph (02) 4934 4911
Ipswich
Ph (07) 3282 5800
Mona Vale
Ph (02) 9979 1711
Labrador
Ph (07) 5537 4295
Newcastle
Ph (02) 4968 4722
Mackay
Ph (07) 4953 0611
Penrith
Ph (02) 4721 8337
Maroochydore
Ph (07) 5479 3511
Queensland
Victoria
Western Australia
Bunbury
Ph (08) 9721 2868
Joondalup
Ph (08) 9301 0916
Maddington
Ph (08) 9493 4300
Mandurah
Ph (08) 9586 3827
Midland
Ph (08) 9250 8200
Northbridge
Ph (08) 9328 8252
O’Connor
Ph (08) 9337 2136
Osborne Park
Ph (08) 9444 9250
Rockingham
Ph (08) 9592 8000
Tasmania
Northern Territory
Darwin
Ph (08) 8948 4043
Arrival dates of new products in this flyer were confirmed at the time of print but delays sometimes occur. Please ring your local store to check stock details. Savings off Original RRP.
Prices and special offers are valid from 28 February - 23 March, 2016.
YOUR LOCAL JAYCAR STORE
Free Call Orders: 1800 022 888
HEAD OFFICE
320 Victoria Road, Rydalmere NSW 2116
Ph:
(02) 8832 3100
Fax:
(02) 8832 3169
ONLINE ORDERS
Website: www.jaycar.com.au
Email:
techstore<at>jaycar.com.au
Occasionally there are discontinued items
advertised on a special / lower price in this
promotional flyer that has limited to nil
stock in certain stores, including Jaycar
Authorised Stockist. These stores may not
have stock of these items and can not order
or transfer stock.
PRODUCT SHOWCASE
300MHz–3.8GHz Software Defined Radio
Nuand, of Rochester, New York,
have appointed Silvertone Electronics
of Wagga Wagga, NSW as a distributor of their bladeRF line of products.
These fully bus-powered USB 3.0 SuperSpeed
Software Defined Radios
measure just 125mm x
87mm. Independent
RX/TX programmability with 12bit 40MSPS quadrature sampling
makes them capable
of achieving full-duplex 28MHz
channels, the on-board 200MHz
ARM9 with 512KB embedded SRAM
(JTAG port available) gives extraordinary flexibility.
They are 2x2 MIMO configurable
with SMB cable, expandable up to
4x4 and have modular expansion for
PCBCART enables your innovation from concept to reality
PCBCART, an exclusive custom PCB
fabrication and assembly service provider from China, is becoming a key
supplier for worldwide design engineers and experts from Industry’s
high-end equipment manufacturers
and Maker community.
With expertise and experience in
the PCB manufacturing industry over
10+ years, PCBCART enables numerous engineers to make their innovation a reality.
Here are the benefits of picking PCBCART as a PCB production partner:
• From rapid prototyping and mass production, they have got you covered.
• Specialising in fabricating a wide
range of PCBs, including HDI PCB,
high-Tg PCB, thick copper PCB, halogen-free PCB as standard options
and more specialist capabilities like
flex PCB, aluminum base and Rogers
PCB, PCBCART is a one-stop shop
for all PCB fabrication needs.
• They can handle small quantity, full
turnkey assembly requirements.
• Quality and project excellence are
guaranteed – they are committed to
adhering to the strictest standards
during production. Their skilled staff
has been working on PCB manufacturing for over a decade. Clients can
rely on file recheck, quick response,
siliconchip.com.au
flexible solutions and high performance PCBs.
• PCBCART has its own procurement
channels and manufacturing base,
which makes it possible to simplify
project sourcing process, avoid multisupplier interaction and save clients
time and money.
• Located in China, it can offer a lower
price on equal or higher quality service than suppliers from other countries.
These advantages make PCBCART
a preferred and reliable provider for
quality PCBs at a cost-effective price.
As a welcome gift, PCBCART is offering new customers 15% discount,
(up to $200 OFF) on their first PCB
order at any cost. Visit their website
for more information.
Contact:
PCBCART
Floor 3rd/4th, Building #1, NO.163
Wu Chang Road, Yu Hang District,
Hangzhou, China 310023
Tel: +86 571 87013819
Web: www.pcbcart.com
adding GPIO, Ethernet, 1PPS sync signal and expanding frequency range
(through an available transverter board)
and power limits.
The system is supported by stable
Linux, Windows, Mac and GNURadio
software packages.
This hardware is capable of operating as a spectrum analyser, vector signal analyser, and vector signal generator as well as anything from simple FM
audio to the latest 4G LTE standard.
Contact:
Silvertone Electronics
1/8 Fitzhardinge St, Wagga Wagga NSW 2650
Tel: (02) 6931 8252
Web: www.silvertone.com.au
Microchip’s 12, 14 & 16 bit
200 Msps A/D Converters
In addition to delivering the speed and
accuracy needed for high-precision measurements of fast input signals, Microchip’s
new ADCs provide industry-leading lowpower consumption and integrate digital
processing features that simplify system
design and reduce cost.
Microchip’s MCP37DX1-200 and
MCP372X1-200 Analog-to-Digital
Converters(ADCs) offer a choice of a 12-,
14- or 16-bit pipelined A/D converters
with sampling rates of up to 200 Msps
and power consumption down to 490 mW
with LVDS digital I/O.
Additional power-saving features enable
standby power of just 80 mW and 33mW
in shutdown mode.
High integration allows a range of digital
processing features to be integrated into
the 124-lead VTLA packages.
Contact:
Microchip Technology Australia
Tel: (02) 9868 6733
Web: www.microchip.com
March 2016 53
SERVICEMAN'S LOG
Sorting my quake-damaged workshop
I absolutely love test equipment and have
recently been given some very nice test gear by
a friend who’s just retired. Fortunately, I now
have somewhere to stash this gear, having just
got my quake-damaged workshop properly
sorted out and functioning again.
O
NE THING that makes being a serviceman so much fun is that we
get to have a cool workshop to hang
out in. There are as many different
workshops as there are servicemen
and I always find it fascinating to take
a look at the workshops of other people I meet in the industry.
I especially like to check out what
tools and gadgets they have, to find out
whether similar tools could be used in
my workshop to make my job easier
(or would just be cool to have).
54 Silicon Chip
A good friend of mine, who was involved in 2-way radios, has just retired
and he and his wife are now looking
to down-size the family home into
something more manageable for a retired couple. And that means he must
clear out his workshop.
His man-cave is a particularly interesting place for me to visit. His hobbies have involved all things to do
with radio and his collection of radiocontrolled aircraft, especially rotarywing models (helicopters to the uninitiated), is quite impressive.
To say that this guy’s single-garagesized workshop is packed to the rafters
would be an understatement. Choppers and fixed-wing models in various
states of repair hang both above and
below the rafters, requiring those of
us taller than about 5-feet 5-inches
(1.65m) to walk slightly stooped
to avoid taking out an eye out
on an errant skid or a piece
damaged landing gear.
The floor is covered
with pretty much the
same blend of models, half-built kit-sets
and associated gear.
All that’s left uncovered is a well-beaten
path from the door to
the light-switch and to
the equally-cluttered
workbench. The single
light bulb (an energysaver that takes 10 minutes to warm up) casts
a yellow glow over the
scene and this and the
associated shadows
Dave Thompson*
Items Covered This Month
•
•
•
•
•
Dave finally gets his workshop
functioning again
Faulty Sunbeam Retro KE5200E kettle
Deckel FP4 CNC milling
machine
Maison vacuum cleaner
Faulty Zen-on Justina guitar
tuner
*Dave Thompson runs PC Anytime
in Christchurch, NZ.
Website: www.pcanytime.co.nz
Email: dave<at>pcanytime.co.nz
add to the atmosphere.
It’s no exaggeration to say that I love
it there and I’ll be very sad when he
down-sizes to some tiny shed that I
guarantee won’t have anything like
the feel of this haven.
However, there is a silver lining;
Keith has had to get rid of his old
scopes, frequency counters and other
flashing-light-infested test gear and,
in the spirit of friendship, he kindly
offered to give some of these instruments to me. The deal is that I can be
their guardian for as long as I want
them and for as long as he can come
over and use them if he ever needs to.
Since he hasn’t used some of them for
a few years now, it’s unlikely he’ll ever
take me up on that but that’s OK; I’m
happy for him to come and use my facilities any time he likes.
So far, I have been given a digital
oscilloscope (an older, 60MHz dualchannel monochrome model) and a
top-quality 20MHz CRT scope, both
of which are in excellent working order. They really do look great on my
shelf along with my existing scope
and various multimeters, soldering
stations and power supplies.
I admit it; I love test equipment and
if I won the lottery I’d have the best
spectrum analysers, audio generators,
siliconchip.com.au
frequency counters and all manner of
other suitably-adorned boxes stacked
from bench-top to ceiling. The beauty
of having this equipment is learning
how to use it to better do my job and
enjoy my hobby, the two curiously
crossing over more often these days.
I’ve already put the scopes to good use
and I’m now looking forward to taking
possession of a very nice AF/RF frequency generator/counter that’s next
on the list to go from Keith’s workshop.
Quake-damaged workshop
Some years ago, my own workshop,
which is about double-garage sized,
was rendered a complete disaster area
by the swarms of quakes we had here
in Christchurch five years ago. Prior
to those cursed quakes, I had a lot of
stuff neatly set up in cupboards, on
shelves and in drawers and other storage units all around the walls of my
workshop. This “stuff” included small
bucket-sized bins of resistors, capacitors, diodes, transistors, ICs and other
components one tends to accumulate
over 40 years of hobby and professional electronics work.
These parts were all neatly arranged
and stored in their own compartments
and trays until 12.51PM on the 22nd
February, 2011, wherein the shelves,
drawers and cupboards were literally
torn from the walls and everything in
and on them ended up dumped onto
the workbenches and floor below. The
benches run around the entire workshop at a height of 900mm, with gaps
only for the entry door and a couple of
larger machines along the back wall.
During the subsequent aftershocks,
of which there were many, everything else that lived in racks, drawers, shelves and boxes under, on or
around the benches also ended up on
the floor, along with my lathe, drillpress, sander, band-saw, scroll-saw
and electronic test gear.
I almost cried when I first opened the
door but soon forgot about that because
my lathe had fallen across the doorway,
preventing it from opening properly.
The lathe had also taken out a tall metal
cabinet of drawers that lived next to it.
Fortunately, all the drawers (A4-sized
and full of lathe tools, components,
half-finished projects and other electronic bric-a-brac) had fired out into the
middle of the room, so they avoided
getting crushed. However, their contents added to the pile that now covered most of the workshop floor.
siliconchip.com.au
I initially surveyed the damage
through the gap in the door and after checking nothing was on fire and
that the workshop power was disconnected (fortunately, the mains were off
and would stay off for another 20-odd
hours), I locked the door and vowed
to sort it all out later.
It took about a year to get the workshop into some semblance of order,
which basically meant I could walk
around most of it. It was still a right
mess though and remained like that for
another few years as our focus was on
other things. Besides, with on-going
after-shocks, there was an air of “why
bother?” about it all. It was a terrifying
time and I didn’t want my epitaph to
read: buried in his workshop!
As a result, my workshop space
became a little-utilised repository for
anything that didn’t fit in the house,
or was too valuable to leave in the
often-open garage that fronted the
workshop itself. My workbenches,
which had been clear and organised,
were now covered entirely in stuff and
if I wanted to do anything, I had to
literally push things aside until I had
room for the new job.
Over the years, I chipped away at
clearing it up by doing things like
sorting out the resistors from the capacitors and then separating other
components – no easy task when literally thousands had been mixed together into a scrambled and hard-topull-apart pile that would likely have
filled a bathtub. Part of me wanted to
just toss the lot and start again but the
miser in me prevented me from tossing
perfectly good components.
It took quite some time to sort it all
out and I while I was at it I also separated the electrolytics and tantalums
from the non-polarised capacitors and
sorted miscellaneous items like terminals from screws, nuts and bolts. One
of the most frustrating jobs involved
separating about 200 assorted springs
from all the other bits; they gripped
and grabbed onto everything and I very
nearly just chucked the lot but decided
against it after considering how long it
took me to accumulate them (and how
handy they can be).
Once I had all that small stuff squared
away, I began looking at shelving and
other storage options that wouldn’t be
susceptible to falling down in quakes.
A lot of bits and pieces originally lived
on shelves around the walls but I now
had to find homes for them in drawers
and other solid storage options.
We haven’t had any sizable aftershocks for the last 12 months (touch
wood) but I’m reasonably confident the
storage I now have will take anything
up to and including a quake that would
drop the garage. And if that happened,
I’d have bigger problems than sorting
out some resistors!
At least we don’t have to worry
about bushfires, which would be absolutely terrible. Give me a quake any
day over fires (well, a smaller jolt at
least).
To chuck or not to chuck
Over the recent Christmas break, I
March 2016 55
Serviceman’s Log – continued
D. A. of Shepparton, Victoria recently encountered a string of faults
in an old Deckel FP4 CNC milling
machine. Here’s how he got it going again . . .
Earlier this year, I was asked by a
relative if I’d have a look at one of
his CNC milling machines. The machine in question was a Deckel FP4
unit from the mid-late 1980s and it
had developed a fault in the CNC
console. I’m no expert when it comes
to engineering but I’ve spent many
years repairing electronic/electrical
and mechanical equipment, both
as a career and as a hobby, and so I
thought “why not?”.
CNC stands for “computer numerical control” and a CNC mill/lathe has
a computer console which allows the
user to push buttons and enter commands to drive the machine’s servos
and motors. These in turn control the
movement of various tools and/or the
job itself in the machine to achieve
the desired cutting and turning, etc.
The story starts when the machine
began displaying an FP00 error code
which, according to the manual, indicates an emergency shut-down,
tripped overloads and/or pressed
emergency stop buttons. The first
step then is to check the overloads
and emergency stops and in fact the
owner had already done this but had
found nothing amiss.
My first thought was that a power
supply fuse had probably blown or
the supply itself was faulty. When
I took a look inside, I found that a
fuse had indeed blown. I replaced
it and the console came back to life
but there was no vertical sync, thus
causing the picture to roll continuously. However, I was told that the
vertical rolling fault had been there
for some time and that the picture
stopped rolling after the machine
had warmed up. And indeed that
turned out to be the case.
What was encouraging was that
there was no longer an FP00 error on
the display. However, the unit still
refused to work.
Thankfully, the owner has the
operator’s manual and the service
manual for the machine. Unfortunately, the service manual is printed in German (since the machine is
German-made) so I spent quite some
time going over the circuits diagrams
and checking for continuity in the
emergency stop circuit. Eventually,
I found that a track on the circuit
board had been burnt off.
Fixing this cured the fault with
the emergency stop circuit and the
machine worked again. However, I
was puzzled as to what had caused
the fault, as it appeared that the circuit board track damage would have
been caused by an inadvertent short.
The next day, the FP00 error was
back so I again checked the emergency stop circuit and found that it was
functioning as intended. The FP00
fault code can also mean that one of
a few overload circuit breakers had
tripped, so I now turned my attention to those. These were all intact
so I consulted the circuit diagrams
and after some time found that these
overload circuit breakers are 3-phase
with an auxiliary contact. This auxiliary contact is used to relay the fact
that one of the circuit breakers has
tripped, thereby halting the machine
and bringing up the FP00 code.
I soon found that one of the wires
going to one of the auxiliary contact’s
terminals had been clamped mostly
on the insulation rather than on the
copper wire and a quick check with
a multimeter confirmed no continuity. I re-terminated it and the problem was solved. This was probably
a manufacturing defect, the wire just
touching the terminal for all those
years before it finally went open
circuit.
In the end, it was a very simple
fault but it wasn’t easy to find. Of
course, that left the vertical rolling
fault but because it quickly disappeared as the machine warmed up,
we decided to leave it for the time
being.
That situation didn’t last long because as winter came on, the vertical
rolling fault got progressively worse.
Eventually, it was taking around
five hours for the display to stop
rolling after the machine had been
switched on.
Having worked on many CRT
TV sets, I was fairly sure that this
wouldn’t just involve adjusting the
internal vertical hold control. Instead, the nature of the fault suggested component drift and I suspected
faulty electrolytic capacitors due to
the age of the unit.
Armed with the circuit and an ESR
meter, I checked all the electrolytic
capacitors on the deflection/HV circuit board. Most of them measured
open-circuit which wasn’t surprising
after 30 years or so of service.
I replaced the lot, then reassembled the console and switched the
unit on. The picture was now locked
solid and that finally cured the annoying rolling problem.
That wasn’t to be the end of the sto-
finally got onto the home straight with
the workshop. I spent around three
hours each day that I was off work
sorting out what I wanted to keep and
what I wanted to chuck.
I’ve mentioned before that while I’m
not a pack-rat, I do tend to gather items
that could come in useful for my servicing work. However, I had to modify my philosophy with this clean up.
My criteria before starting the clean-up
was: will I conceivably ever use this
item; yes or no? If “no”, the item went
into a rubbish box.
I also asked “do I really need this
item”? Again, if the answer was no,
the article went straight into the bin.
It was actually quite liberating to get
rid of the junk and tidy the workshop;
I’d had some of that stuff for so long
and the workshop had been such a
mess that it hung over me like a black
cloud and I dreaded going in there. In
fact, there’s a book currently sweeping
the USA about the very subject of getting rid of unwanted clutter and how
life-affirming it can be.
In this book, the author poses the
question: does this item “spark joy”
in my life? If it doesn’t, out it goes.
While I liked my criteria a little better
and thought it a little more practical,
it was interesting that I had much the
same experience while cleaning out
my workshop that this person wrote
about. At the same time, I quietly
Deckel FP4 CNC milling machine
56 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
ry though. A couple of days passed
and, much to my frustration, the
Deckel FP4 again had a problem.
This time, it was tripping one of its
overload circuit breakers as soon as
there was any attempt to start the
hydraulic pump motor. Apparently,
this machine uses hydraulics to actuate some of the bed axis movements
but I’m no expert on how the whole
machine works.
In this case, an FP02 error code
was appearing on the console. The
manual was quite helpful here because it stated that an FP02 error
code meant hydraulic pump overload and this indicated the relevant
overload breaker to check. It was
tripping the overload at switch-on
alright and my first thought was that
the pump/motor may have seized or
something along those lines.
The only other option would be
a power issue. Sure enough, when I
checked the mains voltage on each
phase at the overload circuit breaker
with respect to ground, two phases
were at 230VAC while the centre
measured just 63VAC. Three-phase
motors don’t appreciate a missing
phase and will draw lots of current
and generally refuse to start.
I then did the same measurements
at the 3-phase power point for this
machine only to find the same readings. So we had a power issue, rather that a fault in the machine itself.
When I inspected the main switchboard, I discovered that the machine
was on a circuit with individual
phase fuses rather than a 3-phase
“ganged” circuit breaker. In the end,
it was a simple case of removing the
blown centre fuse and replacing it.
Once all three phases had been restored, the old Deckel CNC machine
operated normally once more and
should live on for many more years.
cursed the fact that I hadn’t thought
about writing a book about it. It could
have made millions of dollars, which
of course would enable me to buy
even more stuff to fill my workshop
with! Perhaps it all worked out OK
after all . . .
After dumping/recycling 350-odd
kilograms of rubbish from the workshop, I had a lot of spare space left over.
It now feels great to be able to walk to
any part of the bench and have room
siliconchip.com.au
to work on it without having to move
stuff around. The best thing about it is
that it’s a proper workshop again and
I’m not embarrassed to show people
around without making lame excuses as to why it was such a bomb-site.
While I could legitimately claim it was
caused by something beyond my control, it certainly wasn’t beyond my control to tidy it properly long before now.
Of course, it didn’t take long for
someone to ask me if I had something
that I’d just chucked away! It had been
in my workshop for years but hadn’t
met my criteria for keeping it. The fact
is, this will happen every so often and
I’ll just have to live with it.
The kettle carks it
Another thing I’d gotten rid of was
a kettle we’d replaced a few years ago
with a nice new “digital” model. There
was nothing wrong with the old one; it
just didn’t colour-match our new toaster so, of course, it had to go. And so,
after all those years in the workshop,
out it went to the recycling station,
no doubt to eventually turn up in one
of those eco-shops for a few dollars.
I mention this now because just the
other day Nina pushed the power button on our kettle to boil some water.
As she did so, it gave a nasty electrical
“pop!” and its LED display went dead.
And so, being a serviceman, the first
thing I did was grab it and withdraw
to my now-tidy workshop to find out
what was wrong with it.
“It’s probably just a fuse or something just as simple,” I said to Nina as
I made off with it. Yeah, right – famous
last words, as many servicemen will
no doubt confirm.
After negotiating the usual annoying
security-type screws and removing the
base of the kettle, the electronic gubbins were revealed. No simple switch,
thermostat and element for this kettle;
instead, inside was a PCB assembly
that wouldn’t look out of place in a
GPS unit or a portable radio.
The top side of the PCB carried a
number of parts and a 28-pin IC, most
likely a microcontroller of some description. This side appeared to be OK,
so I then had to remove quite a bit of
plastic mounting hardware and unplug various peripherals such as thermostats, wiring looms for the display
and the element wiring in order to gain
access to the underside of the PCB.
As soon as I flipped it over, the cause
of the “pop” was all too obvious; four
very blackened surface-mounted diodes and at least one transistor (or
similar SOT-23 type component) were
clearly damaged. A quick search with
Google confirmed my assumption that
there would be nothing like a circuit
diagram floating around for this appliance and with all active components
sanded or with their part numbers
otherwise obfuscated (thanks manufacturer), this was likely going to be
another guesswork fix.
And so, for the time being, I’m
stumped. If anyone out there in SILICON CHIP “reader-land” has a circuit
diagram for a Sunbeam Retro KE5200E
kettle and is willing to share it, please
contact me.
The rest of the board appears to be
in pristine condition, probably because
the whole thing is covered in some sort
of soft, clear “goop” to waterproof it.
This goop had melted away from the
dead components, making it easy to
access them, but I suppose any “fix”
will require a similar covering once
done. I’ll use epoxy resin. I think –
should I succeed in getting it going
again, that is . . .
All the failed components surround
a relay whose contacts switch mainslevel voltage to the element, so I’m
wondering if the relay has shorted or
something similar. The output track
of this relay has been damaged so it’ll
have to be replaced too.
The diodes shouldn’t be a problem;
the silk-screen at least is very clear
as to polarities etc and they look like
1N4001s or similar for rectifying AC
to DC for the rest of the circuit. The
SOT-23 “transistor” may be a regulator and if I can’t get a diagram, I’ll try
to “reverse engineer” this part of the
circuit and draw a diagram.
That way, I might be able to figure
out what this part does, so that I can
March 2016 57
Serviceman’s Log – continued
Identifying some of the charred parts
on the kettle’s PCB will be extremely
difficult without a circuit.
try to replicate it. Finding another relay should be simple enough too; the
manufacturer has kindly left the part
numbers intact so if I can’t locate the
exact one, any similar 24V DC, 16A
relay that fits the board layout will do
the job. I’ll let you know how it goes.
In the meantime, we went looking
for another one of those kettles but they
aren’t sold any more and the new ones
either seem cheap and nasty by comparison or don’t match the rest of our
kitchen appliances. We’ve settled on
“cheap” for time being in the hope that
I can get the faulty unit going again.
But whatever happens, at least I’ve
once again got a pristine workshop
in which to work. It really is a much
more pleasant place to be than before
the big clean-up.
Maison vacuum cleaner
Regular contributor B. P. of Dundathu, Qld has no particular love for
vacuum cleaners. But why chuck out
old faithful when you can fix it yourself and save money into the bargain?
Here’s his story . . .
Our middle (teenage) son had been
doing some vacuuming (yes, really!)
58 Silicon Chip
when the machine suddenly started
making a loud rumbling noise. Not
wanting to risk further damage, he
turned it off straightaway and I decided to check out what the problem
could be.
My first test was to turn the vacuum
cleaner on and then off again quickly,
so that I could briefly hear it running.
We’ve had this vacuum cleaner for
quite a long time and I had already repaired it several times previously. I’d
also fitted new brushes to it around 18
months ago.
This time, however, I wasn’t sure if
it was repairable, because it sounded
like the bearings were shot. The brushes were also arcing badly, which could
indicate that the armature had shorted
turns. Despite this, I decided to delve
deeper and find out just exactly what
the problem was.
I started by dismantling it and I initially checked the brushes. My suspicion was that they may have been poor
quality and had worn down already, as
the cleaner had had a lot of use since I
fitted them. However, they were fine,
with plenty of “meat” left on each one.
I then noticed that the rear bearing next to the commutator had blue
marks on it, indicating that it had been
running very hot. This wasn’t looking good!
After some further dismantling, I
had the armature free and I could then
assess the situation more thoroughly.
This revealed that the rear bearing had
virtually disintegrated – the plastic retainer that keeps the ball bearings correctly spaced was no longer present,
the metal shield on one side had fallen off and the rubber seal on the other
side had also fallen off.
At that point, the bearing literally
fell apart and the ball bearings dropped
onto the ground. I also noticed that the
metal shield had been distorted, which
indicated that the bearing had been
running out of true. Because the armature would have been moving around
so much, this could explain why there
had been arcing on the brushes.
I then checked the front bearing and
found that it was only slightly worn.
Even so, I decided that I would replace
both bearings and this is where I ran
into difficulty. My automotive bearing
puller was just too big to remove the
front bearing and it would not grip the
inner race of the rear bearing.
As a result, I decided to reassemble the rear bearing, so that it would
have a larger area for the bearing puller to grip. I retrieved the ball bearings,
greased them and placed them in the
outer race, then put the inner race back
in. After turning the bearing, the individual ball bearings distributed evenly
around the unit and I was able to use
the bearing puller to remove it.
That done, I turned my attention to
the front bearing. After some thought,
I decided that because it wasn’t badly
worn and because I couldn’t easily remove it, I would simply service it and
leave it in place. First, I removed the
outer metal shield to access the inside
of the bearing. It had some dirt in it
and the balls were devoid of grease, so
I cleaned it using a pressure-pack can
of multi-purpose spray and then blew
out the remaining liquid with an aircompressor. I then searched for some
suitable grease.
Because I do my own vehicle and
equipment servicing, I have a variety
of greases on hand. In the end, I chose
some automotive “no melt” disc brake
wheel-bearing grease, as this would be
ideal for the purpose. After greasing the
bearing, I refitted the metal shield and
then noticed that there was some wear
on the commutator. This was fixed by
“dressing” it with a fine file.
I knew the rear bearing would be
under $10, so it was worth taking a
risk and replacing it. As it turned out,
it cost less than $5 from a local supplier. Once I got it home, I set about
re-assembling the vacuum cleaner and
when I had the motor back together
and in place, I decided to give it a run
before re-fitting the cover.
When I turned it on, it ran smoothly
without the rumbling noise but there
was considerable arcing from the
brushes. I was begining to think that the
motor might be on the way out when it
suddenly picked up speed. At the same
time, the whine it made increased in
pitch and it sounded “smoother”.
When I looked at it, I immediately
noticed that there was no further arcing
from the brushes and it was running
nicely. I can only assume that the initial arcing had been caused while the
brushes “bedded in” again.
Who knows how much longer it will
continue working but while ever I can
continue to repair it and keep it going, I
will do so. This repair cost less than $5
siliconchip.com.au
and saved yet another defective piece
of equipment from going unnecessarily into landfill.
Of course, this type of repair would
not have been taken on by a service
agency. The cost of the labour alone
would have comfortably exceeded the
price of a new vacuum cleaner. It’s really handy to be able to do this type of
repair myself and save our family quite
a bit of cash in the process.
Faulty guitar tuner
A. C. of Clarement, Tasmania recently repaired an ancient guitar tuner that
had no less than three faults. Here’s
how he got it going again . . .
One of the challenges of being someone who “knows about” electronics
is that all your friends and associates
know you’re the guy to send their paraphernalia to for a quick check-over
when it’s not working.
Recently, I was handed a cheap
guitar tuner from my wife’s employer
(“your husband can fix stuff, right?”)
with the highly-detailed diagnosis that
it was dead. The unit turned out to be
a Zen-on Justina Quartz Guitar Tuner,
with a 3-position switch to power the
unit and check the battery level, a 6-position switch to select one of six string
pitches, a moving coil meter to indicate the battery level and tuning of the
guitar, a built-in mic to allow tuning
acoustic instruments and a 1/4-inch
socket on the side to accept a connection from an electric instrument.
The case was made of plastic in a garish 1970s orange colour but despite its
apparent age, it looked to be in pretty
good shape. In fact, the Justina reminded me of my first guitar tuner which
had been given to me for Christmas
about 25 years prior. Its familiar control layout suggested that it was some
kind of generic design that had been
produced over the years as a budget
alternative to the more expensive tuners made by companies such as Boss
and Peterson.
After sliding off the 9V battery cover it was a no-brainer to work out why
Servicing Stories Wanted
Do you have any good servicing stories that you would like to share in The Serviceman column? If so, why not send those stories in to us?
We pay for all contributions published but please note that your material must
be original. Send your contribution by email to: editor<at>siliconchip.com.au
Please be sure to include your full name and address details.
the unit was dead. The battery clip was
missing, with only the red and black
wire entrails hanging out of the compartment. This was going to be easy!
I rifled through my parts drawers
and extracted a 9V battery clip of a
vintage that complemented the retro
orange duco, de-soldered the two wires
from the PCB and refitted the new clip
in their place. I then managed to find
a 9V battery with enough zing in it to
pass the lick test and clipped it into
the tuner.
Flipping the unit back over, I moved
the first switch to the BAT position and
was encouraged to see the needle rising
to the lower end of the “Good” mark
on the meter. I then slid the switch to
the ON position, selected the A-string
pitch and did my best impersonation
of a chorister at what I thought was
about 440Hz, but the meter’s pointer
failed to rise off the lefthand end-stop.
My first reaction was that the tuner
was simply being judgemental about
my dulcet tones, so I tried a few different pitches on the pitch selector
switch, again with no success. I then
connected a guitar to the 1/4-inch input socket but this also failed to elicit
a response and after confirming that
both the cable and the guitar were
OK on a known-good tuner, I realised
that it wasn’t my singing that was the
problem!
I opened the case again and had a
careful look for any dry solder joints.
This quickly revealed a fractured joint
on the 1/4-inch socket and I surmised
that both the microphone and guitar
signals passed through this socket,
with the microphone signal being bypassed when a guitar was connected.
After re-soldering this joint, I turned
the unit back on and checked the response with my voice and a guitar but
the meter still refused to move.
Disassembling the tuner for a third
time, I re-inspected the PCB for any further dry joints that I may have missed.
I found a couple of narrowly-spaced
pads near the new battery clip pads
that looked a little frosty but I didn’t
think they were bad enough to cause
trouble. Even so, I re-flowed these pads
with fresh solder as well.
Curious to know what was on the
other side of the board, I flipped it over
and had a look at the device connected to the pads I had just re-flowed. It
turned out to be a 78L05 5V regulator
but there appeared to be some kind of
strange mark on the front of its body.
On taking a closer look, I realised that
the mark was in fact a crack that had
split the regulator right down the middle.
I duly replaced the damaged regulator and reassembled the guitar tuner for
what I hoped would be the last time.
And that was it – this time, when I connected a guitar, I was at last rewarded
with the pointer springing up to the
middle of the dial when I ran the pitch
tests. A quick whistle test confirmed
that the microphone also worked. It
also confirmed that my initial assessment of my vocal abilities wasn’t too
far off the mark.
I can’t imagine what caused the
78L05 to fail in such a spectacular way
considering that the highest voltage applied to it would have only been from
a 9V battery. As can be imagined, the
owner was grateful to have the tuner
SC
back in working order.
Issues Getting Dog-Eared?
Keep your copies of SILICON CHIP safe, secure &
always available with these handy binders
REAL
VALUE
AT
$16.95
*
PLUS P
&
P
Order now from www.siliconchip.com.au/Shop/4 or call (02) 9939 3295
and quote your credit card number. *See website for overseas prices.
siliconchip.com.au
March 2016 59
Solar MPPT Charger &
Lighting Controller
Our new Solar MPPT Charger/Lighting Controller uses solar
panels to charge a 12V or 24V battery and then works with LDR/
PIR sensors to run 12V DC lighting or an inverter. Last month, we
gave the circuit details; this month, we show you how to build it
and describe the setting-up procedure.
Pt.2: By JOHN CLARKE
T
HIS UNIT is easy to build, with
all parts mounted on a PCB coded 16101161 and measuring 141 x
112mm. This is mounted in a diecast
case measuring 171 x 121 x 55mm. The
PCB is secured to integral mounting
points inside the case and is shaped
so that it fits neatly around the central
pillars on either side.
As well as providing a rugged assembly, the diecast case also provides
heatsinking for diodes D1 & D2, power
Mosfet Q1 and power transistor Q3.
60 Silicon Chip
Fig.7 shows the parts layout on the
PCB. Begin the assembly by installing
the resistors. Table 1 shows the resistor colour codes but you should also
use a DMM to check each value as it is
installed, as the colours can sometimes
be hard to decipher. Note that the “in
brackets” values shown for some of the
resistors are for the 24V version of the
Solar Charge & Lighting Controller.
Note also that the 0.01Ω 3W resistor
(just above fuse F1) should be left out
at this stage of the assembly. It goes in
after the fuse clips have been installed
(see below).
Diode D3 can go in next, followed by
zener diodes ZD1, ZD2 & ZD3. These
must all be mounted with the correct
orientation, as shown on Fig.7. Leave
power diodes D1 and D2 out for the
time being.
Zener diode ZD4 is not normally installed and a wire link is used for resistor R2. This is the standard set-up
if using a PIR sensor that can handle
a supply of up to 14.4V.
siliconchip.com.au
100k
IC2
LM358
4.7k
22k
100Ω
1
ZD4 12V 1W 100nF
100nF
(Values in brackets
(47k )
are for 24V version) (1k )
Conversely, ZD4 must be installed
if you are using a PIR sensor that’s
rated at 12V maximum. If ZD4 is fitted, you must also use a resistor for R2
instead of a link. Use a 270Ω resistor
for a 12V battery and a 1.2kΩ resistor
for the 24V version.
In particular, note that ZD4 and a
1.2kΩ resistor (for R2) must be used
for the 24V version, unless the PIR can
operate directly from a 28.8V supply.
IC1’s socket can now go in, followed
by IC2, REG1 & OPTO1 which can all
be directly soldered to the PCB. Check
that these parts are all correctly orientated before soldering their pins. Trimpots VR1-VR5 can then be installed.
VR1 & VR2 are 20kΩ types and may be
marked as 203. VR3 & VR4 are 10kΩ
trimpots (103), while VR5 is a 500kΩ
trimpot (504).
Once the trimpots are in, fit PC
stakes to test points TP1-TP4 & TP
GND, then fit PC stakes to terminate
the leads from inductor L1. That done,
install switch S1 and the 3-way pin
headers for JP1 & JP2.
Transistors Q2 & Q5 are next on the
list. Make sure that Q2 is a BC337 and
that Q5 is a 2N7000. Mosfet Q4 can
then be installed; it’s mounted horisiliconchip.com.au
10 µF
35V
100k
R1
100k
100nF
Solar Lighting
100Ω
VR1 20k
LDR
Light
Threshold
NTC
PIR
470Ω
4N28
OPTO1
TP4
Timer
mV/ C
THERMISTOR
100nF
1
1k
68k
(51k )
TP3
A
Fig.7: follow this
parts layout diagram
to assemble the PCB.
Power devices D1,
D2, Q1 & Q3 must
all be mounted on
10mm lead lengths,
while LED1 is
mounted on 20mm
lead lengths so that
it can later be bent
over to protrude
through the side of
the case. Refer to the
text for the winding
details for inductor
L1.
DAY
NIGHT
LDR
VR2 20k
10k
8.2k
22k
1
LED1
10k
CON2
470pF
ZD2 30V 1W
1.5k
SWITCH
R2 *
* see text
S1
2.2k
2.2k
100nF
PIR
TRIGGER
SUPPLY
–
TP2
Q4
IRF1405N
TPGND
VR4 10k
4.7k
16110161
SET 5V <at>TP1
TP1
VR3 10k
10Ω
SET BATT.
+
1
JP2
–
330Ω
VR5 500k
LAMP
Note:
Lamp
supply
=battery
voltage
+
10nF
ZD1 30V 1W
10nF
–
C 2016
16101161
Q2
BC337
JP1
M205
F1 10A
CON1
BATTERY
+
Rev.0
D3
4148
2 x 100nF
X2 Class
470Ω
0.01Ω
100 µF
–
ZD3
18V 1W
L1
5 µH
(10 µH)
REG1
TL499A
SOLAR
PANEL
2200 µF/25V (Values in brackets
(470 µF/63 V) are for 24V version)
IC1 PIC16F88
+
10Ω
2200 µF/25V
(470 µF/63 V)
TIP31C
1k 1W
Q3
Q1SUP53P06-20
100Ω
+
+
D1 MBR20100CT
D2 MBR20100CT
1nF
CON3
10Ω
100nF
zontally on a small finned heatsink
with its leads bent down through 90°
so that they go through their respective holes in the PCB. Be sure to secure
the assembly in place using an M3 x
6mm machine screw, washer and nut
before soldering the leads.
There is no need to electrically isolate Q4’s tab from the heatsink, so an
insulation washer is not required.
Now for the fuse clips. These must
go in with their retaining tabs on the
outside, otherwise you will not be
able to fit the fuse correctly later on.
Once these are in, install the 0.01Ω
3W resistor.
The next step is to fit all the capacitors. Be sure to orientate the electrolytic types correctly. Note that the
values and voltage ratings of the two
large electrolytic capacitors at top left
depend on whether the unit is built for
12V or 24V operation.
Follow with screw terminal blocks
CON1-CON3. Note that CON1 uses
large screw terminals in order to handle the heavy current requirements for
the solar panel, battery and lamp connections. CON2 and CON3 are smaller units and are made up by dovetailing separate connectors together. In
Q5
2N7000
INSULATING WASHER
INSULATING BUSH
M3 x 10mm
SCREW
M3 NUT
TO220
DEVICE
BOX SIDE
PC BOARD
Fig.8: power devices D1, D2, Q1
& Q3 must be electrically isolated
from the case using insulating
washers and insulating bushes.
After mounting each device, use
your DMM (set to a high Ohms
range) to check that the metal tab
is indeed isolated from the case.
particular, CON2 uses a 3-way and
2-way connector, while CON3 uses
two 2-way connectors.
Make sure that CON2 and CON3 are
orientated with their openings towards
the outside edge of the PCB.
Power devices
Power devices D1, D2, Q1 and Q3
are all installed with their mountMarch 2016 61
Inductor L1 is made by twisting six
416mm-long strands of 0.5mm copper
wire together and then winding on
seven (or 10) turns – see text.
The external leads are fed into the case via cable glands.
Additional cable glands will be required for the optional
lamp, PIR and external switch connections.
ing tab holes about 22mm above the
PCB. In practice, this means mounting the devices on 10mm lead-lengths
and that’s best done with the aid of a
10mm-wide cardboard spacer slid between the device leads.
Be careful not to get these devices mixed up and note that the metal
tabs go towards the outside edge of
the board.
LED1 (centre, right) must be mounted so that it can later protrude through
a hole in the side of the diecast case.
It’s just a matter of soldering it in at
full lead length, then bending its leads
over at right angles about 8mm above
the PCB (eg, by bending it over a 8mm
cardboard spacer). Be sure to orientate
the LED correctly; its anode (A) lead
is the longer of the two.
Winding inductor L1
Inductor L1 is wound using six
strands of 0.5mm enamelled copper
wire that are all twisted together. Begin by cutting 6 x 416mm lengths of
wire, then strip about 15mm of enamel
off each wire at one end. Lightly tin
these wire ends, then twist the ends
together and solder them.
Next, secure this soldered end in the
chuck of a hand or battery-powered
drill and twist all the wires together,
so that each wire twists by 360° ap-
proximately every 20mm (see photos).
That done, wind seven turns (or 10
turns for the 24V version) through the
toroid, spacing the turns evenly. Once
they’re on, position the inductor on the
PCB and bend the soldered end so that
it mates with one of the inductor’s PC
stakes. The other end can then be positioned to mate with its PC stake and
cut to length.
Finally, strip back the enamel from
the leads at this end, twist and solder
them together and install the inductor
on the PCB. A couple of cable ties fed
through adjacent holes on either side
of the inductor are then used to secure
it in place.
Note that multiple strands of wire
are used to minimise the impact of
skin effect. If a single, larger wire had
been used instead, its effective resistance at the switching frequency would
be higher, leading to greater losses and
more heating.
The approach taken here to reduce
Table 1: Resistor Colour Codes (12V Version)
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
No.
3
1
2
2
1
2
2
1
2
2
1
1 (opt.)
3
3
1
62 Silicon Chip
Value
100kΩ
68kΩ
22kΩ
10kΩ
8.2kΩ
4.7kΩ
2.2kΩ
1.5kΩ
1kΩ
470Ω
330Ω
270Ω
100Ω
10Ω
0.01Ω
4-Band Code (1%)
brown black yellow brown
blue grey orange brown
red red orange brown
brown black orange brown
grey red red brown
yellow violet red brown
red red red brown
brown green red brown
brown black red brown
yellow violet brown brown
orange orange brown brown
red violet brown brown
brown black brown brown
brown black black brown
not applicable
5-Band Code (1%)
brown black black orange brown
blue grey black red brown
red red black red brown
brown black black red brown
grey red black brown brown
yellow violet black brown brown
red red black brown brown
brown green black brown brown
brown black black brown brown
yellow violet black black brown
orange orange black black brown
red violet black black brown
brown black black black brown
brown black black gold brown
not applicable
siliconchip.com.au
Using The Solar Charger/Lighting
Controller With 24V Batteries
As stated last month, the Solar MPPT Charger/Lighting Controller can also be used
with 24V batteries and 24V solar panels. However, this requires some component
changes to the circuit and these are indicated in brackets on Fig.7. In summary,
the required changes are as follows:
(1) The 22kΩ resistor at pin 3 of lC2a is changed to 47kΩ, the 100Ω resistor
feeding ZD2 is changed to 1kΩ and the 22kΩ resistor at the AN2 input of IC1 is
changed to 51kΩ.
(2) The 2200μF 25V low-ESR capacitors are changed to 470μF 63V low-ESR types.
(3) The number of turns on inductor L1 is increased from seven to 10.
(4) If used, R2 should be increased to 1.2kΩ.
Several set-up changes are also required:
(1) The voltage at TP2 (set by VR2) must now be the battery voltage x 0.15625
(instead of 0.3125).
(2) The voltage set at TP3 for temperature compensation (step 8 in the setting
up procedure) must be half that set for 12V operation. For example, for 38mV/°C
compensation with a 24V battery, TP2 should read 1.9V (not 3.8V).
skin effect is similar to that of using
Litz wire, except that the twisted wires
are larger.
That completes the PCB assembly.
The next step is to prepare the case.
Case drilling
The first step here is to drill two
holes in one side of the case to accept
two IP68 8mm cable glands, plus another hole in the opposite side for a
6.5mm cable gland. To do that, position the PCB inside the case and carefully mark out the positions for these
cable glands. As shown in the photos,
they are positioned opposite CON1
and CON3 and are centred vertically.
The PCB can then be removed from
the case and the holes drilled and
reamed to size. Deburr all edges with
a small round file.
That done, the PCB can be temporarily repositioned in the case and
the mounting holes for the four power devices (D1, D2, Q1 & Q3) and for
LED1 marked out. Drill these holes to
3mm, then use an oversize drill to remove any metal swarf so that the area
around each hole is perfectly smooth.
This latter step is necessary to prevent
punch-though of the insulating washers used with the power devices.
The PCB can now be secured inside
the case using the supplied screws
and the four TO-220 power devices
attached to one side of the case, as
shown in Fig.8. Note that it is necessary to isolate each device tab from the
siliconchip.com.au
Table 2: Capacitor Codes
Value
100nF
10nF
1nF
470pF
µF Value IEC Code EIA Code
0.1µF
100n
104
0.01µF 10n
103
0.001µF 1n
102
NA
470p
471
case using an insulating washer and
insulating bush.
Once they have been installed, use a
digital multimeter (set to read ohms) to
confirm that the metal tabs are indeed
isolated from the metal case. If a low
resistance reading is found, check that
the silicone washer for that particular
TO-220 device has not been punctured
by metal swarf.
If it has, then clear away the swarf
and replace the insulating washer.
Setting up
The step-by-step setting-up procedure is as follows:
Step 1: check that IC1 is out of its socket, then fit the fuse and apply 12V to
the battery input terminals.
Step 2: connect a DMM between TP1
and TPGND and adjust VR1 for a reading of 5.0V.
Step 3: disconnect the 12V supply and
wait for the 5V rail (measured at TP1)
to drop to near 0V.
Step 4: plug IC1 into its socket, then
reconnect the 12V supply.
Step 5: measure the voltage across the
Miss
this
one?
Big, bold
and beautiful
– and simply
the BEST DIY
loudspeaker
system ever
published . . .
anywhere!
Published in
May, 2014
The
Majestic
Everything about this superb loudspeaker
system is impressive: size, physical presence,
power handling, efficiency – and most of all,
performance. Compare them with commercial
loudspeakers ten and twenty times the price!
If you want the ultimate build-it-yourself
loudspeakers, you want The Majestic!
You’ll find the construction details at
siliconchip.com.au/Project/Majestic
Crossover PCB available from On-Line Shop
INTO RADIO?
How about
SiDRADIO?
Take a Cheap DTV
Dongle and end up
with a 100kHz2GHz SoftwareDefined Radio!
Published
October
2013
It’sDon’t
yours
with the 200W
pay $$$$ for a commercial
Ultra
LD
Amplifier
from
receiver: this uses a <$20 USB
DTV/DAB+ dongle as the basis for a very
high performance SSB, FM, CW, AM etc
radio that tunes from DC to daylight!
Features:
Tuned RF front end
Up-converter inbuilt
Powered from PC via USB cable
Single PCB construction
Lots of follow-up articles, too!
Want to know more? Search for “sidradio”
at siliconchip.com.au/project/sidradio
PCBs & Micros available from On-Line Shop
March 2016 63
Lighting & Inverter Options
As stated last month, jumpers JP1 &
JP2 select the various lighting options.
Here are a few suggestions:
(1) Night-time garden lighting: the
light sensor allows the lights to switch
on at dusk and they can remain lit for
a preset period of up to eight hours, as
set by the timer. Alternatively, you may
wish to have the lights lit for the entire
night and to switch off automatically at
sunrise, provided there is sufficient battery capacity.
(2) Security or pathway lighting: the
lights can be set to switch on after dusk
but only when someone approaches the
area. In this case, a PIR movement detector switches on the lights while the
timer switches off the lights after the
time-out period, typically 1-3 minutes
or longer (8-hour maximum).
(3) Shed lighting: in this case, you may
opt to switch the lights on and off using
an external pushbutton switch. The lights
can remain on until they are switched off
again or they can switch automatically
after a preset period, or at sunrise (as
detected by an LDR).
Normally, the controller would be set
so that the lights only come on when it
is dark. However, you might want the
lights on during day in a shed and this
can be done using the third option listed in Table 1 last month; ie, JP1 in the
night position, JP2 in the LDR position
and the LDR left disconnected.
Using an inverter
As mentioned last month, you can directly switch up to 10A of 12V DC lighting via the LAMP terminals on CON1.
Alternatively, instead of using 12V
lamps, you can use an inverter to run
230VAC lamps.
This latter option requires the addi-
Battery size
CON2
PIR POWER +
PIR SIGNAL
PIR POWER 0V
REMOTE
SWITCH
CONNECTION
+
–
POWER
N/O
CONTACT
SOLAR LIGHTING
CONTROLLER
PIR
SENSOR
Fig.9: here’s how to connect the Altronics S5134A
PIR Sensor to the unit. Note the link between the
negative supply terminal & one of the NO contacts.
Mounting & Connecting A PIR Sensor
An Altronics S5314A PIR sensor was used with our prototype unit but other
similar PIR sensors will also be suitable.
The Altronics sensor can be configured for either a normally open (NO) or normally closed (NC) output. In this case, it’s necessary to select the NO option using the supplied jumper.
Once that’s done, the PIR sensor is connected to CON2 on the Solar Charge/
Lighting Controller as shown above in Fig.9. Note the link between the PIR’s negative power terminal and one of its NO contacts. The PIR’s other NO contact connects to the PIR signal input on CON2.
In operation, the signal input terminal is normally pulled to +5V via R1 (100kΩ)
on the controller’s PCB. However, when movement is detected, the PIR’s contacts
close and the signal input is pulled down to 0V, thus triggering the controller and
turning on the lights.
When mounting the PIR sensor, be sure to position it so that it covers the desired detection area. You can test its coverage by temporarily mounting it in position, connecting the 12V supply from CON2 and watching the detect LED in the
PIR sensor light as you move around the detection area.
64 Silicon Chip
tion of an external relay (rated at 12VDC
150A) to switch the inverter on and off.
Fig.10 shows the details.
As can be seen, the external relay’s
coil is connected across the LAMP terminals of CON1, while its NO (normally
open) contacts switch the positive supply line from the battery through to the
inverter. The negative supply terminal in
the inverter is directly connected to the
negative battery terminal.
A 150A relay is recommended to cope
with the surge currents drawn by the
inverter. If you are using a 24V battery,
you will need to connect a 47Ω 10W resistor in series with the relay’s 12V coil.
Assuming that the relay has a 50Ω coil,
this 47Ω resistor will effectively halve the
voltage that’s applied to the coil.
Note that the supply wiring to the relay and to the inverter must be rated
to carry the inverter’s current. A 12V
600W inverter, for example, will need
supply wiring that’s capable of carrying
at least 50A.
A minimum battery capacity of 80Ah
is recommended. A larger battery can be
used provided that you don’t draw more
out of the battery than the solar panels
are able to top up. If you do use more
power than the solar panels can provide,
the battery will eventually be discharged.
LiFePO4 charging
As mentioned, when using a LiFePO4
battery terminals and multiply this
by 0.3125.
Step 6: press switch S1 and wait for
a few seconds, then connect a DMM
between TP2 and TPGND and adjust
VR2 so that the DMM reads the calculated figure. For example, if the battery
terminal voltage is 12.0V, TP2 should
read 3.75V.
Step 7: determine the recommended
temperature compensation (in mV/°C)
for your battery by looking up its specifications. Usually, there will be a graph
which show the battery’s fully charged
voltage against temperature. You will
need to determine the mV/°C figure
from this graph.
Step 8: connect the DMM to TP3, hold
down switch S1 and adjust VR3 until
the meter shows the required temperature compensation value. This reading will be in the range of 0-5V, represiliconchip.com.au
+
D1 MBR20100CT
+
TO SOLAR
PANEL
–
+
SOLAR
PANEL
2200 µF/25V
(470 µF/63 V)
–
LAMP
LAMP–
M205
–
Note:
Lamp
supply
=battery
voltage
+
–
BATTERY
+
100nF
87A
R2 *
* see text
87
85
150A 12V RELAY
S1
ZD2
1.5k
SWITCH
30
–
CON2
PIR
TRIGGER
SUPPLY
86
F1 10A
2.2k
LAMP+
+
CON1
–BATTERY
–
BATTERY
+
0.01Ω
100Ω
+BATTERY
2.2k
Fig.10: an external relay is required if you
wish to power the lamps via a 230VAC
inverter. Note that the wiring to the battery
and to the inverter must be rated to carry
the inverter’s maximum current.
ZD4 12V 1W 100nF
100nF
(Values in brackets
are for 24V version) (1k )
+
SOLAR LIGHTING CONTROLLER
–
(85 & 86 = COIL; 30 = COMMON; 87 = NO CONTACT)
230VAC INVERTER
battery, the mV/°C setting using VR3
must be set to 0mV/°C. This allows the
correct charging cycle for this battery
chemistry.
senting 0-50mV/°C; ie, 1V = 10mV/°C.
Note that this applies to lead-acid
batteries only. If you have a LiFePO4
battery, set VR3 fully anticlockwise for
a 0V reading at TP3.
Thermistor connection
Thermistor TH1 can be directly
connected to CON3 inside the case if
you are not too concerned about temperature compensation. However, you
would then be relying on the temperature within the case being similar to
that of the battery.
The odds are that the case and battery temperatures will be different,
though. So, instead of mounting it in
the case, the best way to mount the
thermistor is to tape it to the side of
the battery and connect it to CON3 using single-core shielded cable (fed in
via the cable gland). This lead should
siliconchip.com.au
In addition, a cell balancer should
be connected to the balance connector on the battery. This is necessary to
ensure that each cell that makes up the
battery is charged to the same level as
the others.
A suitable cell balancer is published
elsewhere in this issue of SILICON CHIP.
Cable Resistance Must Be Kept Low
When the Solar Charge Controller is used with a 120W panel, the charging current to the battery can be as high as 10A. Hence, the cable resistance between the
Charge Controller and the battery should be made as low as possible, otherwise
voltage losses will affect the changeover from the bulk charge to the absorption
stage of charging. This will reduce the overall charging efficacy.
To minimise these voltage losses, mount the charger close to the battery
and use heavy duty cables. For a total cable length of less than one metre (ie,
total wire length for the positive and negative wires), cables with a cross-sectional
area of 1.29mm2 (eg, 41 x 0.2mm) can be used. This will result in a voltage loss
of just 100mV at 10A.
For longer wire lengths, use heavier duty cable. For example, 8-gauge wire with
7 x 95/0.12mm wire and a cross sectional area of 7.5mm2 can be used with a total length of up to 5.5m.
be soldered to the thermistor and the
solder joints insulated with heatshrink
tubing (polarity is unimportant).
Note that you must have the thermistor connected if the mV/°C adjust-
ment, as measured, at TP3 is above 0V.
If it’s left out, LED1 will flash to give
the disconnected thermistor indication and charging will not take place.
Conversely, if VR3 is set to give 0V at
March 2016 65
Table 3: Setting The Time-out Period
TP4 Voltage
Time-out Period (Approx.)
Adjustment Steps
Timeout Calculation (Approx.)
0-2.5V
2-250 seconds (approx. 4 minutes)
2 seconds
2.5-4.9V
4-480 minutes (up to 8 hours)
4 minutes
TP4 voltage x 100 seconds
(2 seconds miniumum)
(TP4 voltage - 2.5V) x 200 minutes
(4 minutes minimum)
Above 4.9V
No timeout
TP3 (ie, 0mV/°C compensation), such
as when using a LiFePO4 battery, the
thermistor can be left disconnected.
Connecting the LDR
The LDR will need to be connected
to CON3 if you want the lighting to be
controlled by the ambient light level.
You then have to set jumpers JP1 & JP2
to determine whether the lights come
on at night or during the day – see
Table 1 last month.
As with the NTC thermistor, the LDR
can be attached via a length of singlecore shielded cable (or use figure-8
lead). The LDR should be mounted in
a location where it receives ambient
light only; not light from the lamps
being switched by the Solar Charge/
Lighting Controller.
An external switch can also be used
for lamp on/off control. This should
be a momentary-contact pushbutton
switch. This is connected to CON2’s
switch terminals using figure-8 cable
(ie, it connects in parallel with switch
S1 on the PCB).
Another option is to connect a PIR
sensor to CON2 and use that to control the lamp switching. An accompa-
Positioning The Solar Panel
The solar panel should be mounted on a roof or in some other position where it
has an unobstructed view of the sky. In Australia, NZ and other southern hemisphere
locations, it should be set facing north (or south for northern hemisphere locations).
The panel’s inclination should be roughly 23° up from horizontal for NSW, SA,
central/south WA and the North Island of NZ. Slightly higher angles are required
for Victoria, Tasmania and NZ’s South Island, while slightly lower angles will be
needed for Qld, NT and northern WA.
If in doubt, check the inclination required on internet sites. In addition, take care
to avoid any possibility of shadowing (eg, from a pole or tree) as the sun traverses
the sky.
nying panel in this artricle describes
how to do this.
Setting the time-out period
Depending on your application, the
timer will need to be set to an appropriate period. The time-out period can
be adjusted from two seconds (2s) up
to about eight hours using VR4.
Table 3 shows the time-out with respect to the voltage on TP4, as set by
VR4. This adjustment must be made
while S1 is pressed, with a multimeter
connected between TP4 and TPGND.
For voltages up to 2.5V, the timeout period in seconds is simply the
measured voltage multiplied by 100.
For example, a 1V setting will provide
a time-out of 100 seconds.
For TP4 voltages above 2.5V, it’s a
bit more complicated. The procedure
is as follows: divide the required timeout period in minutes by 200, then add
2.5V to this figure and adjust VR4 until the voltage at TP4 matches the calculated value.
Note that the minimum time-out
SC
above 2.5V is four minutes.
Are Your S ILICON C HIP Issues
Getting Dog-Eared?
Are your SILICON CHIP copies getting damaged or
dog-eared just lying on a shelf? Can you quickly
find a particular issue that you need to refer to?
Keep your copies of SILICON CHIP safe,
secure and always available with
these handy binders
REAL
VALUE
AT
$16.95
*
PLUS P
&
P
Order now from www.siliconchip.com.au/Shop/4
or call (02) 9939 3295 and quote your credit card number.
*See website for overseas prices.
66 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
CIRCUIT NOTEBOOK
Interesting circuit ideas which we have checked but not built and tested. Contributions will be
paid for at standard rates. All submissions should include full name, address & phone number.
Hot-wire cutter with
PICAXE heat controller
siliconchip.com.au
OUT
10 µF
IN
GND
100nF
16V
K
S1
A
+12V
220 µF
X1
16V
CUTTING WIRE
The concept behind hot-wire cutting is to use a variable power supply
and heat a length of nichrome resistance wire to just below red heat. This
enables the heated wire to melt most
foam plastic or Styrofoam materials
and allows you to cut straight lines
or intricate shapes. Nichrome wire
expands when heated and you must
include a spring to keep the wire taut.
This hot wire cutter will cut foam
materials up to 210mm thick and
250mm from an edge and requires
a timber frame with a length of nichrome wire tensioned by a spring.
The nichrome wire came from Jaycar (Cat. WW-4040) and the spring
from Bunnings (Century type C215).
0.315mm Nichrome wire has a resistance of 13.77Ω per meter or 3.72Ω
for the 270mm length shown in the
diagram. While you could drive the
hot-wire cutter from an an adjustable
bench power supply (capable of 12V
DC at over 3A), this circuit shows
a better approach with a PICAXEbased heat controller and an ATX
computer power supply.
The PICAXE controller uses pulse
width modulation at 5kHz with a variable mark space ratio and the average power delivered to the load, as
set by VR1, can range from 50-100%,
as needed. The 12V from the external power supply is fed directly to
the hot-wire and Mosfet Q1, while
7805 regulator REG1 provides 5V DC
to the PICAXE microcontroller (IC1).
If using an ATX supply, you will
need a switch between the green
wire and any black wire on the main
20-pin connector. Then connect any
yellow and black wire as the 12V DC
supply. Some supplies will need a
10Ω 10W load resistor across the
5VDC red and black wires.
The circuit shows an ICSP header
to download the software into IC1
and uses pin 2 as the serial input
and pin 7 as the serial output. You
will require a special PICAXE serial or USB cable (www.picaxe.com);
download the hot-wire_08m2.bas ba-
D1 1N4004
REG1 7805
2.2k
4
100%
VR1
10k
LIN
3
1
Vdd
C3
C2
IC1
C4 PICAXE
-08M2
50%
A
2 Ser
In
22k
Vss
C1
5
λ
LED1
K
6
X2
100Ω
Ser 7
Out
D
8
ICSP
HEADER
G
Q1
IRF1405N
S
10k
10k
0V
7805
LED
1N4004
A
2x B
K
GND
IN
A
K
GND
IRF1405N
OUT
B
G
D
D
S
2x A
X1
TOP ARM 350 x 40 x 19mm
20
MAIN
ASSEMBLY
SCREWS A:
8G x 40mm
340mm LENGTH (LUG-TO-LUG)
OF 28 B&S NICHROME WIRE
(0.315mm DIAMETER,
13.77 Ω/METRE)
HOLES FOR
NICHROME
WIRE ARE
10mm IN
DIAMETER
WIRE
MOUNTING
SCREWS B:
8G x 25mm
40mm LENGTH OF
12mm DIAM. COPPER
OR ALUMINIUM TUBE
POWER
WIRE
REAR POST
220 x 80 x 19mm
2x A
2x A
DETAILS OF X1 OR X2
BASE 440 x 240 x 19mm
X2
2x B
CENTURY C215
STRETCH SPRING
2x A
B
FRONT & REAR FEET 240 x 40 x 19mm
HOT WIRE CUTTER FRAME CONSTRUCTION DETAILS
sic program from the website at www.
siliconchip.com.au
Ian Robertson,
Engadine, NSW. ($70)
Editor’ note: an alternative to this hotwire cutter was featured in the De-
SCALE: 25% OF ACTUAL SIZE
cember 2010 issue (www.siliconchip.
com.au/Issue/2010/December/A+
HotWire+Cutter+With+Inbuilt+
Heat+Controller) and a PCB is available from our Online Shop at www.
siliconchip.com.au/Shop/8/825
March 2016 67
Circuit Notebook – Continued
V1
6550
V1
6550
IRF530
G
ZD1
430k
(13k)
A
D
D
K
S
2.2k
180Ω
K
K
Q1
IRF530
S
ZD1
BZX84-33
A
Q1
IRF530
10k
G
100nF
VR1
10k
3.3k
BIAS VOLTAGE RANGE 18 – 30V
AT 80mA CATHODE CURRENT
FIG.1 CONSTANT RESISTANCE VERSION
Adjustable current
sink for valve biassing
The Currawong Valve Amplifier
project has stimulated significant interest in valve amplifier design and
in particular, the concept of a variable cathode resistance for valve output stages. These designs are based
on a Mosfet as an adjustable shunt
regulator which is connected between the cathode of a valve (V1,
V2, V3) and earth.
In Fig.1, the Mosfet is configured
essentially as a constant voltage
shunt regulator. The circuit relies on
the fact that a typical power Mosfet
has a non-zero gate threshold voltage
which can be used as a voltage reference in an appropriately designed
negative feedback network. This
makes such Mosfets suitable for use
in simple shunt regulator circuits.
However, bear in mind two things:
First, the gate turn-on voltage varies
widely between Mosfets of different
types and to a lesser extent, between
Mosfets of the same type. Second,
the turn-on voltage of a Mosfet is
somewhat temperature dependent.
As a result, it is important to take
these factors into account before using this kind of circuit in critical applications.
The circuit in Fig.1 works as follows: trimpot VR1 together with the
68 Silicon Chip
S
K
ZD1
BZX84-33
[33V]
D
[33V]
D
+400V
REGULATED
(+12V
REGULATED)
V1
6550
A
10k
G
Q1
IRF530
S
100nF
180Ω
[33V]
D
VR1
10k
ZD1
BZX84-33
A
1k
VR1
10k
G
100nF
8.2k
BIAS VOLTAGE RANGE 18 – 40V
AT 80mA CATHODE CURRENT
FIG.2 VARIABLE RESISTANCE VERSION
3.3kΩ resistor form a voltage divider
network which is connected from the
drain of the Mosfet to earth. Negative
feedback via the divider networks
causes the Mosfet to maintain a relatively constant voltage across its
drain-source terminals over a wide
range of operating currents.
The gate threshold voltage of the
specified Mosfet is about 4V and
hence, by negative feedback action,
the drain-source voltage is approximately the gate turn-on voltage (ie,
4V) multiplied by the resistance ratio
R/Rx where R is the total series resistance and Rx is the resistance from
the wiper of the trimpot to ground.
Because the Mosfet acts as a constant voltage shunt regulator, the
dynamic resistance of the circuit is
determined essentially by the 180Ω
series resistor. In principle, this resistor can be omitted if one wants
a constant voltage at the cathode (a
constant valve cathode bias voltage).
However, in practice, a small amount
of dynamic series resistance between
cathode and earth may be useful to
reduce variations in the valve plate
current due to changes in operating
temperature, valve aging etc.
The 10kΩ resistor and the 100nF
capacitor form a low-pass filter, in
part to reduce the high-frequency
response of the circuit (which in
general is desirable in this kind of
100Ω
10k
(39k)
10k
BIAS VOLTAGE RANGE 17 – 30V
AT 80mA CATHODE CURRENT
FIG.3 IMPROVED VARIABLE
RESISTANCE VERSION
application) and in part to reduce
pot noise.
Zener diode ZD1 is included in
the circuit to protect the Mosfet from
any unexpected voltage spikes, arising from current surges within the
valve such as might result from internal flash-over. The idea is that if
a current surge should occur, any resulting current flowing through the
zener would cause the gate voltage to
rise. The rise in gate voltage, in turn,
would cause the Mosfet to conduct
more heavily, thereby shunting any
excessive energy to earth before damage to the Mosfet occurs.
Alternatively, a high power (eg,
3W) zener diode could be connected directly across the drain-source
terminals of the Mosfet to protect it.
Figs.2 & 3 differ from Fig.1 primarily in that the cathode series resistor
is incorporated within the feedback
circuit (between source and earth)
and this gives the shunt regulator
a variable dynamic resistance, depending on the setting of the pot.
The circuit in Fig.3 can be regarded as an “improved variable resistance version” for two reasons: First,
it shows improved linearity in the
voltage-current curves in the low
current region and second, it has a
wider range (particularly at low plate
currents). These improvements are
achieved by including an external
siliconchip.com.au
+12V
100nF
100nF
16
Vdd
470nF
9
1M
SOLDERING
IRON
SPONGE
VR1
100k
82k
Ctc
Q13
Q12
10
Q10
Rtc
100k
11
100k
Q9
12
12
3
1
2
2
1
5
15
13
6
IC1
40 60 B Q8 14
Q7
RS
Q6
IC3e
11
Q14
100nF
Q5
MR
Vss
Q4
IC2a
IC2b
3
1
3
A
5
14
5
7
12
13
IC2d
GPO FOR
SOLDERING
IRON
E
K
4
N
A
8
150nF
9
100k
IC3c
IC2c
10
7
10nF
OUT
IN
1000 µF
25V
16V
10
8
PIEZO
SOUNDER
~
+
GND
470 µF
9
VR2
10k
BR1 W04
11
E
IC3d
6
7
REG1 7812
15
Q1
BC337
4
+12V
IC3f
B
λ
LED1
A
10k
IC2: 4081B
IC3: 4049B
(12V COIL, 250VAC
RATED CONTACTS)
C
K
6
RELAY
A
3.3k
2
D1
1N4148
4
D2
1N4004
1.5k
IC3b
1M
8
100nF
14
IC3a
K
T1
–
12V
A
230VAC
MAINS
INPUT
230VAC
N
~
E
W04
LED
1N4148
1N4004
A
A
K
Soldering
iron timer
Timers are available to turn power
off after a preset time but this design
is specifically intended for soldering irons and has two extra features.
First, the timer is automatically reset every time the soldering iron tip
is wiped across the wet sponge and
second, it beeps near the end of the
set period to remind the user it is
about to switch off.
The timer is based on a 4060
CMOS timer, IC1, which has an internal oscillator and 14-stage binary
counter. Not all stages have connection to external pins and the clock
speed is set by the components conbias voltage that compensates for
the non-zero gate turn-on voltage of
the Mosfet.
Without the external bias voltage, the minimum voltage that the
shunt regulator circuit can maintain
is equal to the gate turn-on voltage,
which in this case is about 4V. You
can reduce the minimum shunt voltage by using a Mosfet with a lower
turn-on gate voltage but you cansiliconchip.com.au
K
K
A
nected to pins 9, 10 & 11.
With the clock set to 7Hz, the timeout is about 20 minutes, with beeper
alert during the last 18 seconds. A
higher clock speed will result in a
shorter time-out time and vice versa.
The tip cleaning sponge, which
must be wet and isolated from earth,
is connected to the12V rail via a 1MΩ
resistor. When the tip (which must
be properly earthed) touches it, the
4049 inverter input is pulled low,
providing a positive reset pulse to
pin 12 of the 4060.
The 100kΩ resistor and 0.1µF capacitor provide some noise immunity and ESD protection.
During operation, when output
Q4 (pin 7) of IC1 goes high, a short
not reduce the shunt voltage to zero
without modifying the circuit.
By incorporating an external bias
voltage as shown, you can compensate for the gate turn-on voltage so
that in principle, the shunt voltage
could be arbitrarily as close to zero
as possible.
However, the optimal compensating bias voltage in Fig.3 varies with
the setting of the trimpot. The chal-
+~~–
7812
BC 33 7
B
E
GND
IN
C
GND
OUT
pulse (100ms) is generated each 2.3
seconds, causing LED1 to flash. After about 19 minutes, when output
Q14 (pin 3) goes high, the beeper
section is activated and the piezo
element beeps briefly each time the
LED flashes.
The timing ends and the relay
turns off when Q14 is high and Q8
becomes high.
A 12V relay with 250VAC-rated
contacts (SPST) typically requires
30mA and the 12V DC power supply should be able to deliver 60mA.
Caution: for safety reasons, soldering irons should not be left on
unattended
Charles Tivendale,
Edithvale, Vic. ($60)
lenge, when designing a circuit
such as this, is to configure the circuit so as to minimise that variation and thereby to obtain the best
possible compromise over the full
range of the pot. The component
values are rather critical if you want
to obtain optimal performance over
a desired operating range.
Herman Nacinovich,
Gulgong, NSW. ($80)
March 2016 69
Circuit Notebook – Continued
1N60
A
2 x 8T BIFILAR WOUND
ON RF-400-4 CORE
(TYPE 77 MATERIAL)
K
INPUT
A
S
OUTPUT
F
51pF
S
B
Zin = 3.3k
5k
A
C
100nF
INPUT
MATCHED
PAIR
F
51k
CONVENTIONAL GERMANIUM DIODE DETECTOR
36k
K
AA112
E
Zout = 1.5k
AA112
Q1
2N3643
1.3k
470 µF
100nF
10nF
OUTPUT
K
–12V
100Ω
DETECTOR LOAD
2N3643
Fig.1: this diagram shows a conventional germanium
diode detector is shown at top left, while at right is the
Supadetector.
1N60, AA112
SUPADETECTOR
A
B
C
K
E
Improved AM detector has low distortion
A germanium detector diode,
like any diode with forward voltage
drop, gives a very distorted response
when the signal amplitude is below
a few hundred millivolts and it has
square law properties in that zone.
To make the detector work well at
low signal levels, it can be forward
biased. But the amount of forward
bias needs to be temperature-com-
pensated and exactly right for the
germanium diode junction and not
too dependent on battery voltage.
You can also do this in crystal sets
etc to make the diode work better on
weak signals.
This “Supadetector” was designed
to replace the germanium detector in
some communications radios. It acts
as though it has little forward volt-
age drop, like an op amp precision
detector but it uses a transistor and
two diodes for full-wave rectification.
Although it looks just like a single
RF stage, it has a high load impedance provided by a bifilar-wound
inductor which drives two diodes.
This means there is a severe mismatch between the inductor and the
detector load but even at low signal
Radio, Television & Hobbies: the COMPLETE archive on DVD
YES!
NA
MORE THA URY
T
N
E
C
QUARTER
ICS
N
O
R
T
OF ELEC
HISTORY!
This remarkable collection of PDFs covers every issue of R & H, as it was known from
the beginning (April 1939 – price sixpence!) right through to the final edition of R, TV & H
in March 1965, before it disappeared forever with the change of name to EA.
For the first time ever, complete and in one handy DVD, every article and every issue is covered.
If you’re an old timer (or even young timer!) into vintage radio, it doesn’t get much more
vintage than this. If you’re a student of history, this archive gives an extraordinary insight
into the amazing breakthroughs made in radio and electronics technology following the war
years. And speaking of the war years, R & H had some of the best propaganda imaginable!
• Every issue individually archived, by month and year
• Complete with index for each year
• A must-have for everyone interested
in electronics
Exclusive to:
SILICON
CHIP
70 Silicon Chip
ONLY
62
$
00
+$10.00 P&P
Order now from www.siliconchip.com.au/Shop/3 or call
(02) 9939 3295 and quote your credit card number.
siliconchip.com.au
+6dB
SUPADETECTOR
IDEAL
DETECTOR
0dB
–3dB AT
10mV PEAK
–6dB
RELATIVE
OUTPUT:
20 x log (R/S)
IN60
DIODE
–12dB
WHERE
R= RECOVERED
MODULATION
–18dB
S = SIGNAL
MODULATION
–24dB
–30dB
–36dB
1mV
10mV
100mV
1.0V
10V
RF INPUT VOLTS PEAK (465kHz 30% MODULATION AT 1kHz)
Fig.2 above: this graph shows the output response curves for an ideal detector (green), a 1N60 diode detector (blue)
and the Supdetector circuit shown in Fig.1.
levels, the inductor voltage rises
high enough to maintain a good diode current.
The accompanying graph (Fig.2)
shows the straight line output of an
ideal detector (green) while a 1N60
diode is shown in blue. The Supadetector (red) is a great improvement
and still shows quite good performance for signals below 10mV peak
(7mV RMS).
This version of the circuit was for
use in a positive ground radio but
it can be made a number of ways
for positive or negative ground circuits and transistors of either polarity. It pays to have coiled loops on
the germanium diode wires to prevent physical trauma to the glass
and thermal trauma to the junction
when soldering.
Below: the author’s Supadetector prototype was
built on a small PCB.
The original idea to drive a diode
with a current source and not a voltage source, to overcome low level
signal non-linearity in a detector is
noted in Horowitz & Hill’s textbook
The Art of Electronics.
Hugo Holden,
Minyama, Qld. ($70)
Circuit Ideas Wanted
Got an interesting original circuit that you have cleverly devised? We need it and will pay good money to feature it in
the Circuit Notebook pages. We can pay you by electronic funds transfer, cheque (what are they?) or direct to your
PayPal account. Or you can use the funds to purchase anything from the SILICON CHIP on-line shop, including PCBs
and components, back issues, subscriptions or whatever. Email your circuit and descriptive text to editor<at>siliconchip.
com.au or post it to SILICON CHIP, PO Box 139, Collaroy Beach, NSW 2097.
siliconchip.com.au
March 2016 71
Battery Pack
Cell Balancer
Many multi-purpose chargers can handle lithium-ion, lithium-polymer
or LiFePO4 batteries. But they may not balance the charge between
individual cells and this can lead to incomplete charging and premature
failure. This small device solves this by providing the balancing
function separately. It can also be used with Nicad and NiMH packs for
a longer life-span and is suitable for use with the MPPT Solar Lighting
Charger/Controller published elsewhere in this issue.
By Nicholas Vinen
T
RADITIONAL BATTERY chargers
treat a battery as a device having
two terminals, delivering current until the battery voltage reaches a certain level. The termination voltage is
the fully-charged cell voltage multiplied by the number of cells and the
assumption is that the when the battery reaches this voltage, each cell is
fully charged. However, this relies on
the cells being identical.
Similarly, the battery is determined
to be flat when the overall voltage
reaches a level indicating that each
cell is fully discharged. But if one cell
starts out with a lesser charge or discharges faster for some reason, it could
be over-discharged before this threshold is reached. This could damage the
cell, leading to lower capacity and a
shorter battery-pack life.
It’s quite typical for a battery-pack
to fail because the internal resistance
of just one cell has gone high. The
charge and discharge current must
flow through all cells, so once one cell
can no longer pass enough current, the
whole battery is useless. Similarly, if
Features & Specifications
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Balances Li-ion, LiPo or LiFePO4 batteries with 2-8 cells
Can also balance NiMH or Nicad packs with 4-8 cells
Fully charged battery voltage of up to 33.6V (8 x 4.2V)
Suitable for use with chargers up to 10A
Will work with chargers >10A but not as effectively
Cell balancing shunt current: ~200mA
Very low quiescent current: <25µA
Compact PCB can be mounted next to battery pack
Works with virtually any non-balancing charger
Plugs straight into typical battery balance connectors
No external power required
Automatically detects number of cells
Detection of charging by cell voltage or via external signal
Adjustable cell voltage balance start threshold via resistor
LEDs indicate balance status
72 Silicon Chip
one cell’s voltage is especially low
(or perhaps even negative), the fully
charged battery voltage may be insufficient even though the rest of the cells
are healthy.
So for the longest battery life you
need to ensure that all cells are charged
and discharged equally. Even with a
brand new battery, cell capacity may
vary slightly (by one ot two percent,
say) but over time, this can worsen.
This effect is greater with lithiumbased cells than other types, which is
why it’s important to ensure they are
properly balanced during charging.
Consider a 4-cell LiPo battery with
one cell that has 2% lower capacity
than the others. All cells start out fully discharged at 3V, ie, the battery is at
12V. It is then charged to 16.8V, which
we would expect to yield 4.2V per cell.
However, since the lower capacity cell
will charge faster, it may have reached
4.3V while the other cells are all at
4.166V. 4.3V + 4.166V x 3 = 16.8V, so
the charger can’t tell the difference.
This cell has now been over-charged
and this could lower its capacity further, to say 3% below the rest. Despite its lower capacity, it has a higher charge state than the other cells, so
after discharge the voltages may be
equal again. But eventually its capacity
could drop so much that it also starts
discharging further than the other cells
each cycle, accelerating the damage.
The simple solution is to monitor
siliconchip.com.au
E
S
G
+
B
3.90V
C
D
S
G
CHARGER
(EXTERNAL)
CHARGE
PUMP
3.90V
4 +IN
D
S
G
INSTRUMENT.
AMPLIFIER
3.92V
D
D
7
OUT
1 –IN
3.90V
G
S
DISCHG.1
DISCHG.2
DISCHG.3
DISCHG.4
CELL SELECT
ADC
3.92V
MICROCONTROLLER
PWM
ON/OFF
Fig.1: a simplified circuit showing the general principle of cell balancer
operation. We’re showing four cells but our balancer will work with up to
eight. Mosfets are connected across each cell, to divert some of the charge
current if that cell’s voltage rises higher than the others. Analog switching,
driven by a microcontroller, allows each cell to be connected across the
inputs of an instrumentation amplifier, so the micro can measure that
cell’s voltage. A charge pump is used to provide sufficient voltage for the
instrumentation amplifier to operate, while a transistor allows its supply to
be switched off when it isn’t being used.
the voltage of each cell during charging and shunt current around those
cells which have a higher voltage than
the others. This reduces the charge delivered to lower capacity cells, so they
all reach the correct charge termination voltage simultaneously. This not
only prevents weak cells from being
over-charged but also stops strong cells
from being under-charged.
Arguably, it’s a good idea to monitor and balance cell voltages during
discharge too, however if balancing
occurs during charging, this should
hopefully keep the cells healthy and
they will discharge at a more or less
equal rate. Serious imbalances normally take multiple charge/discharge
cycles to build up, so regular cell balancing during charging is thought to
be sufficient.
However, should you wish to balance a battery pack while it’s being
discharged, our unit can do that too.
It can be constantly active, drawing
very little current until an imbalance
is detected, at which point it “wakes
up” and attempts to rectify it.
Our cell balancer
The concept of a cell balancer is
quite simple. It periodically checks
the voltage of all cells. If one cell has
siliconchip.com.au
a significantly higher voltage than the
others, some of the charge current is
shunted around it or if the battery is
not currently being charged, it is discharged slightly. This reduces its voltage back in line with the others. This
process is continuous so that as soon
as any cell’s voltage starts rising above
the others, it is brought back in line.
Block diagram
The basic principle is shown in
the simplified circuit of Fig.1, drawn
with a 4-cell battery. Blue arrows show
the flow of current from the charger
through the battery. The second cell
has a higher voltage than the others,
so the microcontroller enables the corresponding Mosfet to divert some of
the charge current around it.
There are some complications to this
approach. Cell voltages will need to be
measured accurately so that small imbalances can be detected before they
become significant. Ideally, inter-cell
error should be around 10mV or less.
This will prevent unnecessary shunting/discharging of the cells due to
measurement error. In the worst case,
if there is a bias in the way the balancer measures cell voltages, it could
actually imbalance an already balanced pack!
Also, if the balancer is to be left
connected to the battery pack (which,
in fixed installations, it would be), it
needs to have negligible drain when
the battery is not being charged or
balanced. Ideally, it should be able
to detect when charging is occurring
and switch off for the rest of the time.
It also needs to be able to shunt a
sufficiently large percentage of the
charge current to be able to “keep up”
with the rate at which cell imbalance
can occur, without this resulting in excessive dissipation which could cause
undesired heating of the balancer or
the battery.
It should also ideally suit a wide
range of battery types, from two cells
or more and including all the different chemistries that may require balancing.
In order to accurately assess the difference in cell voltages, we’ve avoided
using a voltage divider. If we had simply connected each cell to a micro’s
ADC inputs with its own divider, it
would be difficult to assure cell-to-cell
accuracy. And if we used dividers after some sort of analog switching arrangement, they would have to be very
accurate to keep the common mode
rejection ratio (CMRR) high enough.
Independent cell measurement
Instead, we are using analog switches to connect one cell at a time to an
instrumentation amplifier. This is effectively a differential op amp with a
very high input impedance and a very
high CMRR. These both contribute to
providing very good differential voltage sensing accuracy. Its output is the
voltage of the selected cell and this is
then fed to the ADC input of a microcontroller.
The micro we have chosen is a
PIC16LF1709, running at 3.3V. This
has a 10-bit ADC which is sufficient
to sense cell voltages with a resolution of less than 5mV or even better
with averaging. It’s also capable of an
ultra-low-power sleep mode, to minimise current drain when balancing is
not occurring. To this end, it has been
teamed up with an ultra-low quiescent
current regulator and it can switch
power to the instrumentation amplifier off when it isn’t being used.
Current is shunted around a cell
during charging, or the cell is partially
discharged, by switching on a Mosfet
connected across the cell with a pair
of current-limiting resistors. These
March 2016 73
74 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.2: the complete Cell Balancer circuit. Cell voltages at CON1 are connected to instrumentation amplifier IC4 by highvoltage analog switches IC1 and IC2, then to microcontroller IC3’s AN11 analog input. IC3 can then switch on one of
Mosfets Q5-Q11 which in turn activate Mosfets Q1a-Q3b or Q4 to shunt current around or discharge the cell with the
highest voltage. The bottom-most cell is shunted directly by Mosfet Q12. IC3’s pin 11 output drives a charge pump to
boost IC4’s supply so it can operate over the entire battery voltage range.
siliconchip.com.au
March 2016 75
Parts List
1 double-sided PCB, code
11111151, 69 x 35.5mm
1 3-way to 9-way pin header,
2.54mm pitch, straight or right
angle to suit battery pack
(CON1)
1 3-way pin header, 2.54mm
pitch, with optional jumper
shunt (CON2)
1 5-way pin header, 2.54mm pitch,
straight or right angle (CON3,
optional, for ICSP)
1 100mm length of heatshrink
tubing, 50mm diameter
(optional)
3216/1206 (LED1)
1 high-brightness green LED, SMD
3216/1206 (LED2)
3 DMP3085 dual 30V P-channel
Mosfets, SOIC-8 (Q1-Q3)
1 DMP2215 20V P-channel Mosfet,
SOT-23 (Q4)
9 BSS138 logic level N-channel
Mosfets, SOT-23 (Q5-Q13)
1 BC856 PNP transistor, SOT-23
(Q14)
8 BAT54CFILM dual 40V Schottky
diodes, SOT-23 (D1-D8)
1 BAT54SFILM dual 40V Schottky
diode, SOT-23 (D9)
Semiconductors
2 DG409DY quad high-voltage
CMOS switches, SOIC-16
(IC1,IC2)
1 PIC16LF1709-I/SO 8-bit
microcontroller programmed with
1111115A.hex, SOIC-20 (IC3)
1 AD8226BRZ single supply
instrumentation amplifier,
SOIC-8 (IC4)
1 RT9058-33GV 3.3V (36V in)
100mA low-dropout, low-IQ
regulator, SOT-23 (REG1)
1 high-brightness red LED, SMD
Capacitors (SMD 3216/1206, X5R/X7R)
8 1µF 50V
2 10nF 50V
Mosfets are controlled by individual
output pins on the microcontroller.
Circuit description
The full circuit of the cell balancer
is shown in Fig.2. The battery balance
connector is usually a 2.54mm-pitch
JST type which plugs into CON1 with
the negative-most terminal to pin 9, as
shown. Between two and eight cells
are connected and with fewer than
eight cells, some pins will not connected.
The terminals of CON1 are wired
directly to the inputs of two dual 4-to1 multiplexer ICs, IC1 & IC2. These
DG409s will tolerate up to 44V and
have a maximum on-resistance of
100Ω. They are wired so that, depending on the state of their control input
pins (A0, A1 and EN), one cell at a time
can be connected to the inverting and
non-inverting inputs of instrumentation amplifier IC4 (pins 1 & 4).
For example, if A0 and A1 are low
(0V) and the enable pin of IC1 is high,
pin 1 of CON1 is connected to pin 4 of
IC4 while pin 2 of CON1 is connected
76 Silicon Chip
Resistors (SMD 3216/1206, 1%, ¼W)
1 3.3MΩ*
3 10kΩ
1 1MΩ
2 1kΩ
10 47kΩ
1 47Ω
1 22kΩ
9 10Ω 0.5W**
2 10kW ¼W through-hole resistor
* change to set balance start voltage
threshold
** 4.7Ω ½W preferred for use with
NiMH/Nicad
to pin 1 of IC4. Therefore, the voltage
across the top-most cell of the battery
(assuming it has eight) appears across
IC4’s inputs. IC4 is configured for unity
gain, with no resistor between pins 2
& 3. Thus, the difference between the
voltage at either end of the selected
cell appears at output pin 7.
This is fed to analog input AN11
(pin 12) of the PIC16LF1709 microcontroller via a 10kΩ/22kΩ resistive
divider, with a 10nF capacitor connected across the bottom leg to act as
a noise filter. The divider ensures that
even with a fully-charged lithium-ion
or lithium polymer battery, with a cell
voltage of up to say 4.3V, no more than
2.96V will be fed to IC3 and this is well
below its 3.3V supply, which also acts
as the ADC reference voltage.
So basically, the micro can measure
the voltage across each cell by controlling the state of its output pins 13/RB4
(to A0), 14/RC2 (to A1), 15/RC1 (to IC2
EN) and 16/RC0 (to IC1 EN). Because
it uses the same circuitry in each case,
errors should be consistent, making
for accurate cell voltage comparisons.
IC4 has a CMRR of at least 90dB with
unity gain, so the error due to absolute
cell voltage variation is tiny – with
30V between the bottom and top cell
voltages, the resulting error will be
less than 1mV. Besides noise, the other
source of error is variation in the on-resistance between the analog switches
in IC1 and IC2. However, since IC4 has
an extremely high input impedance of
around 400MΩ, this error will also be
negligible; less than 10µV.
Cell balancing
During charging, microcontroller IC3
scans the cells about once per second,
to determine if there is a significant
difference in their voltages. If there is,
it switches on one of Q1a-Q3b, Q4 or
Q12 to shunt some current around it,
reducing that cell’s charge rate.
One of these Mosfets is connected
across each cell, with a 10Ω series resistor at either end (the bottom cell is
slightly different). Many of these resistors are shared, to cut down on the
component count, meaning normally
only one Mosfet will switch on at a
time, to keep dissipation within component limits.
The bottom-most cell is discharged
by N-channel Mosfet Q12. Its gate is
driven directly from output pin 10
(RB7) of micro IC3 and when that line
goes high, it sinks current from the
positive terminal of this cell through a
pair of series-connected 10Ω resistors
to ground. Assuming this is a fullycharged Li-Po cell at around 4.2V, the
shunt current is 4.2V ÷ 20Ω = 210mA.
If the battery is being charged at,
say 5A, this means that 4.2% of the
charge current will be shunted around
this cell, so it will charge more slowly than the others and eventually the
voltages will re-balance. If charging is
not occurring then this cell will simply discharge at a rate of 210mA, until its voltage has been reduced to be
in line with the other cells.
The other seven cells (or however
many are present) are discharged by
one of P-channel Mosfets Q1-Q4. Six
of these are part of DMP3085 dual
Mosfets while the seventh is a single
DMP2215 Mosfet. Each is normally
held off by a 47kΩ resistor between its
gate and source terminal, and switched
on when the gate is pulled to ground
by one of Q5-Q11, which are smallsignal N-channel Mosfets.
Like Q12, these are driven directly
from the outputs of micro IC3, from
siliconchip.com.au
pins 2-9. These are logic-level Mosfets
and require less than 2V at the gate to
sink more than 100mA. Q5-Q11, in
combination with the gate pull-up resistors, effectively form level shifters
to provide the different voltage levels
to drive the gates of Q1-Q4.
The DMP3085 Mosfets used have a
maximum gate-source voltage of 30V,
so Q2 and Q3 require no gate voltage
limiting. Q4 does not require gate voltage limiting either as it’s connected
across the second-from-bottom cell
and so its source will never be more
than 9V above ground. However, for
Q1a and Q1b, two extra 47kΩ resistors
are connected between the drains of
Q5/Q6 and their gates to reduce the
gate drive voltage to a maximum of
-20V.
The discharge Mosfets do not need
to be switched quickly, so the relatively high-value 47kΩ resistors do not interfere with their function.
Power supply
REG1 is fed the full battery voltage
via one of dual Schottky diodes D1-D4.
A 47Ω filter/dropper resistor reduces
dissipation in REG1, an SMD 3.3V lowdropout linear regulator, while also filtering out any hash from the charger or
spikes from discharge pulses.
The 3.3V rail supplies microcontroller IC3 and is also used as a reference
voltage for its ADC, as stated earlier.
The VBAT rail from the cathodes of
D1-D4 also powers multiplexers IC1
and IC2 via series Schottky diodes D5
and D6. These diodes provide protection for IC1 and IC2 against over-voltage at their inputs, since their internal
clamp diodes will automatically boost
the supply if this happens (and D5/D6
would become reverse-biased). Normally this is not an issue but when a
battery is initially plugged in, not all
of its pins may make contact at the
same time, so we’re protecting these
ICs as per the suggested arrangement
in the data sheet.
The power supply for IC4 is somewhat more complex. To avoid draining
the battery when it isn’t being charged
or balanced, micro IC3 switches off IC4
using PNP transistor Q14. To switch
Q14 on, IC3 drives its RB6 output high
(pin 11), which charges N-channel
Mosfet Q13’s gate via an RC filter. Q13
then sinks current from Q14’s base via
a 10kΩ current-limiting resistor, turning it on and allowing current to flow
to IC4’s supply pin via D7.
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.3: operation of the charge pump which supplies IC4. Initially, IC4’s supply
(yellow) is below the battery voltage (green) due to the two Schottky diodes and
one PNP transistor its supply current must pass through. Once the charge pump
begins operation, it quickly climbs above the battery voltage, eventually settling
about 4V higher after 8ms or so. The micro then quickly takes the measurement
using its ADC before the supply voltage drops.
But that isn’t the end of the story
because while IC4 can handle input
voltages down to its negative rail (ie,
GND), the inputs must remain below
its positive rail for correct operation.
The voltage between the positive-most
input and the positive supply rail must
be at least 1V plus half the output voltage to remain in the common-mode operating range, which in our case means
we need a “headroom” of around 3.1V
(1V + 4.2V ÷ 2).
The forward voltage of D1-D4 & D7
means that normally IC4’s supply will
be around 0.6V below the positivemost battery terminal, so we need to
boost its supply by 3.1V + 0.6V = at
least 3.7V to correctly sense the top
cell voltage.
So, before measuring the voltage of
the top-most cell, after RB6 is brought
high and the 1µF capacitor at Q13’s
gate is fully charged, IC3 pulses its
RB6 output around 50 times before
taking the first measurement, with a
frequency of around 5kHz. This drives
a charge pump which increases IC4’s
supply voltage to about 4V above the
battery voltage, allowing it to properly
measure the voltage of the top cell(s).
Fig.3 shows how the supply voltage
to IC4 rises during this period, from a
little below the 20V battery voltage in
this example to around 24V.
It works as follows: when RB6 goes
low, 1µF capacitor C1 charges from
the battery supply via Q14 and D8,
to around 0.75V less than the battery
(point “a”, Fig.2). When RB6 goes high
again, point “a” increases by about
3.3V, to around 2.5V above the battery
voltage. C2 is then charged to slightly
less than this (at point “b”), via one
half of dual series Schottky diode D9.
When RB6 next goes low, C3 charges
to around 2V above the battery voltage
via the second half of D9 (point “c”).
When RB6 goes high again, point “c”
is boosted to around 4V above the battery voltage and current flows through
the lower half of dual Schottky diode
D7, forming IC4’s supply. This drops a
little during RB6’s off-time but remains
sufficiently high to complete several
ADC conversions.
By starting with Q13’s gate at 3.3V
and keeping the duty cycle relatively
high, Q13 is prevented from switching
off before the charge pump has done
its work, despite the fact that RB6 is
being modulated.
Balance current
The 10Ω resistors have been chosen
March 2016 77
Q14
47Ω
IC4 1 µF 1 µF
D8
ICSP1 µF
D9
47k
1 µF10k D7
REG1
10nF
10nF22k
10k 1 µF
1
Q13
CON1
−
IC2
9x 10 Ω ½W
Cell Balancer RevC
LED2
CON3 1 µF
1 µF 10k
IC3
PIC16LF1709
Q4
DMP2215
1
LED1
K
A
1 µF
D5
Q3
Q6
2x 1k
AD
8226
D4
1
Q2
Q5
1
DG409
D3 1
1
1M
Q12 Q11 Q10 Q9 Q8 Q7
D2
BATTERY
DG409
CON2
11111151
3.3M
GND
CELL1
D6
EN
9x 47k
+
IC1
1
D1 1
Q1
Fig.4: all SMD components are mounted on the top of the double-sided PCB. The pin headers can be straight or rightangle types and can be fitted on either side. Take care with the orientation of IC1-IC4, Q1-Q3, LED1 & LED2. The other
components are either non-polarised or their orientation is fairly obvious. Note: photo shows prototype PCB assembly.
to limit current to a safe level with
lithium-based rechargeable cells. For
NiMH/Nicad, since the cell voltage is
substantially lower (less than half),
ideally 4.7Ω 0.5W resistors should be
substituted. The unit will still operate with 10Ω resistors but the shunt
current will be below 100mA and this
may be insufficient to keep the cells
balanced, depending on the charge
current.
Note though that 4.7Ω is too low for
use with Li-ion, LiPo and LiFePO4 batteries as they would dissipate nearly
1W each ((4.3V ÷ 2)2 ÷ 4.7Ω).
Software operation
The first thing that the software
does, after setting up the input and
output pins, is to determine the number of cells in the battery by measuring
the voltage of each one and checking
that it is above a minimum threshold.
It expects to find a contiguous set of
at least two cells starting from the bottom; otherwise, it flashes red LED1,
waits a little while, then checks again.
Once a valid battery has been detected,
normal operation begins.
When checking for the presence of
a cell, the corresponding shunt/discharge Mosfet is switched on briefly
to remove any stray charge that may
be present, which could give a false
reading.
The main loop checks the voltage
on pin 17 and goes into a sleep mode
if it is below the 0.95V threshold (corresponding to a 4.085V trigger threshold with the values shown in Figs.1 &
3). After spending some time in low
power sleep mode, the watchdog timer
wakes the chip up and the pin 17 voltage is checked again.
Assuming pin 17 is at least 0.95V,
the software switches on power to IC4,
waits for its bypass capacitor to charge,
then initiates the charge pump to bring
78 Silicon Chip
its supply voltage up. Once that’s complete it quickly scans the cells, from
the highest to the lowest, measuring
the voltages and storing them. It then
makes a decision about whether to
shunt/discharge any cells. If they’re
all basically equal, it ceases balancing
and goes back to the main loop.
If balancing starts, the cell with the
highest voltage is shunted/discharged.
If there is a tie then they are handled
in a round-robin fashion to balance the
shunt current evenly. Each time, after a
few seconds of shunting/discharging,
the cell voltages are re-checked and a
new decision is made.
Balance initiation
You can connect an external signal
to pin 2 of CON2 to initiate balancing;
for example, you could connect an output from your battery charger that goes
high (to at least 4.5V) during charging.
For a lower threshold, reduce the value
of the 3.3MΩ resistor. For example, to
suit a 3.3V signal, use a 1MΩ resistor,
setting the threshold to 1.9V.
Alternatively, you can short out
pins 1 & 2 of CON2, eg, with a jumper shunt. Balancing then starts whenever the bottom-most cell of the pack
exceeds 4.1V. This voltage was chosen
so that when a Li-ion or Li-Po battery
is approaching full charge, balancing
will begin but will cease once the battery has been discharged below approximately 90% of full charge. This
prevents unnecessary battery drain if
the cells become imbalanced during
discharge.
There’s no inherent reason why
cells can not be balanced during discharge; in fact, arguably this is a good
idea. However, it will increase battery
current drain slightly and may reduce
shelf-life after charging. It may also trigger low-battery cut-out on the powered
device earlier. However, this could be
a good thing as it will prevent any single cell from being over-discharged.
The balance initiation threshold can
also be changed by selecting a different value for the 3.3MΩ resistor. Simply take the desired cut-off voltage,
divide by 0.95, subtract one and pick
the nearest resistor value in megohms.
This will be necessary for different battery chemistries (eg, NiMH).
Construction
All components are fitted to one side
of the PCB, with the possible exception
of the headers, depending on your requirements. Use the PCB overlay diagram, Fig.4, as a guide for assembly.
Start by fitting the ICs. The simplest
method is to apply a little solder to
one of the pads, then heat that solder
while sliding the IC into place. Once
you’ve done that, check carefully that
pin 1 is orientated correctly, which is
usually indicated by a divot or dot in
the corner.
Failing that, look for a bevelled edge
on the IC package. Then check that all
the pins are correctly centred over their
pads. If not, reheat the initial solder
joint and nudge the IC into place. You
can then solder the remaining pins and,
finally, refresh the initial solder joint.
Follow with Mosfets Q1-Q3 which
are in similar packages to IC4. Next,
install all the components in SOT-23
packages which includes all the diodes, the remaining Mosfets and bipolar transistor Q14, as well as REG1.
A similar method can be used, where
one pin is tacked down before the other
two are soldered and the initial joint
refreshed. Be careful not to get any of
these parts mixed up as they all look
very similar.
Follow with the resistors and capacitors using a similar technique.
The resistors will have an abbreviated
code printed on the top showing the
siliconchip.com.au
value, eg, 223 for 22kΩ (22 x 103). The
capacitors will be unmarked although
you will probably be able to pick them
apart as the 1µF types should be physically larger. If you’re planning on using
4.7Ω resistors rather than 10Ω, keep
that in mind.
That just leaves two SMDs, both
LEDs. You will need to determine
which end is the cathode. This is often
marked on the package with a green
dot, however we’ve seen LEDs which
mark the anode with a green dot too,
so it’s safest to check. Generally, this
can be done with a DMM set on diode
test mode. Probe each end of the LED
with the leads. If it lights up, the red
lead is connected to the anode and the
black to the cathode. If not, try flipping
the LED around.
Once you’ve worked out which end
is the cathode (and also revealed the
colour), solder it in place. Note that
LED1 is red and LED2 is green and that
the cathode (indicated with a K) goes
towards the righthand edge of the PCB.
Battery connector CON1 can be soldered to either side of the PCB and
you can use a straight or right-angle
header. We used a right-angle header
on the top of the board to minimise the
overall thickness of the unit. You may
wish to use a header with fewer than
nine pins, to suit your battery connector, as this will make it easier to plug
in. However, you could just solder in
a 9-pin header to suit any battery pack
with 2-8 cells.
CON3 can be omitted if your microcontroller is already programmed.
We used a right-angle programming
header, again to minimise thickness.
For CON2, we used a straight header as we simply fitted a jumper shunt
so that balancing would begin automatically once the battery reached a
sufficient cell voltage. However, you
could simply fit a wire link between
“EN” and “CELL1” if desired. Alternatively, connect a pair of wires between GND and EN, with or without
the pin header.
Note that, while it would be possible
to leave out some components if you
do not need to handle batteries with
more than six cells, we’ll leave it to
individual constructors to figure out
which ones can be omitted.
Usage
If IC3 has not already been programmed, download the hex file from
the SILICON CHIP website (free for subsiliconchip.com.au
scribers). Program the chip using a
PICkit 3 or similar. You can use the
PICkit 3 to power IC3 but be careful
not to exceed its 3.6V maximum supply rating.
Ideally, it’s a good idea to do some
basic checks before connecting a battery. If you have a current-limited
bench supply, set it to 12-24V at 10mA
and connect it between pins 1 & 9 of
CON1, with the negative terminal to
pin 9. Once the on-board capacitors
charge, the current drain should drop
to just a few milliamps and the red
LED should flash, indicating a battery
is not detected.
If you don’t have a bench supply,
you can use any DC source with a series resistor of say 470Ω 0.5W for ~12V
or 1kΩ 0.5W for ~24V.
Assuming all is OK, connect the battery, taking care to orientate the plug
correctly as the header is not polarised. In theory, the unit should survive a reversed supply connection,
at least in the short term, but the 10Ω
resistors could potentially overheat as
the parasitic diodes in Mosfets Q1-Q4
will conduct.
After a couple of seconds you
should see the green LED flash once
for each cell in the battery. If you have
joined EN and CELL1 on CON2, depending on the battery voltage, the unit
may then begin the balancing operation. Otherwise, it will go into sleep
mode and both LEDs will remain off.
If driving the EN pin externally, wire
this up to your charger so that it will
be driven high during charging. You
can then switch on the charger and
check that the red and green LEDs illuminate together briefly, to indicate
that the unit has “woken up”. If the
battery needs balancing, you will see
further flashes.
When balancing occurs, green LED2
will flash rapidly and then switch off.
The number of flashes indicates which
cell is being shunted/discharged. Once
the cells have been balanced, green
LED2 will be switched on for around
one second, then switch off.
Error indication
If an error condition is detected (eg,
an unexpected low cell voltage), red
LED1 will flash rapidly. If the EN pin
drops below 0.95V while balancing is
still active, red LED1 will switch on for
around one second and then the unit
will go back into sleep mode until the
SC
EN pin voltage rises again.
MISS THIS ONE?
CLASSIC
Published in Feb 2013
DAC
Make just about any DVD or even CD
player sound better by using this highperformance Digital to Analog Converter!
It has three TOSLINK inputs, three
SP/DIF inputs, USB audio inputs, SD
card playback capability and a built-in
headphone amplifier.
THD is almost unmeasurable at 0.001%
<at> 1kHz and S/N ratio is outstanding at
110dB.
Most parts mount on a single PCB and
the hard-to-get parts (PCB, front and rear
panels, programmed micro, SMD parts
and coloured RCA sockets) are available
from the SILICON CHIP On-Line Shop.
You’ll find the construction details at
siliconchip.com.au/project/classic+dac
PCBs, micro etc available from On-Line Shop
Where do you
get those
HARD-TO-GET
PARTS?
Many of the components used in
SILICON CHIP projects are cutting-edge
technology and not worth your normal
parts suppliers either sourcing or
stocking in relatively low quantities.
Where we can, the SILICON CHIP On-Line
Shop stocks those hard-to-get parts,
along with PCBs, programmed micros,
panels and all the other bits and
pieces to enable you to complete your
SILICON CHIP project.
SILICON CHIP
On-Line SHOP
www.siliconchip.com.au/shop
March 2016 79
$ave money: replace failed
batteries in emergency lights
Recently a building owner I know had a problem
by
with his emergency lights – you know the ones,
ROSS TESTER
where an exit route is illuminated to show the way
out of the building in a blackout. When power goes
out, an internal battery keeps the light on for some time.
T
here are many different types
of emergency lighting. The ones
we’re talking about here look
just like standard fluoro fittings. In
the electrical trade they’re called luminaires and can be “maintained” and
“non maintained”.
The difference is that maintained
emergency luminaires are “on at all
times” – normally powered by the
mains so they light an exit route 24
hours a day; whereas non-maintained
fixtures only come on when power
fails.
Neither type can be turned off (except by cutting mains power to them,
usually at the switchboard – and even
then they stay lit courtesy of their inbuilt batteries) and in both types those
batteries are continuously “tricklecharged” from the mains supply.
Until quite recently, when LEDs
started to take over, these were fitted with one or two 18W fluoro tubes
which, especially in the case of the
maintained type, had a quite respectable tube life. Fluoro tubes will always
last a lot longer if they’re not subjected
to the rigours of frequent starting.
Of course, the non-maintained types have a tube
life approaching shelf
life because they
are so very seldom on –
They
look
just like
an “ordinary”
fluoro lamp fitting.
80 Silicon Chip
they only light up in a blackout or
other power-cut emergency (eg, a fire).
While on the subject, there are other “emergency” lights often found in
buildings which show either a running man and an arrow, showing the
exit route, or simply the word “EXIT”
if that’s the way out.
Similarly, they’re normally on but
switch over to internal batteries in a
blackout. There’s yet another type with
two tubes, one of which is powered by
the mains and the other which comes
on when the mains fails.
Now back to the building owner’s
quandary: of the half-dozen or so
emergency luminaires in the twentyyear-old building, two had recently
failed their annual “fire” inspection
(required by insurance companies).
It wasn’t so much that the lights
themselves had failed, as they worked
perfectly when power was on and immediately switched over to their inbuilt batteries if the power was cut .
It was the backup battery circuit
which earned the big cross from
the fire inspectors, as they
didn’t power the lights
for the required 90 minutes without mains
power.
Even though one
lasted 45 minutes and
one over an hour, that
wasn’t “up to spec” and
therefore the building insurance
would not be renewed without that
vital certificate.
Never mind the fact that it was only
a two-storey building, and maximum
egress would be (at most) one minute.
Them’s the rules!
He contacted the electrician who
looked after things electric in the
building, asking if the luminaires
could be repaired. He was told that
they were never repaired; simply replaced with a new fitting.
Now I’m not saying that the building
owner was named Scrooge McDuck,
but he baulked at the quoted price of
$295, plus GST. Each!
Fitting involved removing the old
luminaire, mounting a new one, then
re-wiring the mains. But as this also
required mains power being disconnected, it could be quite inconvenient if done during working hours . . .
and even more expensive if it had to
be done after hours.
Being of a somewhat technical
“bent”, our hero reasoned that the
backup supply must be a rechargeable battery and would be either a
sealed lead-acid (SLA), nickel-cadmium (Nicad) or (possibly) nickel-metal-hydride (NiMH), presumably with
a simple trickle charger running from
the mains plus an inverter to boost the
voltage back up to power the tubes
when required.
Unless someone wasn’t playing by
Hoyle, such a battery should be significantly less than what the electrician quoted.
It was only a matter of a couple of
minutes up a ladder with trusty screwdriver in hand to whip off the emergency light cover and his suspicions
were confirmed – a “stick” of five Csized NiCd batteries, shrink- wrapped
and mounted on a plate, with a quickconnect terminal attaching them to the
charger/inverter.
Indeed, there was even a label attached telling him that it was a 5-cell,
6V, 1000mAh Nicad.
siliconchip.com.au
Who’s dat a
comin’ down
MY driveway?
BUILD THE DRIVEWAY MONITOR –
See SILICON CHIP July/August 2015
Alerts you when any vehicle uses driveway.
PARTS AVAILABLE from the SILICON CHIP
ONLINE SHOP (www.siliconchip.com.au/shop):
While it would
appearDetector
that the
vast majority
of emergency lights use NiCd
PIC16F88I/P
IC (programmed):
...$10.00
batteries, theyPIC12F675I/P
are not all
the same.
Indeed, within
Receiver
IC (programmed):
.$10.00 the same building there
were about half
with a 6V stick,
made up......$10.00
of 5 “C” size Nicads, but the other
Detector/Transmitter
PCB (15105151)
PCBor
(15105152)
half had fourReceiver
“D” size,
4.8V (as.....................$5.00
seen in the photo above). We would hazard
P&P formay
any/all
above parts
(one order)
a guess that there
beofother
variations
on$10.00
the theme. However, when he
asked Battery Business ORDER
if this would
cause
NOW AT any problems, the manager smiled
and said “we can replace
any battery for anything.” Nuff said!
www.siliconchip.com.au/shop
So one night when everyone had
gone home, he turned off the appropriate lighting circuit at the switchboard and removed the cover/diffuser
and the fluoro tubes (which of course
was still lit). He then undid the two
screws which held the Nicad stick in
place. Carefully unplugging the stick
(which was a very simple, ten second
job) he replaced the tube and diffuser,
then turned power back on.
Measuring the output voltage revealed that the voltage was less than
the 7.5 or so volts he would have expected; in fact it was about 5.2V which
does suggest one or more of the cells
was at least a little sick!
Placing the battery on a suitable load
showed that it had dropped markedly even after 15 minutes, so the stick
definitely needed replacing.
A quick search on line revealed that
these batteries were available but quite
a bit more expensive than he expected
– more than $100+. He was hoping for
perhaps half that.
But one thing he did notice was a
company called “Battery Business”
who promised that they can replace
any battery for anything.
He remembered seeing one of their
outlets only a few streets away from
his building – so much the better. They
didn’t quote any prices on line but it
was worth the ask.
So next morning, on the way in, he
called into Battery Business with the
old unit.
siliconchip.com.au
The manager told him that if they
didn’t have it in stock, they’d simply
make up new ones and shrink-wrap
them to the old bases, then weld the
old connectors on. The price? $40 each,
including GST. That made him smile.
It turned out that they didn’t have
any in stock but it only took them a
day to have the replacements made up.
He duly picked them up – and noticed
they even came with a similar label to
the old one!
Fitting the replacement battery to
the emergency light fitting was just as
simple as removing the old one – screw
it in, plug it in, replace the fluoro tubes
and put the cover/diffuser back on.
As he put one of the fluoros in, it instantly came to life, indicating that they
had supplied a charged battery. This
was repeated for the second fitting.
With the power back on, he left them
for a day or so, then after hours turned
the power back off.
And after two hours they were still
lighting the way, so he called the inspector who duly checked them for
himself, passed them as A-OK and issued the insurance certificate.
So for just a few minutes work, both
of the old emergency exit fittings were
brought back to new condition (in fact,
probably better-than-new, because he
replaced all the tubes at the same time
– to be sure, to be sure, etc), saving a
bit of landfill but more importantly for
him, saving several hundred dollars in
the process.
SC
Got a long driveway? Want to know
who is coming to visit? Our driveway
monitor will alert you when any
vehicle enters. You can use it to
sound an alarm, turn on a camera,
lock doors and gates . . . anything!
It will even work up to 200m away!
BUILD THE DRIVEWAY MONITOR –
See SILICON CHIP July/August 2015
PARTS AVAILABLE from SILICON CHIP
ONLINE SHOP (www.siliconchip.com.au/shop):
PIC16F88I/P Detector IC (programmed): ...$10.00
PIC12F675I/P Receiver IC (programmed): .$10.00
Detector/Transmitter PCB (15105151) ......$10.00
Receiver PCB (15105152) .....................$5.00
P&P for any/all of above parts (one order) $10.00
ORDER NOW AT
www.siliconchip.com.au/shop
LOOKING
FOR A
PCB?
PCBs for most recent (>2010)
SILICON CHIP projects are
available from the
SILICON CHIP PartShop
– see the PartShop pages
in this issue or log onto
siliconchip.com.au/shop.
You’ll also find some of
the hard-to-get components
to build your SILICON CHIP
project, back issues,
software, panels, binders,
books, DVDs and much more!
Please note: the SILICON CHIP PartShop
does not sell kits; for these, please
refer to kit supplier’s adverts in this issue.
March 2016 81
Vintage Radio
By Associate Professor Graham Parslow
His Master’s Voice
1939 Model 209
The HMV badge sits in a recess at the
bottom of the dial escutcheon.
cabinet. The speaker is better baffled
than in most sets, so the bass response
is noticeably better than that produced
by other mantel sets and table-top models of the era.
In addition, the treble can be adjusted by the tone control to suit the program material.
Circuit details
Housed in a handsome timber cabinet, HMV’s
Model 209 receiver from 1939 is a dualwave, 5-valve superhet design with excellent
performance. Despite initial appearances, this
unit was relatively straightforward to restore.
The beauty of the timber veneers, the
comprehensive controls and the quality of the sound are what attracts me
to HMV’s Model 209 radio. However,
this particular unit was left neglected
for five years after I originally acquired
it, mainly because it looked like a major task to restore it compared to other
radios in my collection.
In the end, the restoration effort went
smoothly and with few challenges, unlike other projects which I’d figured
would “take no time” at all.
Radios produced during the 1930s
and 1940s were targeted to specific
rooms. Economy priced mantel sets
were intended for kitchens, while a
82 Silicon Chip
range of table-top models (usually
placed on side-tables) and top-of-therange floor standing consoles were designed for use in lounge rooms. The
HMV 209 table-top unit described here
is the electrical twin to the HMV 660
console model that was featured in the
February 2004 issue of SILICON CHIP.
The console model boasted a 12-inch
loudspeaker and weighed 33.6kg, so it
was no lightweight. The Model 209 is
also solidly constructed and tips the
scales at 16.6kg.
All the electrical features of the
Model 660 are duplicated in the Model
209, although a smaller 8-inch electrodynamic loudspeaker is used to fit the
The HMV Model 209 is a dual-wave
(or dual-band) 5-valve superhet design. A 6J8 functions as the converter
stage and this is followed by a 6U7G
IF amplifier. This in turn feeds a 6B8G
stage which functions as a combined
diode detector, AGC diode and audio
amplifier pentode. Its output in turn
feeds a 6V6G audio output stage and
this drives the loudspeaker via transformer T1.
AGC is applied to both the 6J8 converter and 6U7 IF amplifier stages. In
addition, some AGC is applied to the
6B8G audio amplifier stage. As a result,
the output level from the amplifier is
kept relatively constant, regardless of
RF signal level.
The power supply uses a conventional mains transformer. Its high-voltage secondary output is rectified by a
5Y3G and the resulting HT then filtered
by two electrolytic capacitors and the
field winding of the loudspeaker.
The panel on the following pages is
taken directly from a document titled
“His Master’s Voice Service Manual
– Private and Confidential For Trade
Use Only – Models 209/660”. The text
(with minor editing for style) not only
describes how the radio works but
gives a feel for the language and termisiliconchip.com.au
Fig.1: the HMV Model 209 is a fairly conventional 5-valve superhet receiver with an
electrodynamic loudspeaker. The set has three IF transformers – two before the 6U7G
IF amplifier valve and one after it.
Fig.2: this label advised reversing the
Active and Neutral connections inside
the set to see if that reduced the hum.
nology of the time (the sections dealing
with troubleshooting and alignment
have been omitted).
Restoring the Model 209
The accompanying photos show the
dilapidated state of the cabinet and
chassis prior to restoration. The lacquer on the cabinet was peeling quite
badly and the dark highlights required
extensive rubbing back to bare timber.
In addition, the chassis had rusted. On
the other hand, little contamination
had penetrated under the chassis and
the loudspeaker cone was intact.
What was interesting was the paper
debris strewn under the loudspeaker.
It looked like it was the remains of the
sales receipt for the radio.
The first task was to thoroughly
clean the chassis using mineral turpentine then rub back the rust in the most
affected places. The top of the chassis
and the speaker frame were then coated
with grey paint.
siliconchip.com.au
These two photos show the dilapidated condition of the cabinet and the
chassis prior to restoration. Despite its age (around 77 years), only a few
parts required replacement to get it going again.
March 2016 83
HMV Service Manual – Models 209/660
Consumption – 82W
Wave Length Range – 13.9 metres
(21.57 megacycles) to 47 metres (6.38
megacycles). 187.5 metres (1600 kc) to
545 metres (550 kc).
Intermediate frequency – 457.5 kc.
Max. undistorted power output – 4.5
watts.
Loudspeaker – Model 290 uses an
8-inch speaker, the field winding of
which acts as filter choke. DC resistance
of (the) field coil cold is 1800 ohms. DC
resistance of (the) voice coil is 2 ohms.
At 400 cycles, impedance of voice coil
is 2.35 ohms.
Valves – 6J8G. 6U7G, 6B8G, 6V6G,
5Y3G.
Circuit description
This model is a superheterodyne in
which a 6J8G triode-hexode acts as
frequency changer. The oscillator circuit is designed to provide relatively
constant output voltage over the wide
tuning range incorporated in this receiver. The 6J8G is band-pass coupled
to a 6U7G which acts as an IF amplifier
and which is in turn coupled to a 6B8G,
the diodes of which are used as signal
and AVC rectifiers respectively, the signal diode being tapped down one-third
on the secondary of the IF transformer
coupling these two tubes.
The amplifier section of the 6B8G
acts as the first AF stage and is resistance-capacity coupled to the 6V6G output stage. AVC (automatic volume control) is applied to the 6J8G, 6U7G and
6B8G tubes.
The aerial coupling transformer on
the broadcast band is a high efficiency, iron-cored type employing Litz-wire
coils. The IF transformers also use Litzwire coils and high-efficiency iron-dust
cores. The coils are tuned by silver-coated titanium dioxide fixed condensers.
The oscillator circuit padding adjustment is carried out inductively on both
bands by means of adjustable iron cores
in the oscillator coils, while on the shortwave band a certain amount of equalisation of oscillator output at the low frequency end of the band is obtained by
feedback across the 0.00054µF oscillator padding condenser; which feedback
is introduced from the oscillator plate circuit by the 0.01µF condenser connected
to the top side of the padding condenser.
The padding condensers are held to a
tolerance of ±1%.
Inverse feedback is applied to the
complete audio system, through the
The top of the chassis
had rusted, as had the
top of the tuning gang
and the transformer
covers.
84 Silicon Chip
Tone Monitor Control from the secondary of the output transformer to a tap
on the volume control. In this manner,
the whole of the audio system benefits
from the distortion reducing properties
of the negative feedback system. In addition the circuits associated with the
Tone Monitor Control provide selective
feedback varying with frequency, thus
providing control of tonal balance. Furthermore, the degree of feedback varies
with the setting of the volume control in
such a way as to provide the best response for both local and distant reception at all volume levels.
The speaker field winding placed in
the negative HT line is used as a filter choke in conjunction with two 16µF
wet-type electrolytic condensers, one
of which is a regulating type which automatically prevents the rise of voltage
beyond a safe limit during the warmingup period.
Note: it is essential that the positions
of these two condensers in the circuit
shall not be inter-changed. These condensers are mounted on the speaker and are thus protected from damage should the power be accidentally
switched on while the speaker is out of
circuit. A voltage divider is placed across
the field to obtain the required bias for
RF circuits.
Jacks are provided at the back of the
chassis for the connection of an extension speaker. They are in the secondary circuit of the output transformer and
directly in shunt to the voice coil in the
set speaker.
Any speaker having a voice coil impedance between 2.5 and 4 ohms can
be connected to these jacks (the output
transformer on the extension speaker
must, of course, be first removed). An
impedance of 3 ohms at 400 cycles is
recommended and the speaker should
be preferably of the permanent magnet
type. The HMV extension speaker is
specially designed for this purpose
and has, in addition, its own constant
impedance volume control.
The core of the output transformer is internally connected to
the positive HT line to prevent
corrosion troubles.
Band switching is carried
out by means of a single-deck
switch. The oscillator primary
coils are connected in series
and not switched. Capacitive
feedback is applied across the
siliconchip.com.au
padding condenser on the short-wave
band and this is switched by contacts
on the wave-change switch.
The first position of the switch (extreme anti-clockwise) connects the
short-wave and associated components, and the second position the
broadcast circuits. Only the broadcast
band dial lamp circuit is switched, being
cut out when the wave-change switch
is in the short-wave position. See that
when in the broadcast position, both
wave bands are illuminated, while in
the short-wave position, only the shortwave band is illuminated.
Tone Monitor: this is a four-position
switch. The following effects are secured
in the various switch positions:
1st Position (Wide Range): normal bass
response and treble boosted to compensate for side-band attenuation for
highest fidelity.
2nd Position (Normal): normal bass and
small degree of treble cut for normal and
long-distance reception.
3rd Position (Bass): as in “Normal” position, but additional treble cut for reduced
background noise and particularly for
pick-up operation.
4th Position (Speech): boosted treble
response and bass cut for improved intelligibility of speech.
Note: the RF trimmers on this model
are of a plunger type with air dielectric,
and possess exceptionally high stability and efficiency. A special adjusting
tool can be obtained from the factory,
incorporating a box spanner for the condenser lock nut and an adjusting hook
for the plunger.
After loosening the lock nut at the top
of the condenser, the adjusting hook is
inserted in the hole which will be found
in the top of the plunger, which can then
be easily adjusted by moving up or down
as required with a slight rotary movement. When adjustment is completed,
tighten the lock nut securely.
Very little corrosion had penetrated under the chassis and most parts were
still in good condition. Capacitor C11 (labelled) had failed though, while C28
operates at high voltage and was replaced as a precaution.
Author’s comments
(1) The RF trimmers referred to above
are the four metal rods adjacent to the
tuning gang;
(2) Litz wire is designed to reduce the
skin effect and proximity effect losses
in conductors used at frequencies up
to about 1 MHz.
(3) The current use of Hertz (Hz) for
frequency officially replaced “cycles” in
1960 but only became widely accepted
in the 1970s.
siliconchip.com.au
This view shows the chassis after it
had been cleaned and painted to stop
further corrosion.
Everything appeared to be in good
condition under the chassis. However, the original figure-8 mains flex was
still in place, so this was replaced with
3-core mains cable so that the chassis
could be securely earthed.
One point of interest is that HMV
recommended swapping around the
Active and Neutral connections to the
transformer to determine if one set of
March 2016 85
This speaker coil cover from another
HMV radio illustrates how HMV rebadged the Rola speaker used in the
model 209 and other sets.
The two HT electrolytic filter capacitors are located in a box that’s spliced
into the speaker cable. These capacitors had previously been replaced, as
had electrolytic capacitors C11 & C29.
connections generated less hum. This
recommendation is displayed on a
label inside the cabinet (see Fig.2).
The two HT filter electrolytics (C34
& C35) are located in a box spliced into
the speaker cable and had previously
been replaced, as had electrolytic capacitors C11 & C29. No other component replacements were evident and
the under-chassis parts all checked OK.
By contrast, the four 6.3V dial lamps
had all gone dark and checking revealed that they had all gone open circuit. These were replaced and the set
then powered up without the valves in
place while some initial checks were
made. The power consumption remained at a steady 14W and the mains
transformer remained cool.
The valves were then refitted and
my optimism that it would work was
rewarded when the radio was powered up. However, while it sounded
quite reasonable, its 105W power consumption was uncomfortably above
the specified 82W. A quick check with
the power switched off revealed that
the 0.5µF AVC (AGC) bypass capacitor
(C11) was hot. Replacing this immediately reduced the power consumption
to 82W, exactly as specified.
As a precaution, I also replaced ca-
This view shows the front of the chassis and the dial prior to restoration.
Despite its unusual shape, the large dial scale is easy to read.
86 Silicon Chip
pacitor C28 which feeds the audio
signal from the anode of the 6B8 to
the grid of the 6V6 output stage. The
original capacitor was still performing faultlessly but this part operates at
high voltage, so replacing it is a good
idea in order to guard against shortterm failure.
Cabinet restoration
This part of the restoration initially
involved sanding the cabinet back to
bare timber using aluminium oxide
grade 80 abrasive paper. This type of
abrasive is particularly good for this
job, since it doesn’t tend to clog with
the removed debris.
When using coarse abrasive, it is
essential not to cut across the grain.
In addition, a smooth finish relies on
careful sanding of the polyurethane
coatings that are applied, rather than
fine sanding the bare timber.
The black highlights in the cabinet
were painted with acrylic paint after
the first sealing coat. This prevents the
black paint from running into the adjoining wood grain by capillary action.
Multiple coats of Cabot’s CFP clear
gloss finish were then applied, with
sanding between coats. The gloss was a
personal choice; the cabinet originally
had a satin finish.
Another problem was that the original celluloid dial cover had yellowed.
This was replaced with a clear dial
cover fabricated from thermo-moldable PETG plastic.
The performance of this set illustrates the value of buying a quality radio back in 1939. It had few failures
and now, fully restored, continues as
an object of beauty and function. SC
siliconchip.com.au
$UB$CRIBING
MAKE$
$EN$E...
because it saves you dollars!
If you regularly purchase SILICON CHIP over the counter from your newsagent, you can $ave more than 10% by having it
delivered right into your mailbox. Simply take out a subscription – and instead of paying $9.95 per issue ($119.40 for
12 issues), you’ll pay just $8.75 per issue (12 month subscription: $105.00) – and we pay the postage!
How can we do this?
It’s all about economics. Printing enough copies to send out to newsagents, in the hope that they’ll sell, is very
wasteful (and costly!). When readers take out subscriptions, we know exactly how many copies we need to print to
satisfy that demand. That saves us money – so we pass the savings onto our subscribers. It really is that simple!
You REAP THE BENEFIT!
But wait, there’s more! Subscribers also automatically qualify for a 10% discount on any purchases made from
the SILICON CHIP online shop: books, printed circuit boards, specialised components, binders, wall charts – anything
except subscriptions!
So why not take out a subscription?
You can choose from 6 months, 12 months or 24 months – and the longer you go, the bigger the savings.
You can choose the print edition, the online edition or both!
Most people still prefer a magazine they can hold in their hands. That’s a fact. But in this digital age, many
people like to be able to read SILICON CHIP online from wherever they are – anywhere in the world. That’s also a
fact. NOW YOU CAN – either or both. The on-line edition is exactly the same as the printed edition – even the
adverts are included. So you don’t miss out on anything with the on-line edition (flyers and catalogs excepted).
OK, so how do you go about it?
It’s simple: you can order your subscription online, 24 hours a day (siliconchip.com.au/shop and follow the
prompts); you can send us an email with your subscription request and credit card details (silicon<at>siliconchip.
com.au), or you can phone us, Monday-Friday, 9am-4.30pm, on (02) 9939 3295 (international 612 9939 3295).
Don’t put it off any longer: $TART $AVING TODAY with a SILICON CHIP $ub$cription!
siliconchip.com.au
www.siliconchip.com.au
March 2016 87
SILICON
CHIP
.com.au/shop
ONLINESHOP
Looking for a specialised component to build that latest and greatest SILICON CHIP project? Maybe it’s the PCB you’re after?
Or a pre-programmed micro? Or some other hard-to-get “bit”? The chances are they are available direct from the SILICON CHIP ONLINESHOP.
As a service to readers, SILICON CHIP has established the ONLINESHOP. No, we’re not going into opposition with your normal suppliers –
this is a direct response to requests from readers who have found difficulty in obtaining specialised parts such as PCBs & micros.
•
•
•
•
•
PCBs are normally IN STOCK and ready for despatch when that month’s magazine goes on sale (you don’t have to wait for them to be made!).
Even if stock runs out (eg, for high demand), in most cases there will be no longer than a two-week wait.
One low p&p charge: $10 per order, regardless of how many boards or micros you order! (Australia only; overseas clients – email us for a postage quote).
Our PCBs are beautifully made, very high quality fibreglass boards with pre-tinned tracks, silk screen overlays and where applicable, solder masks.
Best of all, those boards with fancy cut-outs or edges are already cut out to the SILICON CHIP specifications – no messy blade work required!
HERE’S HOW TO ORDER:
4 Via the INTERNET (24 hours, 7 days): Log on to our secure website –
siliconchip.com.au, click on “SHOP” and follow the links
4 Via EMAIL (24 hours, 7 days): email silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au – Clearly tell us what you want and include your contact and credit card details
4 Via MAIL (24 hours, 7 days): PO Box 139, Collaroy NSW 2097. Clearly tell us what you want and include your contact and credit card details
4 Via PHONE (9am-5pm EADST, Mon-Fri): Call (02) 9939 3295 (INT 612 9939 3295) – have your order ready, including contact and credit card details!
YES! You can also order or renew your SILICON CHIP subscription via any of these methods as well!
PRE-PROGRAMMED MICROS
Price for any of these micros is just $15.00 each + $10 p&p per order#
As a service to readers, SILICON CHIP ONLINESHOP stocks microcontrollers and microprocessors used in new projects (from 2012 on) and
some selected older projects – pre-programmed and ready to fly!
Some micros from copyrighted and/or contributed projects may not be available.
PIC12F675-I/P
PIC16F1507-I/P
PIC16F88-E/P
PIC16F88-I/P
PIC16LF88-I/P
PIC16LF88-I/SO
PIC16LF1709-I/SO
PIC16F877A-I/P
PIC18F2550-I/SP
PIC18F45K80
PIC18F4550-I/P
UHF Remote Switch (Jan09), Ultrasonic Cleaner (Aug10),
Ultrasonic Anti-fouling (Sep10), Cricket/Frog (Jun12) Do Not Disturb (May13)
IR-to-UHF Converter (Jul13), UHF-to-IR Converter (Jul13)
PC Birdies *2 chips – $15 pair* (Aug13). Driveway Monitor Receiver (July15)
Wideband Oxygen Sensor (Jun-Jul12)
Hi Energy Ignition (Nov/Dec12), Speedo Corrector (Sept13),
Auto Headlight Controller (Oct13) 10A 230V Motor Speed Controller (Feb14)
Projector Speed (Apr11), Vox (Jun11), Ultrasonic Water Tank Level (Sep11),
Quizzical (Oct11) Ultra LD Preamp (Nov11), 10-Channel Remote Control
Receiver (Jun13), Revised 10-Channel Remote Control Receiver (Jul13),
Nicad/NiMH Burp Charger (Mar14) Remote Mains Timer (Nov14),
Driveway Monitor Transmitter (July15) Fingerprint Scanner (Nov15)
MPPT Lighting Charge Controller (Feb16)
Garbage Reminder (Jan13), Bellbird (Dec13)
LED Ladybird (Apr13)
Battery Cell Balancer (Mar16)
6-Digit GPS Clock (May-Jun09), Lab Digital Pot (Jul10)
Semtest (Feb-May12)
Batt Capacity Meter (Jun09), Intelligent Fan Controller (Jul10)
USB Power Monitor (Dec12)
GPS Car Computer (Jan10), GPS Boat Computer (Oct10)
USB MIDIMate (Oct11)
USB Data Logger (Dec10-Feb11)
Digital Spirit Level (Aug11), G-Force Meter (Nov11)
Maximite (Mar11), miniMaximite (Nov11), Colour Maximite (Sept/Oct12),
Touchscreen Audio Recorder (Jun/Jul 14)
PIC32MX170F256B-50I/SP Micromite Mk2 (Jan15) – also includes FREE 47F tantalum capacitor
Micromite LCD Backpack [either version] (Feb 16), Parking Assistant (Mar 16)
PIC32MX170F256B-I/SP
Low Frequency Distortion Analyser (Apr15) Bad Vibes (June 15)
PIC32MX170F256D-501P/T 44-pin Micromite Mk2 (Now with Mk2 Firmware at no extra cost)
PIC32MX250F128B-I/SP
GPS Tracker (Nov13) Micromite ASCII Video Terminal (Jul14)
PIC32MX470F512H-I/PT
Stereo Audio Delay/DSP (Nov13), Stereo Echo/Reverb (Feb 14),
Digital Effects Unit (Oct14)
dsPIC33FJ128GP802-I/SP Digital Audio Signal Generator (Mar-May10), Digital Lighting Controller
(Oct-Dec10), SportSync (May11), Digital Audio Delay (Dec11) Level (Sep11)
Quizzical (Oct11), Ultra-LD Preamp (Nov11), LED Musicolor (Nov12)
dsPIC33FJ64MC802-E/P
Induction Motor Speed Controller (revised) (Aug13)
dsPIC33FJ128GP306-I/PT CLASSiC DAC (Feb-May 13)
ATTiny861
VVA Thermometer/Thermostat (Mar10), Rudder Position Indicator (Jul11)
ATTiny2313
Remote-Controlled Timer (Aug10)
PIC18F14K50
PIC18F27J53-I/SP
PIC18LF14K22
PIC32MX795F512H-80I/PT
When ordering, be sure to nominate BOTH the micro required AND the project for which it must be programmed.
SPECIALISED COMPONENTS, HARD-TO-GET BITS, ETC
CDI – Hard-to-get parts pack: Transformer components (excluding wire),
all ICs, Mosfets, UF4007 diodes, 1F X2 capacitor:
NEW THIS MONTH:
ULTRASONIC PARKING ASSISTANT
$5.00
$7.50
(Mar 16)
$50.00
includes PCB, micro and 2.8-inch touchscreen
(Feb 16)
$60.00
VALVE STEREO PREAMPLIFIER -
(Jan 16)
$30.00
ARDUINO-BASED ECG SHIELD - all SMD components
ULTRA LD Mk 4 - plastic sewing machine bobbin for L2 – pack 2
VOLTAGE/CURRENT/RESISTANCE REFERENCE - all SMD components#
(Oct 15)
$25.00
BATTERY CELL BALANCER
ALL SMD PARTS, including programmed micro
MICROMITE LCD BACKPACK ***** COMPLETE KIT *****
100µH SMD inductor, 3x low-profile 400V capacitors & 0.33Ω resistor
# includes precision resistor. Specify either 1.8V or 2.5V
(Oct 15)
$2.00
(Aug 15)
$12.50
MINI USB SWITCHMODE REGULATOR all SMD components
(July 15) $10.00
BAD VIBES INFRASOUND SNOOPER - TDA1543 16-bit Stereo DAC IC
(Jun 15)
$2.50
BALANCED INPUT ATTENUATOR - all SMD components inc.12 NE5532D ICs, 8 SMD diodes, SMD
caps, polypropylene caps plus all 0.1% resistors (SMD & through-hole)
(May 15)
$65.00
APPLIANCE INSULATION TESTER - 600V logic-level Mosfet. 5 x HV resistors: (Apr15)
ISOLATED HIGH VOLTAGE PROBE - Hard-to-get parts pack:
(Jan15)
$10.00
all ICs, 1N5711 diodes, LED, high-voltage capacitors & resistors:
(Dec 14)
$40.00
CURRAWONG AMPLIFIER Hard-to-get parts pack:
(Mar 16)
(Mar 16)
Clear lid with cutout to suit UB3 Jiffy Box
Ultrasonic Range Sensor PLUS clear lid with cutout to suit UB5 Jiffy Box
P&P – $10 Per order#
$40.00
(Dec 14) $50.00
LM1084IT-ADJ, KCS5603D, 3 x STX0560, 5 x blue 3mm LEDs, 5 x 39F 400V low profile capacitors
ONE-CHIP AMPLIFIER - All SMD parts
(Nov 14) $15.00
DIGITAL EFFECTS UNIT WM8371 DAC IC & SMD Capacitors [Same components
also suit Stereo Echo & Reverb, Feb14 & Dual Channel Audio Delay Nov 14]
AD8038ARZ Video Amplifier ICs (SMD)
(Oct14)
$25.00
For Active Differential Probe (Pack of 3)
(Sept 14) $12.50
44-PIN MICROMITE Complete kit inc PCB, micro etc
MAINS FAN SPEED CONTROLLER - AOT11N60L 600V Mosfet
RGB LED STRIP DRIVER - all SMD parts and BSO150N03 Mosfets,
(Aug14)
$35.00
(May14)
$5.00
does not include micro (see above) nor parts listed as “optional”
(May14)
$20.00
HYBRID BENCH SUPPLY- all SMD parts, 3 x BCM856DS & L2/L3
USB/RS232C ADAPTOR MCP2200 USB/Serial converter IC
(May 14)
$45.00
(Apr14)
$7.50
NICAD/NIMH BURP CHARGER
(Mar14)
$7.50
10A 230V AC MOTOR SPEED CONTROLLER
(Feb14)
$45.00
GPS Tracker MCP16301 SMD regulator IC and 15H inductor
SMD parts for SiDRADIO
(Nov13)
(Oct13)
$5.00
$20.00
1 SPD15P10 P-channel logic Mosfet & 1 IPP230N06L3 N-channel logic Mosfet
40A IGBT, 30A Fast Recovery Diode, IR2125 Driver and NTC Thermistor
Same as LF-UF Upconverter parts but includes 5V relay and BF998 dual-gate Mosfet.
RF Probe All SMD parts
(Aug13)
$5.00
THESE ARE ONLY THE MOST RECENT MICROS AND SPECIALISED COMPONENTS. FOR THE FULL LIST, SEE www.siliconchip.com.au/shop
*All items subect to availability. Prices valid for month of magazine issue only. All prices in Australian dollars and included GST where applicable. # P&P prices are within Australia. O’seas? Please email for a quote
03/16
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARDS
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD TO SUIT PROJECT:
PUBLISHED:
DIGITAL LIGHTING CONTROLLER LED SLAVE
OCT 2011
USB MIDIMATE
OCT 2011
QUIZZICAL QUIZ GAME
OCT 2011
ULTRA-LD MK3 PREAMP & REMOTE VOL CONTROL
NOV 2011
ULTRA-LD MK3 INPUT SWITCHING MODULE
NOV 2011
ULTRA-LD MK3 SWITCH MODULE
NOV 2011
ZENER DIODE TESTER
NOV 2011
MINIMAXIMITE
NOV 2011
ADJUSTABLE REGULATED POWER SUPPLY
DEC 2011
DIGITAL AUDIO DELAY
DEC 2011
DIGITAL AUDIO DELAY Front & Rear Panels
DEC 2011
AM RADIO
JAN 2012
STEREO AUDIO COMPRESSOR
JAN 2012
STEREO AUDIO COMPRESSOR FRONT & REAR PANELS
JAN 2012
3-INPUT AUDIO SELECTOR (SET OF 2 BOARDS)
JAN 2012
CRYSTAL DAC
FEB 2012
SWITCHING REGULATOR
FEB 2012
SEMTEST LOWER BOARD
MAR 2012
SEMTEST UPPER BOARD
MAR 2012
SEMTEST FRONT PANEL
MAR 2012
INTERPLANETARY VOICE
MAR 2012
12/24V 3-STAGE MPPT SOLAR CHARGER REV.A
MAR 2012
SOFT START SUPPRESSOR
APR 2012
RESISTANCE DECADE BOX
APR 2012
RESISTANCE DECADE BOX PANEL/LID
APR 2012
1.5kW INDUCTION MOTOR SPEED CONT. (New V2 PCB) APR (DEC) 2012
HIGH TEMPERATURE THERMOMETER MAIN PCB
MAY 2012
HIGH TEMPERATURE THERMOMETER Front & Rear Panels MAY 2012
MIX-IT! 4 CHANNEL MIXER
JUNE 2012
PIC/AVR PROGRAMMING ADAPTOR BOARD
JUNE 2012
CRAZY CRICKET/FREAKY FROG
JUNE 2012
CAPACITANCE DECADE BOX
JULY 2012
CAPACITANCE DECADE BOX PANEL/LID
JULY 2012
WIDEBAND OXYGEN CONTROLLER MK2
JULY 2012
WIDEBAND OXYGEN CONTROLLER MK2 DISPLAY BOARD JULY 2012
SOFT STARTER FOR POWER TOOLS
JULY 2012
DRIVEWAY SENTRY MK2
AUG 2012
MAINS TIMER
AUG 2012
CURRENT ADAPTOR FOR SCOPES AND DMMS
AUG 2012
USB VIRTUAL INSTRUMENT INTERFACE
SEPT 2012
USB VIRTUAL INSTRUMENT INT. FRONT PANEL
SEPT 2012
BARKING DOG BLASTER
SEPT 2012
COLOUR MAXIMITE
SEPT 2012
SOUND EFFECTS GENERATOR
SEPT 2012
NICK-OFF PROXIMITY ALARM
OCT 2012
DCC REVERSE LOOP CONTROLLER
OCT 2012
LED MUSICOLOUR
NOV 2012
LED MUSICOLOUR Front & Rear Panels
NOV 2012
CLASSIC-D CLASS D AMPLIFIER MODULE
NOV 2012
CLASSIC-D 2 CHANNEL SPEAKER PROTECTOR
NOV 2012
HIGH ENERGY ELECTRONIC IGNITION SYSTEM
DEC 2012
USB POWER MONITOR
DEC 2012
1.5kW INDUCTION MOTOR SPEED CONTROLLER (NEW V2 PCB)DEC 2012
THE CHAMPION PREAMP and 7W AUDIO AMP (one PCB) JAN 2013
GARBAGE/RECYCLING BIN REMINDER
JAN 2013
2.5GHz DIGITAL FREQUENCY METER – MAIN BOARD
JAN 2013
2.5GHz DIGITAL FREQUENCY METER – DISPLAY BOARD
JAN 2013
2.5GHz DIGITAL FREQUENCY METER – FRONT PANEL
JAN 2013
SEISMOGRAPH MK2
FEB 2013
MOBILE PHONE RING EXTENDER
FEB 2013
GPS 1PPS TIMEBASE
FEB 2013
LED TORCH DRIVER
MAR 2013
CLASSiC DAC MAIN PCB
APR 2013
CLASSiC DAC FRONT & REAR PANEL PCBs
APR 2013
GPS USB TIMEBASE
APR 2013
LED LADYBIRD
APR 2013
CLASSiC-D 12V to ±35V DC/DC CONVERTER
MAY 2013
DO NOT DISTURB
MAY 2013
LF/HF UP-CONVERTER
JUN 2013
10-CHANNEL REMOTE CONTROL RECEIVER
JUN 2013
IR-TO-455MHZ UHF TRANSCEIVER
JUN 2013
“LUMP IN COAX” PORTABLE MIXER
JUN 2013
L’IL PULSER MKII TRAIN CONTROLLER
JULY 2013
L’IL PULSER MKII FRONT & REAR PANELS
JULY 2013
REVISED 10 CHANNEL REMOTE CONTROL RECEIVER
JULY 2013
INFRARED TO UHF CONVERTER
JULY 2013
UHF TO INFRARED CONVERTER
JULY 2013
IPOD CHARGER
AUG 2013
PC BIRDIES
AUG 2013
RF DETECTOR PROBE FOR DMMs
AUG 2013
BATTERY LIFESAVER
SEPT 2013
SPEEDO CORRECTOR
SEPT 2013
SiDRADIO (INTEGRATED SDR) Main PCB
OCT 2013
SiDRADIO (INTEGRATED SDR) Front & Rear Panels
OCT 2013
TINY TIM AMPLIFIER (same PCB as Headphone Amp [Sept11])OCT 2013
NOTE: The listings below are for the PCB only – not a full kit. If you want a kit, contact the kit suppliers advertising in this issue.
For more unusual projects where kits are not available, some have specialised components available – see the list opposite.
PCB CODE:
Price:
16110111 $30.00
23110111 $25.00
08110111 $25.00
01111111 $30.00
01111112 $20.00
01111113 $10.00
04111111 $20.00
07111111 $10.00
18112111
$5.00
01212111 $25.00
01212112/3 $20 per set
06101121 $10.00
01201121 $30.00
0120112P1/2 $20.00
01101121/2 $30 per set
01102121 $20.00
18102121
$5.00
04103121 $40.00
04103122 $40.00
04103123 $75.00
08102121 $10.00
14102112 $20.00
10104121 $10.00
04104121 $20.00
04104122 $20.00
10105122 $35.00
21105121 $30.00
21105122/3 $20 per set
01106121 $20.00
24105121 $30.00
08109121 $10.00
04106121 $20.00
04106122 $20.00
05106121 $20.00
05106122 $10.00
10107121 $10.00
03107121 $20.00
10108121 $10.00
04108121 $20.00
24109121 $30.00
24109122 $30.00
25108121 $20.00
07109121 $20.00
09109121 $10.00
03110121
$5.00
09110121 $10.00
16110121 $25.00
16110121 $20 per set
01108121 $30.00
01108122 $10.00
05110121 $10.00
04109121 $10.00
10105122 $35.00
01109121/2 $10.00
19111121 $10.00
04111121 $35.00
04111122 $15.00
04111123 $45.00
21102131 $20.00
12110121 $10.00
04103131 $10.00
16102131
$5.00
01102131 $40.00
01102132/3 $30.00
04104131 $15.00
08103131
$5.00
11104131 $15.00
12104131 $10.00
07106131 $10.00
15106131 $15.00
15106132
$7.50
01106131 $15.00
09107131 $15.00
09107132/3 $20.00/set
15106133 $15.00
15107131
$5.00
15107132 $10.00
14108131
$5.00
08104131 $10.00
04107131 $10.00
11108131
$5.00
05109131 $10.00
06109131 $35.00
06109132/3 $25.00/pr
01309111
$20.00
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD TO SUIT PROJECT:
PUBLISHED:
PCB CODE:
Price:
AUTO CAR HEADLIGHT CONTROLLER
OCT 2013
03111131
$10.00
GPS TRACKER
NOV 2013
05112131
$15.00
STEREO AUDIO DELAY/DSP
NOV 2013
01110131
$15.00
BELLBIRD
DEC 2013
08112131
$10.00
PORTAPAL-D MAIN BOARDS
DEC 2013
01111131-3
$35.00/set
(for CLASSiC-D Amp board and CLASSiC-D DC/DC Converter board refer above [Nov 2012/May 2013])
LED Party Strobe (also suits Hot Wire Cutter [Dec 2010])
JAN 2014
16101141
$7.50
Bass Extender Mk2
JAN 2014
01112131
$15.00
Li’l Pulser Mk2 Revised
JAN 2014
09107134
$15.00
10A 230VAC MOTOR SPEED CONTROLLER
FEB 2014
10102141
$12.50
NICAD/NIMH BURP CHARGER
MAR 2014
14103141
$15.00
RUBIDIUM FREQ. STANDARD BREAKOUT BOARD
APR 2014
04105141
$10.00
USB/RS232C ADAPTOR
APR 2014
07103141
$5.00
MAINS FAN SPEED CONTROLLER
MAY 2014
10104141
$10.00
RGB LED STRIP DRIVER
MAY 2014
16105141
$10.00
HYBRID BENCH SUPPLY
MAY 2014
18104141
$20.00
2-WAY PASSIVE LOUDSPEAKER CROSSOVER
JUN 2014
01205141
$20.00
TOUCHSCREEN AUDIO RECORDER
JUL 2014
01105141
$12.50
THRESHOLD VOLTAGE SWITCH
JUL 2014
99106141
$10.00
MICROMITE ASCII VIDEO TERMINAL
JUL 2014
24107141
$7.50
FREQUENCY COUNTER ADD-ON
JUL 2014
04105141a/b $15.00
VALVE SOUND SIMULATOR PCB
AUG 2014
01106141
$15.00
VALVE SOUND SIMULATOR FRONT PANEL (BLUE)
AUG 2014
01106142
$10.00
TEMPMASTER MK3
AUG 2014
21108141
$15.00
44-PIN MICROMITE
AUG 2014
24108141
$5.00
OPTO-THEREMIN MAIN BOARD
SEP 2014
23108141
$15.00
OPTO-THEREMIN PROXIMITY SENSOR BOARD
SEP 2014
23108142
$5.00
ACTIVE DIFFERENTIAL PROBE BOARDS
SEP 2014
04107141/2 $10/SET
MINI-D AMPLIFIER
SEP 2014
01110141
$5.00
COURTESY LIGHT DELAY
OCT 2014
05109141
$7.50
DIRECT INJECTION (D-I) BOX
OCT 2014
23109141
$5.00
DIGITAL EFFECTS UNIT
OCT 2014
01110131
$15.00
DUAL PHANTOM POWER SUPPLY
NOV 2014
18112141
$10.00
REMOTE MAINS TIMER
NOV 2014
19112141
$10.00
REMOTE MAINS TIMER PANEL/LID (BLUE)
NOV 2014
19112142
$15.00
ONE-CHIP AMPLIFIER
NOV 2014
01109141
$5.00
TDR DONGLE
DEC 2014
04112141
$5.00
MULTISPARK CDI FOR PERFORMANCE VEHICLES
DEC 2014
05112141
$10.00
CURRAWONG STEREO VALVE AMPLIFIER MAIN BOARD
DEC 2014
01111141
$50.00
CURRAWONG REMOTE CONTROL BOARD
DEC 2014
01111144
$5.00
CURRAWONG FRONT & REAR PANELS
DEC 2014
01111142/3 $30/set
CURRAWONG CLEAR ACRYLIC COVER
JAN 2015
- $25.00
ISOLATED HIGH VOLTAGE PROBE
JAN 2015
04108141
$10.00
SPARK ENERGY METER MAIN BOARD
FEB/MAR 2015
05101151
$10.00
SPARK ENERGY ZENER BOARD
FEB/MAR 2015
05101152
$10.00
SPARK ENERGY METER CALIBRATOR BOARD
FEB/MAR 2015
05101153
$5.00
APPLIANCE INSULATION TESTER
APR 2015
04103151
$10.00
APPLIANCE INSULATION TESTER FRONT PANEL
APR 2015
04103152
$10.00
LOW-FREQUENCY DISTORTION ANALYSER
APR 2015
04104151
$5.00
APPLIANCE EARTH LEAKAGE TESTER PCBs (2)
MAY 2015
04203151/2
$15.00
APPLIANCE EARTH LEAKAGE TESTER LID/PANEL
MAY 2015
04203153
$15.00
BALANCED INPUT ATTENUATOR MAIN PCB
MAY 2015
04105151
$15.00
BALANCED INPUT ATTENUATOR FRONT & REAR PANELS
MAY 2015 04105152/3
$20.00
4-OUTPUT UNIVERSAL ADJUSTABLE REGULATOR
MAY 2015
18105151
$5.00
SIGNAL INJECTOR & TRACER
JUNE 2015
04106151
$7.50
PASSIVE RF PROBE
JUNE 2015
04106152
$2.50
SIGNAL INJECTOR & TRACER SHIELD
JUNE 2015
04106153
$5.00
BAD VIBES INFRASOUND SNOOPER
JUNE 2015
04104151
$5.00
CHAMPION + PRE-CHAMPION
JUNE 2015
01109121/2 $7. 50
DRIVEWAY MONITOR TRANSMITTER PCB
JULY 2015
15105151 $10.00
DRIVEWAY MONITOR RECEIVER PCB
JULY 2015
15105152
$5.00
MINI USB SWITCHMODE REGULATOR
JULY 2015
18107151
$2.50
VOLTAGE/RESISTANCE/CURRENT REFERENCE
AUG 2015
04108151
$2.50
LED PARTY STROBE MK2
AUG 2015
16101141
$7.50
ULTRA-LD MK4 200W AMPLIFIER MODULE
SEP 2015
01107151 $15.00
9-CHANNEL REMOTE CONTROL RECEIVER
SEP 2015
1510815 $15.00
MINI USB SWITCHMODE REGULATOR MK2
SEP 2015
18107152
$2.50
2-WAY PASSIVE LOUDSPEAKER CROSSOVER
OCT 2015
01205141 $20.00
ULTRA LD AMPLIFIER POWER SUPPLY
OCT 2015
01109111 $15.00
ARDUINO USB ELECTROCARDIOGRAPH
OCT 2015
07108151
$7.50
FINGERPRINT SCANNER – SET OF TWO PCBS
NOV 2015
03109151/2 $15.00
LOUDSPEAKER PROTECTOR
NOV 2015
01110151 $10.00
LED CLOCK
DEC 2015
19110151 $15.00
SPEECH TIMER
DEC 2015
19111151 $15.00
TURNTABLE STROBE
DEC 2015
04101161
$5.00
CALIBRATED TURNTABLE STROBOSCOPE ETCHED DISC DEC 2015
04101162 $10.00
VALVE STEREO PREAMPLIFIER – PCB
JAN 2016
01101161 $15.00
VALVE STEREO PREAMPLIFIER – CASE PARTS
JAN 2016
01101162 $20.00
QUICKBRAKE BRAKE LIGHT SPEEDUP
JAN 2016
05102161 $15.00
SOLAR MPPT CHARGER & LIGHTING CONTROLLER
FEB/MAR 2016
16101161 $15.00
MICROMITE LCD BACKPACK, 2.4-INCH VERSION
FEB/MAR 2016
07102121
$7.50
MICROMITE LCD BACKPACK, 2.8-INCH VERSION
FEB/MAR 2016
07102122
$7.50
NEW THIS MONTH
BATTERY CELL BALANCER
MAR 2016
11111151
$6.00
DELTA THROTTLE TIMER
MAR 2016
05102161 $15.00
LOOKING FOR TECHNICAL BOOKS? YOU’LL FIND THE COMPLETE LISTING OF ALL BOOKS AVAILABLE IN THE SILICON CHIP ONLINE BOOKSTORE – ON THE “BOOKS & DVDs” PAGES AT SILICONCHIP.COM.AU/SHOP
ASK SILICON CHIP
Got a technical problem? Can’t understand a piece of jargon or some technical principle? Drop us a line
and we’ll answer your question. Send your email to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Shopping for a
Class-D amplifier
I have been shopping for an inexpensive amplifier as part of my DVD
surround sound system. The amplifier of interest is a Class-D amplifier.
Places like eBay and Banggood are selling Class-D amplifier modules for between $13 and $30, with power output
between 3W and 100W per channel.
You can purchase a mono, stereo, 2.1
channel and even a 5.1 channel module. The specifications include a THD
of less than 0.1% and a frequency response between 20Hz and 20kHz.
While I could find a locally-made
suitable power supply for a 2-channel
amplifier, for example a 15-20V 150W
laptop power supply for less than $50,
what if you want a power supply for
a 5.1 channel module? The answer
would require a power supply that
can handle more current than a laptop’s power supply. The other reason
is whether the “heavy duty” power
supplies at 15V-20V purchased from
overseas meet Australia’s technical
standards. (A. P., via email).
• High-power commercial DC sup-
plies are available but a 150W amplifier will probably need more than 20V.
We have published a number of Class-D
power amplifiers, the most recent being a 10W/channel design in September 2014 and a high-power design in
November & December 2012, together
with a suitable power supply circuit.
For a high-power Class-D amplifier,
you really need a loudspeaker protector as a catastrophic fault in the amplifier would destroy the loudspeakers. A suitable protector circuit was
described in these two articles.
Even if you were not going to build
our Class-D amplifier, we would still
strongly recommend a Protector circuit and in that case the best solution
would be the Universal Protector featured in the November 2015 issue.
Gate closer using
a wiper motor
Many years ago, you produced an
article for a gate closer using a windscreen wiper motor. Please advise if I
can purchase a copy of this project or
any other similar one. (F. H., via email).
• You can see a 2-page preview of the
wanted article at www.siliconchip.
com.au/Issue/1997/August/Remote+
Controlled+Gates+For+Your+Home
You can purchase the full digital issue or a print-out of the article itself
from our Online Shop
Wire glue not for high
current connections
I recently located Jaycar’s “Wire
Glue” (Cat. NM2831) product in their
catalog and thought it may be of use
in the simpler projects that I find in
the magazine.
Is the glue designed to be used to
make only temporary repairs to an
electronic device until it can be properly soldered/re-soldered or can it be
used for more substantial and long
term purposes in projects, etc? Could
this glue be used to replace soldering
in any of your existing (simple) projects and might you consider using
this glue as a solder replacement in
any of your future simple projects? (P.
M., Karrabar, NSW).
• Our reading suggests that this glue
would probably be OK for connections
where low resistance or a high current
Fingerprint Access Controller Problems
I built the Fingerprint Access
Controller project from the November 2015 issue and I am having all
manner of problems with it. Firstly,
do you need to have the actual scanner module connected to the controller for it to display anything on
the LCD? I have been over the board
many times. All components are present and accounted for, in their correct positions, and all solder joints
are good.
I have all the correct voltages
where they should be, with and
without the PIC and LCD in place.
I replaced the LCD just in case and
even tried replacing the PIC16F88
with a programmed unit from SILICON CHIP, just in case my PICkit 3
90 Silicon Chip
or computer is faulty. I’ve checked
all tracks on the PCB have continuity and measured all capacitor values and ESR.
If I apply power with the PIC16F88
in its socket, all voltages are correct. I
get two rows of square blocks on the
LCD until I adjust the contrast pot
and then they disappear. If I then remove the power and re-apply it, the
top lefthand character on the LCD
flashes on and then disappears to
reveal a blank LCD. I have also noticed that the backlight is coming on
whilst the PIC is in its socket but not
when it is out.
I am at a loss to explain why all
this is happening unless I need to
have the actual scanner module con-
nected, which I am still waiting to
arrive. Any help would be much appreciated. (P. C., via email).
• The display should show the correct characters once you power up
with the fingerprint module connected. The program within the PIC will
stall if the fingerprint module is not
connected, as it waits for a response
from the module at the beginning of
the program sequence.
Unless there is a response from
the fingerprint module, there will be
no data sent to drive to the display
with characters.
The LCD backlight is switched under control by the PIC so the backlight will not light up with the PIC
out of circuit.
siliconchip.com.au
connection is not required. However,
we don’t know how permanent these
“glue” connections would be.
In summary, if you need to make
a non-critical connection when you
don’t have a soldering iron available
(or maybe you require connection to
some metal, eg, aluminium, which
cannot be easily soldered), then “Wire
Glue” is probably worth trying.
Parts queries for
6-digit LED clock
I am building the High-Visibility
6-Digit LED GPS Clock project as featured in the December 2015 & January
2016 issues of SILICON CHIP. However,
I am having trouble finding a couple
of the parts as the 47-100kΩ LDR and
the 3.3V infrared receiver. I’ve found
several suppliers have 5V infrared receivers but not a 3.3V receiver. In addition, Jaycar have a 48-140kΩ LDR.
Will this suit? (P. C., via email).
• The Altronics Z1611A infrared receiver is rated for operation at 3-5V.
The Jaycar part isn’t (5V only) however it’s possible it will work anyway.
We haven’t tried it.
The specification for a 47-100kΩ
LDR was intended to suggest that an
LDR with a nominal resistance that
overlaps that range should be suitable, hence we expect the Jaycar part
should work fine, especially as the
clock software has automatic calibration for the LDR.
If you use the Jaycar LDR and find
it doesn’t work well (unlikely), you
could always change or shunt the 10kΩ
resistor from the supply rail to compensate, ie, increase its value if using
an LDR with a higher nominal resistance or lower the resistor value for a
lower-value LDR.
Giant LED clock
works well
Just dropping you a quick note to
say thanks for the giant LED clock. I
really enjoyed putting it together. The
software with the supplied PIC from
SILICON CHIP has a few differences as
described in the articles. I note there
are two extra options, “HTAL” and
“GPSLoc” and pushing the show date
button twice shows the day of week.
What do the other two options do?
Further, mine doesn’t show GPS 00
and counting up it just shows flashing 12:00:00 and then after the acquisiliconchip.com.au
How About A Valve RIAA Preamplifier?
With respect to your Valve Pre
amplifier project featured in the
January & February 2016 issues, it
is good to know that Altronics are
going to do a kit. Have you considered designing an RIAA preamplifier
along these lines as well?
Some time ago, I modified one of
your earlier designs that used a separate power supply and two preamp
PCBs (SILICON CHIP, November 2003
& February 2004). It was a little cumbersome but it did work OK.
A design all on one board would
be great. What do you think? (K. C.,
via email).
• It may be feasible to design an
RIAA version of the valve preamplifier but we are concerned that there
may not be enough open-loop gain
to ensure correct equalisation at the
very low bass frequencies. And even
sition time it switches to the correct
time. Just curious; very happy with the
way it is. (M. B., via email).
• The “HTAL” (actually meant to
be “XTAL”) allows the RTCC to be
trimmed to compensate for any error
in the 32.768kHz crystal frequency. If
you are using a GPS unit with a 1PPS
output, this is done automatically, to
avoid the need for the RTCC to be corrected in whole-second steps. We’re
rather proud of this solution actually.
What it does is it slowly decreases the
RTCC “speed” by reducing the crystal
trim value until the 1PPS pulses start
coming before the RTCC tick-over.
It then increases the trim value until the situation reverses and basically
“dithers” the trim to keep the RTCC
and GPS synchronised. You’d never
notice it as it’s only changing tiny fractions of a second but it should avoid
the need to ever actually correct the
time except during DST changes.
If no GPS is fitted, then XTAL trim
can be used to manually adjust the
LED clock to match a known-accurate clock.
The GPSLOC setting is something
we realised would be useful quite late.
We had assumed that the data from the
GPS unit would be unusable until the
GPS unit indicated it had a good fix.
Due to our metal roof and depending
on the weather etc, sometimes we are
not able to get a good fix, so we decided
if there is sufficient open-loop gain,
there will be very little more to provide distortion reduction.
We are also concerned that the
signal-to-noise ratio would be very
poor. The existing valve preamplifier
has an S/N ratio of -105dB with respect to 1V. When referred to a 2mV
signal, that will be reduced by 54dB
to -51dB and that is not allowing for
the almost 20dB boost at low bass
frequencies. On that basis, such a
preamplifier is likely to be unusable.
Yes, we know that there are RIAA
valve preamplifiers to be seen on the
internet but unless they have changes the laws of physics, we cannot see
how they could be satisfactory. If you
want to listen to records via valves,
use a good (SILICON CHIP) RIAA
preamplifier and follow it with the
valve preamplifier or valve amplifier.
to see what would happen if the code
was changed to use the data from the
GPS unit regardless of whether it had
a good fix.
It seemed to give accurate time any
way, although perhaps not quite as
accurate. The GPSLOC setting allows
you to tell the clock to ignore the “fix
good” indicator and just use the data
from the GPS unit as soon as it has
enough information to get the time
(ie, UTC time, latitude and longitude).
Basically, you’d only change this setting if you had trouble getting a reliable GPS fix.
Your clock probably doesn’t show
the “GPS 00” display because the
module doesn’t send much useful data
until it has a good fix – or maybe it
just gets a fix really quickly. Once the
module is “warm” that’s what tends to
happen. With some modules though, if
the signal is poor and it takes a while
to get a fix, it will trigger the GPS progress display.
Switching transistor
question
I have a question about the Giant
LED Clock project. The silk screen is
not in agreement with the circuit diagram or the parts list, regarding what
type of transistor goes where . . . all
very confusing and frustrating. I have
mounted Q1-Q9 as BC337 but the cirMarch 2016 91
Stereo DAC Won’t Handle 96kHz Signals
I recently purchased and built
the High Quality Stereo Digital-toAnalog Converter kit from Altronics in Perth. It is based of the September-November 2009 SILICON CHIP
articles.
I am having some noise problems
with the DAC kit on quiet passages
at the start and end of songs. I am
hearing a rapid quiet popping noise
when using the optical inputs with
a 96kHz or 192kHz sampling rate,
although I think I might have also
heard the sounds when using a coaxial input. The issue seems to be
worse when using a PS3 or PS4 but
on my PC’s optical output, it’s less
of an issue.
These popping sounds do not occur if I put the signal through my
sound card’s S/PDIF input, so I’ve
isolated the issue to the DAC. It also
means that the devices I’m experiencing the issues on don’t cause any
issues on other receivers.
The notes and errata mention
changing the 33pF capacitors at
pins 1 & 2 of the optical receivers
to 100pF. This, however, actually
made things worse for me. Reduccuit specifies BC547, disagreeing with
the parts list (BC337).
I am worried that my board is now
ruined, as to remove nine transistors
without damaging the tracks may be a
tall order. (G. M., via email).
• The circuit diagram and overlay
diagrams published in the December
2015 issues should be followed to
build the clock. If Q1-Q9 have been
fitted as BC337, leave it that way and
just use BC337s throughout. The main
reason for specifying the BC547s was
to save a little money.
Sorry about the confusion. We published errata in the February 2016 issue.
Alternative strobe
disc suggestions
With reference to your white LED
strobe and strobe disc presented in
the December 2015 issue, old turntable AC frequency stroboscopes had
limitations that need not limit a design
based upon a microcontroller.
Since you use a quartz crystal to gen92 Silicon Chip
ing those capacitors’ value seems to
have made some improvement but it
still didn’t resolve the problem completely. I have tested with smaller
capacitors down to 1.5pF but ended
up removing them altogether. It still
has some noise but it is reduced to
the occasional pop.
Is it safe for me to remove these
capacitors? What is their purpose?
Looking at the circuit design, I’m
a bit confused about the implementation of the optical input. I looked
at the data sheet for the Altronics
optical receiver and it shows a sample implementation with a bypass
capacitor and series 47µH inductor
for pin 3, however there is no such
inductor in your particular design.
Should I try adding these inductors?
I note that the CLASSiC DAC design
uses those inductors.
If you have any tips to resolve
the popping sound issue, it would
be very much appreciated. (T. K.,
via email).
• We believe it is safe to remove
those capacitors. The DAC was originally designed to use Jaycar Toslink
receivers which recommended those
erate the timebase, why bother with
multiple strobe patterns and a single
strobe speed when you could easily
generate three accurate strobe speeds
and use a simple single bar set for the
strobe pattern?
With a pushbutton and pull-up
resist
or to re-purpose the GP2 pin,
and eliminating the JP1 jumper, you
could switch the frequencies in software. The spare GP1 pin, for example,
could drive a LED and resistor to flash
a simple pattern to show which strobe
rate was active.
With a 90-bar strobe pattern, for example, wouldn’t generating accurate
flash rates of 50, 67.5 and 117Hz be a
doddle, particularly if the crystal was
3.2768MHz? (K. S., via email).
• There are many ways to produce
a suitable strobe but we wanted to be
able to have a strobe light that was
compatible with existing strobe discs,
and particularly those turntables with
strobe markers arranged around the
rim of the platter.
While a LED could have been used
to indicate different strobe rates select-
capacitors in the data sheet. Presumably they were intended to improve
noise immunity however as you’ve
found, they seem to make matters
worse instead.
We’re not sure how much inductors would help however they might
reduce noise in the power supply.
You could try cutting the supply
tracks and soldering one in series
for each receiver. Unfortunately,
Jaycar seem to have stopped selling
the Toslink receivers we used originally so you may not be able to get
these to try.
Have you tried moving the DAC
away from any sources of electrical
noise? It may also be worth putting
a ferrite sleeve around the power cable to the unit to prevent high frequency interference from coupling
inside. Your problem could be due
to interference from other equipment
or inadequate supply bypassing/filtering for the receiver modules.
You could also try replacing the
bypass capacitors for the optical receivers with higher value ceramic
types, eg, 1µF (ideally X7R dielectric or similar).
ed with a pushbutton, a simple jumper
link that’s either in or out is all that’s
required for 100/120Hz selection.
Design for a 6V CDI
system wanted
I’m looking for a CDI I can build
for an old 1970s Ariel Arrow 2-stroke
motorbike engine. I’ve downloaded an
article and circuit drawings from your
website, based on a 1997 design. My
problem is that the Arrow has a 6V
electrical system, so what modifications would be needed to convert this
to 6V? (S. W., via email).
• Unfortunately, none of our inverter based CDI designs can be easily
changed to 6V operation since the inverter driver ICs will not work at that
low voltage. The “Replacement CDI
For Small Petrol Motors” (SILICON
CHIP, May 2008) may suit your bike
if there is a high-voltage generator included on the bike itself.
A 6V CDI was published in the November 1971 issue of Electronics Australia. Its inverter was a free-running
siliconchip.com.au
HO SE
U
ON SE W E
CH IT TO
IP IN
JA
N
20
16
)
.au
THIS
CHART
m
o
pi .c
h
IC
c
on
t
SIL
a
(or
ic
sil
• Huge A2 size (594 x 420mm)
• Printed on 200gsm photo paper
• Draw on with whiteboard markers
(remove with damp cloth)
• Available flat or folded
will
become as
indispensable as
your multimeter!
How good are you at remembering formulas? If you don’t
use them every day, you’re going to forget them!
In fact, it’s so useful we decided our readers would love to
get one, so we printed a small quantity – just for you!
Things like inductive and capacitive reactance? Series and
parallel L/C frequencies? High and low-pass filter frequencies?
And here it is: printed a whopping A2 size (that’s 420mm
wide and 594mm deep) on beautifully white photographic
paper, ready to hang in your laboratory or workshop.
This incredibly useful reactance, inductance, capacitance
and frequency ready reckoner chart means you don’t have
to remember those formulas – simply project along the
appropriate line until you come to the value required, then
read off the answer on the next axis!
Here at SILICON CHIP, we find this the most incredibly useful
chart ever – we use it all the time when designing or checking
circuits.
If you don’t find it as useful as we do, we’ll be amazed! In
fact, we’ll even give you a money-back guarantee if you don’t!#
Order yours today – while stocks last. Your choice of:
Supplied fold-free (mailed in a protective mailing tube);
or folded to A4 size and sent in the normal post.
But hurry – you won’t believe you have done without it!
#Must be returned post paid in original (ie, unmarked) condition.
Read the feature in January 2016 SILICON CHIP (or view online) to see just how useful this chart will be in your workshop or lab!
NOW AVAILABLE, DIRECT FROM www.siliconchip.com.au/shop:
Flat – (rolled)
and posted in a
secure mailing tube
$2000ea
inc GST & P&P*
Folded –
and posted in a
heavy A4 envelope
$1000ea
inc GST & P&P*
*READERS OUTSIDE AUSTRALIA:
Email us for a price mailed to your country
(specify flat or folded).
ORDER YOURS TODAY – LIMITED QUANTITY AVAILABLE
siliconchip.com.au
March 2016 93
500VA Transformer For CLASSiC-D Amplifier
As a part of our university project,
I recently purchased CLASSiC-D amplifier kit and power supply kit. As
the article says, we need a 300VA, 400-40V toroidal transformer. Can we
use a 500VA 35-0-35V or 40-0-40V
unit? And if we use 35-0-35V, does
only ZD6 need to be changed to 33V
or do we need need to change all the
resistors (RF, R2A, R2B, R3A, R3B,
R4, R5, R6, R7, R8, R9 & R10) and
zener diodes ZD5 & ZD6, as shown
in the table? (J. J., via email).
• Yes, you can use a 500VA transformer. If building a stereo amplifier,
it would allow you to get a continuous output rating of 200W or more
per channel into 4-ohm loads, while
the specified 300VA transformer
would limit you to about 120W
per channel on a continuous basis.
The only disadvantages of using a
500VA transformer are size, weight
and cost.
You certainly could use 35-0-35V
oscillator based on two 2N3055 NPN
transistors driving a pot-core transformer which would now be very difficult to obtain. However, you could possibly produce a suitable transformer,
with suitable primary and secondary
turns, using the transformer core featured in our most recent CDI, in the December 2014 and January 2015 issues.
You can order a reprint of the Electronics Australia CDI article from our
website at www.siliconchip.com.au
Alternatively, you could use a standard (ie, non-CDI) ignition such as our
High-Energy Ignition System in the
November & December 2012. This can
be run at 6V.
Raspberry Pi
set-up hiccup
The Raspberry Pi temperature sensor articles in the January & February
2016 issues are fantastic projects! It
has everything – a fast processor, good
programming capability, WiFi, headless operation, sensor cards and more
– wow! It’s several orders of magnitude
better than a PICAXE.
I bought the WiFi starter pack from
Wiltronics. Initially, the WiFi did not
work but after running the “update”
and “upgrade” commands and reboot94 Silicon Chip
but then you might not be able to
get the rated power. It would come
close, however. If doing this, you
should change ZD6 to 33V, to prevent premature under-voltage cutout.
Because the difference in the DC
supply rails between 35V and 40V
transformers is relatively small
(~55V vs ~48V), you could probably
get away without changing the other
component values. However, doing
so might have some benefits.
We suggest the following:
RF: leave it at 4.3kΩ
R2A,R2B,R3A,R3B: 3.9kΩ 1W
R4: 39kΩ
R5: 2.7kΩ
R6: leave at 6.8kΩ
R7: leave at 8.2kΩ
R8: 2.0kΩ
R9: 6.8kΩ
R10: 680Ω 1W
ZD5: 56V 1W
ZD6: 33V 1W
ing the RPi, it then worked fine.
I am currently stuck on Step 8, “Connect the Sense HAT”. When I run the
sudo pip-3.2 install pillow command I
get this error:
File “/home/pi/build/pillow/setup.py”,
line 516, in build_extensions
(f, f))
ValueError: jpeg is required unless explicitly disabled using --disable-jpeg,
aborting
Then when I run the Python module as per your article I get the following error:
ImportError: No module named PIL
Could you offer any guidance as to
what might be happening? Keep up the
good work. (L. B., Thornleigh, NSW).
• The error message you received
is explained at this link: www.
raspberrypi.org/forums/viewtopic.
php?t=130745&p=875524#p872657
To solve it, run this command:
sudo apt-get install libjpeg-dev
You should then be able to install
Pillow. We didn’t have to do this with
the version of Raspbian we used but
it looks like it may be necessary for
other versions. (Reader feedback: that
did the trick).
Problem with reluctorbased ignition system
I have just found and built the May
1990 High-Energy Ignition for Reluctor Distributors. I have a Toyota distributor, from a Toyota 5 FSE motor.
It has two reluctor coils. I suspect the
top one is for cylinder 1 sensing but
the one below is a mystery to me. The
lower shaft has four poles but the upper one has only one.
I have measured the output of both
upper and lower coils with a DVM and
their outputs seem to be about 300400mV. When I connect these coils
to the ignition module, the LED does
not flash at all. It seems that the LED
and the Darlington Transistor are always on.
What have I done wrong? (M. S.,
via email).
• The reluctor output is too low for
the ignition module to work. The output from the reluctor needs to be several volts rather than 300-400mV.
Generally, a reluctor will deliver up
to 30V peak when the engine is running. Check that you have the correct
wires connected and that they are of
the correct polarity.
Jacob’s Ladder IGBT
gets too hot
I assembled one of your Jacob’s Ladder kits (SILICON CHIP, February 2013)
and it worked fine. However, I soon
burned out the Q1 IGBT. I replaced it
and have noticed that after even a few
seconds of use, it becomes red hot.
The voltage regulator is doing its job
as everything checks out around 5V so
I am unsure as to why this would be
happening. Any ideas or suggestions?
Can the part be substituted for something else? (D. B., via email).
• We suspect that you have the dwell
period set too long. The dwell should
be set to its minimum and then slowly
advanced so there is sufficient sparking for the ladder but without overheating the IGBT.
The dwell is set using VR1. If this
does not change the spark intensity,
check that the trimpot (with the ignition coil disconnected) varies the voltage at pin 18 of IC1 from 0-5V, with
clockwise rotation increasing it.
Finally, check that the IGBT is securely bolted to the case (but is electrically isolated) to ensure effective
heatsinking.
siliconchip.com.au
MARKET CENTRE
Cash in your surplus gear. Advertise it here in SILICON CHIP
Announcing Pioneer Hill Software
FOR SALE
SpectraPLUS 24bit DAQ ADC
spectrogram, t.h.d. and i.m.d. analysis, f.f.t,
acoustic tools, 3D surface plot, sig. gen. etc.
Fully shielded SpecctraDAQ200 ADC/DAC
24bit/192kHz dual channel, Wolfson. AKM
converters … USB3 interface to laptop/PC
As 2ch. 24bit recorder t.h.d. = 0.002%max
see : www.spectraplus.com
Order direct, USA contact : John Pattee
(pioneer<at>spectraplus.com)
Local agent : DSCAPE Melbourne
s/w , h/w package ca. USD $1500
Aus. Distributor : Julian Driscoll CEO
jcdrisc<at>tpg.com.au for support
TEKTRONIX 316 10MHz valve oscilloscope. Excellent condition. In use until
1989, then storage, Sydney. Suit collector/restorer. No probes. Best offer above
$140.00. email kim.hague-smith<at>tpg.
com.au
tronixlabs.com - Australia’s best value
for hobbyist and enthusiast electronics
from adafruit, DFRobot, Freetronics,
Raspberry Pi, Seeedstudio and more,
with same-day shipping.
CRO & BITS for robotics. BWD 1722 Oscilloscope plus manuals. Assorted motors, cogs, solenoids, magnetic clutches
etc removed from photocopier. Free if
able to pick up. NE Victoria.
tevitarobson<at>gmail.com for details.
PCB MANUFACTURE: single to multi
layer. Bare board tested. One-offs to
any quantity. 48 hour service. Artwork
design. Excellent prices. Check out our
specials: www.ldelectronics.com.au
PCBs MADE, ONE OR MANY. Any format, hobbyists welcome. Sesame Electronics Phone 0434 781 191.
sesame<at>sesame.com.au
www.sesame.com.au
PCBs & Micros: SILICON CHIP can sup-
ply PCBs and programmed microcontrollers and other specialist parts for
recent projects and some not so recent
projects: www.siliconchip.com.au or
phone (02) 9939 3295.
LEDs, BRAND NAME and generic
LEDs. Heatsinks, fans, LED drivers,
power supplies, LED ribbon, kits, components, hardware, EL wire. www.ledsales.com.au
KIT ASSEMBLY & REPAIR
VINTAGE RADIO REPAIRS: electrical mechanical fitter with 36 years ex
perience and extensive knowledge of
valve and transistor radios. Professional and reliable repairs. All workmanship guaranteed. $10 inspection fee
plus charges for parts and labour as re-
quired. Labour fees $35 p/h. Pensioner
discounts available on application. Contact Alan on 0425 122 415 or email bigal
radioshack<at>gmail.com
KEITH RIPPON KIT ASSEMBLY &
REPAIR:
* Australia & New Zealand;
* Small production runs.
Phone Keith 0409 662 794.
keith.rippon<at>gmail.com
DAVE THOMPSON (the Serviceman
from SILICON CHIP) is available to help
you with kit assembly, project troubleshooting, general electronics and custom design work. No job too small.
Based in Christchurch, NZ but service
available Australia/NZ wide. Phone
NZ (+64 3) 366 6588 or email dave<at>
davethompson.co.nz
ADVERTISING IN MARKET CENTRE
Classified Ad Rates: $32.00 for up to 20 words plus 95 cents for each additional word. Display ads in Market Centre (minimum 2cm deep, maximum 10cm deep): $82.50 per column centimetre per insertion. All prices include GST.
Closing date: 5 weeks prior to month of sale. To book, email the text to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au and include your
name, address & credit card details, or phone Glyn (02) 9939 3295 or 0431 792 293.
Ask SILICON CHIP
. . . continued from page 94
Dog silencer
overheats
I built the Dog Silencer (SILICON
CHIP, July 1999) from an Oatley Electronics kit but I’m having trouble with
siliconchip.com.au
it. The MTP3055 Mosfets on the output amplifier have 1W 10Ω resistors
on their drains which keep overheating and I can’t see why.
I replaced the Mosfets and disconnected the output transformers so
there is no load and still the resistors
cook. The output transformers get hot
too. It’s a simple circuit and shouldn’t
be a problem so any help you can give
us would be appreciated as the dogs
just keep on barking. (T. D., Perth, WA).
• Try connecting a 1N5819 Schottky
diode across each transformer primary
with the cathode to 12V and the anode
to the junction of the 10Ω resistor and
the transformer winding. The diode
will clamp the back-EMF rather than
the 10Ω resistor via the Mosfet. Also,
the frequency could be adjusted for
March 2016 95
Notes & Errata
Loudspeaker Protector, October
2011 & Universal Loudspeaker Protector, November 2015: both articles
refer to a 70°C thermal cut-out from
Jaycar, Cat. ST3831. This is incorrect, the correct catalog number is
ST3833.
High-Visibility 6-Digit LED GPS
Clock, December 2015-January
2016: two bugs have been identified in the firmware. One causes the
unit to display the incorrect time for
8pm and later when set to 12-hour
mode. The other causes minutes to
be shown as 60 rather than 00 for one
minute if the current time zone has
an offset that is not a whole number of hours.
Firmware v1.2 (revision C) fixes
both problems and is available for
download from our website. Affected users can send their PIC32 chips
back in to be re-programmed if they
are unable to do so themselves.
In addition, in Pt.2, the instruc-
Ask SILICON CHIP
. . . continued from page 94
minimal heat in the 10Ω resistors. A
higher frequency could reduce saturation time in the windings.
USB power injector
for STB HDD
The USB Power Injector featured in
the January 2016 issue has caught my
interest. I am wondering if this simple circuit would be suitable for use
in powering an external HDD (up to
500GB) for a Dick Smith (DSE) Set Top
Advertising Index
tions for gluing the case together
state “The front panel is rotationally
symmetrical so its orientation is not
important . . .”.
While the front panel is rotationally symmetrical, it does not have
mirror symmetry so it is possible to
glue it “flipped” such that the LED
colons will slant in the wrong direction. Please pay attention to this possibility while assembling the case.
Allan Warren Electronics.............. 95
QuickBrake, January 2016: The
voltage applied to the reset pin of
7555 timer IC3 once the timing capacitor has charged may not reach
a sufficient level to release the reset.
To solve this, change the 220kΩ resistor between pin 4 of IC3 and the
5V supply to 82kΩ.
In addition, trimpot VR1 is shown
incorrectly orientated in the circuit
diagram (Fig.1). Clockwise rotation
reduces the resistance and thus reduces sensitivity, as stated in the
text.
Jaycar .............................. IFC,45-52
Box [DSE codes “GH5930” & “GH5944”
– I have one of each and my Dad has
two of the earlier model (the GH5930)].
According to the manuals, it would
appear that both of these units may be
able to handle a USB drive of “up to”
500GB (the GH5944 up to 2TB) with
a supplementary power supply and,
if necessary, reformatted to FAT32.
Would you agree with this proposition? (P. M., via email).
• Yes, the USB power injector should
be suitable for the external hard drive.
Power capability is dependent on the
5V supply so it needs to be rated for
SC
the hard drive’s current drain.
Altronics..................................... IBC
Digi-Key Electronics....................... 3
DSCAPE...................................... 95
Emona Instruments...................... 25
Front Panel Express..................... 11
Hammond Manufacturing............. 10
Hare & Forbes.......................... OBC
Icom Australia................................ 9
Keith Rippon Kt Assembly ........... 95
LD Electronics.............................. 95
LEDsales...................................... 95
Master Instruments...................... 95
Microchip Technology................... 21
Ocean Controls.............................. 6
PCBCART...................................... 5
Sesame Electronics..................... 95
SC Radio & Hobbies DVD............ 70
Silicon Chip Binders..................... 66
Silicon Chip Online Shop........ 88-89
Silicon Chip Subscriptions........... 87
Silicon Chip Wallchart.................. 93
Silvertone Electronics.................. 13
Tronixlabs.................................. 7,95
Next Issue
The April 2016 issue of SILICON
CHIP is due on sale in newsagents
by Thursday 24th March. Expect
postal delivery of subscription copies in Australia between March 24th
and April 8th.
WARNING!
SILICON CHIP magazine regularly describes projects which employ a mains power supply or produce high voltage. All such
projects should be considered dangerous or even lethal if not used safely.
Readers are warned that high voltage wiring should be carried out according to the instructions in the articles. When working on these projects use extreme care to ensure that you do not accidentally come into contact with mains AC voltages or
high voltage DC. If you are not confident about working with projects employing mains voltages or other high voltages, you
are advised not to attempt work on them. Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd disclaims any liability for damages should anyone
be killed or injured while working on a project or circuit described in any issue of SILICON CHIP magazine.
Devices or circuits described in SILICON CHIP may be covered by patents. SILICON CHIP disclaims any liability for the infringement of such patents by the manufacturing or selling of any such equipment. SILICON CHIP also disclaims any liability
for projects which are used in such a way as to infringe relevant government regulations and by-laws.
Advertisers are warned that they are responsible for the content of all advertisements and that they must conform to the
Competition & Consumer Act 2010 or as subsequently amended and to any governmental regulations which are applicable.
96 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
Build It Yourself Electronics Centre®
28th Edition ‘Build It Yourself’ Catalogue
OUT NOW!
Yours FREE with this issue of Silicon Chip.
If you didn’t receive your copy, contact your newsagent or register at
www.altronics.com.au/catalogue to receive one by post for FREE.
Below is just a sampling of the 900+ new items in the range...
NEW!
NEW!
A 1109
49
.95
$
Add Bluetooth® streaming to
any amplifier instantly!
Pairs with your phone to stream your favourite tunes
to your existing audio system.. Includes 3.5mm lead.
Buy P 6020 1.5m lead to hook up to RCA input on
most amps ($6). USB 5V 1A charging output.
M 8195
199
Suits 12V battery vehicles. 16800mAh rated
battery provides up to 800A peak output when
cranking. Two USB ports are provided for
charging devices. It also has a super bright 1W
LED torch. Dimensions: 178L x 84W x 45Dmm.
Stunning Performance Biema® Power Amplifiers
The latest release from Biema with several key enhancements in cooling, efficiency
and circuit protection. High power non-bridgeable design is perfect for DJs, bands,
function venues using foreground sound reinforcement. 3 pin XLR and 6.35mm inputs.
Speakon and binding post outputs. 2 year warranty.
®
NEW!
169
$
NEW!
A 1115
K 2547
NEW!
79.95
$
Audio Signal Injector/Tracer Kit
Ideal for fault locating in radio and
audio circuits. Includes a 1kHz
oscillator (injector) and an in-built
preamp/amplifier with a
headphone jack (tracer).
$
A 4157 2x250W $625
A 4159 2x350W $675
199
$
2 x 50W Stereo Mini Amp
Add Bluetooth® audio
to your favourite speakers!
Power up speakers in your study or alfresco
with this mini amp. 3.5mm and RCA inputs.
Class D design. Internal headphone amplifier.
Why pay for new bluetooth speakers when you can
add this 2x20W RMS module to your existing
speakers? Streams music direct from your phone!
$
Driveway Monitor Kit
Uses magnetic field detection to provide an audible
and visual alert when a vehicle is detected in your
driveway. Extra output can activate a mains switch
for lighting etc. Ideal for gate monitoring on farms.
A 4155 2x150W
525
149.95
K 4035
Lithium Car Jump Starter
JUST LANDED!
A 4200
NEW!
$
NEW!
Z 6355
7
$ .95
Handy Breadboard
Power Module
Makes the most of your
breadboard space. 3.3V or
5V DC selectable. Powers
both busses. USB input or
6-12V input via 2.1mm jack.
Z 6372
NEW!
29.95
$
Funduino Nano
Clone version of the popular Arduino
Nano board. atMega328P chip.
Store Locations: » Virginia QLD: 1870 Sandgate Rd » Springvale VIC: 891 Princes Hwy
» Auburn NSW: 15 Short St » Perth WA: 174 Roe St » Balcatta WA: 7/58 Erindale Rd
» Cannington WA: 6/1326 Albany Hwy
© Altronics 2016. E&OE. Prices stated herein are only valid until 31/03/16 or until stocks run out. All prices include GST and
exclude freight and insurance. See latest catalogue for freight rates. All major credit cards accepted.
NEW!
41.95
$
K 4344
Reduce the chance of being ‘rear ended’
with the Quick Brake kit.
The Quick Brake detects fast pedal movements
between accelerator and brake and switches on
the brake lights before your foot reaches the
brake pedal.
NEW!
Z 6328
19.95
$
8 Channel Relay Board
5V DC coil, popular for use with
microcontroller automation projects.
Heart Rate
Monitor Sensor
5Uses an IR LED and
optical transistor to
detect pulse on the
surface of the skin.
3-5V input. 15mmØ.
NEW!
Z 6352
21
$
.95
Phone Order Now On...
1300 797 007
or shop online 24/7 at www.altronics.com.au
|